qemu-qmp-ref − QEMU QMP Reference Manual
• |
QEMU QMP Reference Manual |
•
Introduction |
•
This document describes all commands currently supported by QMP. |
||||
• |
QMP errors |
•
QapiErrorClass (Enum) |
||||
• |
Common data types |
•
IoOperationType (Enum) |
||||
• |
OnOffAuto (Enum) |
|||
• |
OnOffSplit (Enum) |
|||
• |
String (Object) |
|||
• |
StrOrNull (Alternate) |
|||
• |
OffAutoPCIBAR (Enum) |
|||
• |
PCIELinkSpeed (Enum) |
|||
• |
PCIELinkWidth (Enum) |
|||
• |
HostMemPolicy (Enum) |
|||
• |
NetFilterDirection (Enum) |
|||
• |
GrabToggleKeys (Enum) |
|||
• |
HumanReadableText (Object) |
|||
• |
Socket data types
• |
NetworkAddressFamily (Enum) |
|||
• |
InetSocketAddressBase (Object) |
|||
• |
InetSocketAddress (Object) |
|||
• |
UnixSocketAddress (Object) |
|||
• |
VsockSocketAddress (Object) |
|||
• |
InetSocketAddressWrapper (Object) |
|||
• |
UnixSocketAddressWrapper (Object) |
|||
• |
VsockSocketAddressWrapper (Object) |
|||
• |
StringWrapper (Object) |
|||
• |
SocketAddressLegacy (Object) |
|||
• |
SocketAddressType (Enum) |
|||
• |
SocketAddress (Object) |
|||
• |
VM run state
• |
RunState (Enum) |
|||
• |
ShutdownCause (Enum) |
|||
• |
StatusInfo (Object) |
|||
• |
query−status (Command) |
|||
• |
SHUTDOWN (Event) |
|||
• |
POWERDOWN (Event) |
|||
• |
RESET (Event) |
|||
• |
STOP (Event) |
|||
• |
RESUME (Event) |
|||
• |
SUSPEND (Event) |
|||
• |
SUSPEND_DISK (Event) |
|||
• |
WAKEUP (Event) |
|||
• |
WATCHDOG (Event) |
|||
• |
WatchdogAction (Enum) |
|||
• |
RebootAction (Enum) |
|||
• |
ShutdownAction (Enum) |
|||
• |
PanicAction (Enum) |
|||
• |
watchdog−set−action (Command) |
|||
• |
set−action (Command) |
|||
• |
GUEST_PANICKED (Event) |
|||
• |
GUEST_CRASHLOADED (Event) |
|||
• |
GuestPanicAction (Enum) |
|||
• |
GuestPanicInformationType (Enum) |
|||
• |
GuestPanicInformation (Object) |
|||
• |
GuestPanicInformationHyperV (Object) |
|||
• |
S390CrashReason (Enum) |
|||
• |
GuestPanicInformationS390 (Object) |
|||
• |
MEMORY_FAILURE (Event) |
|||
• |
MemoryFailureRecipient (Enum) |
|||
• |
MemoryFailureAction (Enum) |
|||
• |
MemoryFailureFlags (Object) |
|||
• |
NotifyVmexitOption (Enum) |
|||
• |
Cryptography
• |
QCryptoTLSCredsEndpoint (Enum) |
|||
• |
QCryptoSecretFormat (Enum) |
|||
• |
QCryptoHashAlgorithm (Enum) |
|||
• |
QCryptoCipherAlgorithm (Enum) |
|||
• |
QCryptoCipherMode (Enum) |
|||
• |
QCryptoIVGenAlgorithm (Enum) |
|||
• |
QCryptoBlockFormat (Enum) |
|||
• |
QCryptoBlockOptionsBase (Object) |
|||
• |
QCryptoBlockOptionsQCow (Object) |
|||
• |
QCryptoBlockOptionsLUKS (Object) |
|||
• |
QCryptoBlockCreateOptionsLUKS (Object) |
|||
• |
QCryptoBlockOpenOptions (Object) |
|||
• |
QCryptoBlockCreateOptions (Object) |
|||
• |
QCryptoBlockInfoBase (Object) |
|||
• |
QCryptoBlockInfoLUKSSlot (Object) |
|||
• |
QCryptoBlockInfoLUKS (Object) |
|||
• |
QCryptoBlockInfo (Object) |
|||
• |
QCryptoBlockLUKSKeyslotState (Enum) |
|||
• |
QCryptoBlockAmendOptionsLUKS (Object) |
|||
• |
QCryptoBlockAmendOptions (Object) |
|||
• |
SecretCommonProperties (Object) |
|||
• |
SecretProperties (Object) |
|||
• |
SecretKeyringProperties (Object) |
|||
• |
TlsCredsProperties (Object) |
|||
• |
TlsCredsAnonProperties (Object) |
|||
• |
TlsCredsPskProperties (Object) |
|||
• |
TlsCredsX509Properties (Object) |
|||
• |
QCryptoAkCipherAlgorithm (Enum) |
|||
• |
QCryptoAkCipherKeyType (Enum) |
|||
• |
QCryptoRSAPaddingAlgorithm (Enum) |
|||
• |
QCryptoAkCipherOptionsRSA (Object) |
|||
• |
QCryptoAkCipherOptions (Object) |
|||
• |
Background jobs
• |
JobType (Enum) |
|||
• |
JobStatus (Enum) |
|||
• |
JobVerb (Enum) |
|||
• |
JOB_STATUS_CHANGE (Event) |
|||
• |
job−pause (Command) |
|||
• |
job−resume (Command) |
|||
• |
job−cancel (Command) |
|||
• |
job−complete (Command) |
|||
• |
job−dismiss (Command) |
|||
• |
job−finalize (Command) |
|||
• |
JobInfo (Object) |
|||
• |
query−jobs (Command) |
|||
• |
Block devices
• |
Block core (VM unrelated) |
|||
• |
Additional block stuff (VM related) |
|||
• |
Block device exports |
|||
• |
Character devices
• |
ChardevInfo (Object) |
|||
• |
query−chardev (Command) |
|||
• |
ChardevBackendInfo (Object) |
|||
• |
query−chardev−backends (Command) |
|||
• |
DataFormat (Enum) |
|||
• |
ringbuf−write (Command) |
|||
• |
ringbuf−read (Command) |
|||
• |
ChardevCommon (Object) |
|||
• |
ChardevFile (Object) |
|||
• |
ChardevHostdev (Object) |
|||
• |
ChardevSocket (Object) |
|||
• |
ChardevUdp (Object) |
|||
• |
ChardevMux (Object) |
|||
• |
ChardevStdio (Object) |
|||
• |
ChardevSpiceChannel (Object) |
|||
• |
ChardevSpicePort (Object) |
|||
• |
ChardevDBus (Object) |
|||
• |
ChardevVC (Object) |
|||
• |
ChardevRingbuf (Object) |
|||
• |
ChardevQemuVDAgent (Object) |
|||
• |
ChardevBackendKind (Enum) |
|||
• |
ChardevFileWrapper (Object) |
|||
• |
ChardevHostdevWrapper (Object) |
|||
• |
ChardevSocketWrapper (Object) |
|||
• |
ChardevUdpWrapper (Object) |
|||
• |
ChardevCommonWrapper (Object) |
|||
• |
ChardevMuxWrapper (Object) |
|||
• |
ChardevStdioWrapper (Object) |
|||
• |
ChardevSpiceChannelWrapper (Object) |
|||
• |
ChardevSpicePortWrapper (Object) |
|||
• |
ChardevQemuVDAgentWrapper (Object) |
|||
• |
ChardevDBusWrapper (Object) |
|||
• |
ChardevVCWrapper (Object) |
|||
• |
ChardevRingbufWrapper (Object) |
|||
• |
ChardevBackend (Object) |
|||
• |
ChardevReturn (Object) |
|||
• |
chardev−add (Command) |
|||
• |
chardev−change (Command) |
|||
• |
chardev−remove (Command) |
|||
• |
chardev−send−break (Command) |
|||
• |
VSERPORT_CHANGE (Event) |
|||
• |
Dump guest memory
• |
DumpGuestMemoryFormat (Enum) |
|||
• |
dump−guest−memory (Command) |
|||
• |
DumpStatus (Enum) |
|||
• |
DumpQueryResult (Object) |
|||
• |
query−dump (Command) |
|||
• |
DUMP_COMPLETED (Event) |
|||
• |
DumpGuestMemoryCapability (Object) |
|||
• |
query−dump−guest−memory−capability (Command) |
|||
• |
Net devices
• |
set_link (Command) |
|||
• |
netdev_add (Command) |
|||
• |
netdev_del (Command) |
|||
• |
NetLegacyNicOptions (Object) |
|||
• |
NetdevUserOptions (Object) |
|||
• |
NetdevTapOptions (Object) |
|||
• |
NetdevSocketOptions (Object) |
|||
• |
NetdevL2TPv3Options (Object) |
|||
• |
NetdevVdeOptions (Object) |
|||
• |
NetdevBridgeOptions (Object) |
|||
• |
NetdevHubPortOptions (Object) |
|||
• |
NetdevNetmapOptions (Object) |
|||
• |
NetdevVhostUserOptions (Object) |
|||
• |
NetdevVhostVDPAOptions (Object) |
|||
• |
NetdevVmnetHostOptions (Object) |
|||
• |
NetdevVmnetSharedOptions (Object) |
|||
• |
NetdevVmnetBridgedOptions (Object) |
|||
• |
NetdevStreamOptions (Object) |
|||
• |
NetdevDgramOptions (Object) |
|||
• |
NetClientDriver (Enum) |
|||
• |
Netdev (Object) |
|||
• |
RxState (Enum) |
|||
• |
RxFilterInfo (Object) |
|||
• |
query−rx−filter (Command) |
|||
• |
NIC_RX_FILTER_CHANGED (Event) |
|||
• |
AnnounceParameters (Object) |
|||
• |
announce−self (Command) |
|||
• |
FAILOVER_NEGOTIATED (Event) |
|||
• |
NETDEV_STREAM_CONNECTED (Event) |
|||
• |
NETDEV_STREAM_DISCONNECTED (Event) |
|||
• |
RDMA device
• |
RDMA_GID_STATUS_CHANGED (Event) |
|||
• |
Rocker switch device
• |
RockerSwitch (Object) |
|||
• |
query−rocker (Command) |
|||
• |
RockerPortDuplex (Enum) |
|||
• |
RockerPortAutoneg (Enum) |
|||
• |
RockerPort (Object) |
|||
• |
query−rocker−ports (Command) |
|||
• |
RockerOfDpaFlowKey (Object) |
|||
• |
RockerOfDpaFlowMask (Object) |
|||
• |
RockerOfDpaFlowAction (Object) |
|||
• |
RockerOfDpaFlow (Object) |
|||
• |
query−rocker−of−dpa−flows (Command) |
|||
• |
RockerOfDpaGroup (Object) |
|||
• |
query−rocker−of−dpa−groups (Command) |
|||
• |
TPM (trusted platform module) devices
• |
TpmModel (Enum) |
|||
• |
query−tpm−models (Command) |
|||
• |
TpmType (Enum) |
|||
• |
query−tpm−types (Command) |
|||
• |
TPMPassthroughOptions (Object) |
|||
• |
TPMEmulatorOptions (Object) |
|||
• |
TPMPassthroughOptionsWrapper (Object) |
|||
• |
TPMEmulatorOptionsWrapper (Object) |
|||
• |
TpmTypeOptions (Object) |
|||
• |
TPMInfo (Object) |
|||
• |
query−tpm (Command) |
|||
• |
Remote desktop
• |
DisplayProtocol (Enum) |
|||
• |
SetPasswordAction (Enum) |
|||
• |
SetPasswordOptions (Object) |
|||
• |
SetPasswordOptionsVnc (Object) |
|||
• |
set_password (Command) |
|||
• |
ExpirePasswordOptions (Object) |
|||
• |
ExpirePasswordOptionsVnc (Object) |
|||
• |
expire_password (Command) |
|||
• |
ImageFormat (Enum) |
|||
• |
screendump (Command) |
|||
• |
Spice |
|||
• |
VNC |
|||
• |
Input
• |
MouseInfo (Object) |
|||
• |
query−mice (Command) |
|||
• |
QKeyCode (Enum) |
|||
• |
KeyValueKind (Enum) |
|||
• |
IntWrapper (Object) |
|||
• |
QKeyCodeWrapper (Object) |
|||
• |
KeyValue (Object) |
|||
• |
send−key (Command) |
|||
• |
InputButton (Enum) |
|||
• |
InputAxis (Enum) |
|||
• |
InputMultiTouchType (Enum) |
|||
• |
InputKeyEvent (Object) |
|||
• |
InputBtnEvent (Object) |
|||
• |
InputMoveEvent (Object) |
|||
• |
InputMultiTouchEvent (Object) |
|||
• |
InputEventKind (Enum) |
|||
• |
InputKeyEventWrapper (Object) |
|||
• |
InputBtnEventWrapper (Object) |
|||
• |
InputMoveEventWrapper (Object) |
|||
• |
InputMultiTouchEventWrapper (Object) |
|||
• |
InputEvent (Object) |
|||
• |
input−send−event (Command) |
|||
• |
DisplayGTK (Object) |
|||
• |
DisplayEGLHeadless (Object) |
|||
• |
DisplayDBus (Object) |
|||
• |
DisplayGLMode (Enum) |
|||
• |
DisplayCurses (Object) |
|||
• |
DisplayCocoa (Object) |
|||
• |
HotKeyMod (Enum) |
|||
• |
DisplaySDL (Object) |
|||
• |
DisplayType (Enum) |
|||
• |
DisplayOptions (Object) |
|||
• |
query−display−options (Command) |
|||
• |
DisplayReloadType (Enum) |
|||
• |
DisplayReloadOptionsVNC (Object) |
|||
• |
DisplayReloadOptions (Object) |
|||
• |
display−reload (Command) |
|||
• |
DisplayUpdateType (Enum) |
|||
• |
DisplayUpdateOptionsVNC (Object) |
|||
• |
DisplayUpdateOptions (Object) |
|||
• |
display−update (Command) |
|||
• |
client_migrate_info (Command) |
|||
• |
User authorization
• |
QAuthZListPolicy (Enum) |
|||
• |
QAuthZListFormat (Enum) |
|||
• |
QAuthZListRule (Object) |
|||
• |
AuthZListProperties (Object) |
|||
• |
AuthZListFileProperties (Object) |
|||
• |
AuthZPAMProperties (Object) |
|||
• |
AuthZSimpleProperties (Object) |
|||
• |
Migration
• |
MigrationStats (Object) |
|||
• |
XBZRLECacheStats (Object) |
|||
• |
CompressionStats (Object) |
|||
• |
MigrationStatus (Enum) |
|||
• |
VfioStats (Object) |
|||
• |
MigrationInfo (Object) |
|||
• |
query−migrate (Command) |
|||
• |
MigrationCapability (Enum) |
|||
• |
MigrationCapabilityStatus (Object) |
|||
• |
migrate−set−capabilities (Command) |
|||
• |
query−migrate−capabilities (Command) |
|||
• |
MultiFDCompression (Enum) |
|||
• |
BitmapMigrationBitmapAliasTransform (Object) |
|||
• |
BitmapMigrationBitmapAlias (Object) |
|||
• |
BitmapMigrationNodeAlias (Object) |
|||
• |
MigrationParameter (Enum) |
|||
• |
MigrateSetParameters (Object) |
|||
• |
migrate−set−parameters (Command) |
|||
• |
MigrationParameters (Object) |
|||
• |
query−migrate−parameters (Command) |
|||
• |
migrate−start−postcopy (Command) |
|||
• |
MIGRATION (Event) |
|||
• |
MIGRATION_PASS (Event) |
|||
• |
COLOMessage (Enum) |
|||
• |
COLOMode (Enum) |
|||
• |
FailoverStatus (Enum) |
|||
• |
COLO_EXIT (Event) |
|||
• |
COLOExitReason (Enum) |
|||
• |
x−colo−lost−heartbeat (Command) |
|||
• |
migrate_cancel (Command) |
|||
• |
migrate−continue (Command) |
|||
• |
migrate (Command) |
|||
• |
migrate−incoming (Command) |
|||
• |
xen−save−devices−state (Command) |
|||
• |
xen−set−global−dirty−log (Command) |
|||
• |
xen−load−devices−state (Command) |
|||
• |
xen−set−replication (Command) |
|||
• |
ReplicationStatus (Object) |
|||
• |
query−xen−replication−status (Command) |
|||
• |
xen−colo−do−checkpoint (Command) |
|||
• |
COLOStatus (Object) |
|||
• |
query−colo−status (Command) |
|||
• |
migrate−recover (Command) |
|||
• |
migrate−pause (Command) |
|||
• |
UNPLUG_PRIMARY (Event) |
|||
• |
DirtyRateVcpu (Object) |
|||
• |
DirtyRateStatus (Enum) |
|||
• |
DirtyRateMeasureMode (Enum) |
|||
• |
DirtyRateInfo (Object) |
|||
• |
calc−dirty−rate (Command) |
|||
• |
query−dirty−rate (Command) |
|||
• |
DirtyLimitInfo (Object) |
|||
• |
set−vcpu−dirty−limit (Command) |
|||
• |
cancel−vcpu−dirty−limit (Command) |
|||
• |
query−vcpu−dirty−limit (Command) |
|||
• |
MigrationThreadInfo (Object) |
|||
• |
query−migrationthreads (Command) |
|||
• |
snapshot−save (Command) |
|||
• |
snapshot−load (Command) |
|||
• |
snapshot−delete (Command) |
|||
• |
Transactions
• |
Abort (Object) |
|||
• |
ActionCompletionMode (Enum) |
|||
• |
TransactionActionKind (Enum) |
|||
• |
AbortWrapper (Object) |
|||
• |
BlockDirtyBitmapAddWrapper (Object) |
|||
• |
BlockDirtyBitmapWrapper (Object) |
|||
• |
BlockDirtyBitmapMergeWrapper (Object) |
|||
• |
BlockdevBackupWrapper (Object) |
|||
• |
BlockdevSnapshotWrapper (Object) |
|||
• |
BlockdevSnapshotInternalWrapper (Object) |
|||
• |
BlockdevSnapshotSyncWrapper (Object) |
|||
• |
DriveBackupWrapper (Object) |
|||
• |
TransactionAction (Object) |
|||
• |
TransactionProperties (Object) |
|||
• |
transaction (Command) |
|||
• |
Tracing
• |
TraceEventState (Enum) |
|||
• |
TraceEventInfo (Object) |
|||
• |
trace−event−get−state (Command) |
|||
• |
trace−event−set−state (Command) |
|||
• |
Compatibility policy
• |
CompatPolicyInput (Enum) |
|||
• |
CompatPolicyOutput (Enum) |
|||
• |
CompatPolicy (Object) |
|||
• |
QMP monitor control
• |
qmp_capabilities (Command) |
|||
• |
QMPCapability (Enum) |
|||
• |
VersionTriple (Object) |
|||
• |
VersionInfo (Object) |
|||
• |
query−version (Command) |
|||
• |
CommandInfo (Object) |
|||
• |
query−commands (Command) |
|||
• |
quit (Command) |
|||
• |
MonitorMode (Enum) |
|||
• |
MonitorOptions (Object) |
|||
• |
QMP introspection
• |
query−qmp−schema (Command) |
|||
• |
SchemaMetaType (Enum) |
|||
• |
SchemaInfo (Object) |
|||
• |
SchemaInfoBuiltin (Object) |
|||
• |
JSONType (Enum) |
|||
• |
SchemaInfoEnum (Object) |
|||
• |
SchemaInfoEnumMember (Object) |
|||
• |
SchemaInfoArray (Object) |
|||
• |
SchemaInfoObject (Object) |
|||
• |
SchemaInfoObjectMember (Object) |
|||
• |
SchemaInfoObjectVariant (Object) |
|||
• |
SchemaInfoAlternate (Object) |
|||
• |
SchemaInfoAlternateMember (Object) |
|||
• |
SchemaInfoCommand (Object) |
|||
• |
SchemaInfoEvent (Object) |
|||
• |
QEMU Object Model (QOM)
• |
ObjectPropertyInfo (Object) |
|||
• |
qom−list (Command) |
|||
• |
qom−get (Command) |
|||
• |
qom−set (Command) |
|||
• |
ObjectTypeInfo (Object) |
|||
• |
qom−list−types (Command) |
|||
• |
qom−list−properties (Command) |
|||
• |
CanHostSocketcanProperties (Object) |
|||
• |
ColoCompareProperties (Object) |
|||
• |
CryptodevBackendProperties (Object) |
|||
• |
CryptodevVhostUserProperties (Object) |
|||
• |
DBusVMStateProperties (Object) |
|||
• |
NetfilterInsert (Enum) |
|||
• |
NetfilterProperties (Object) |
|||
• |
FilterBufferProperties (Object) |
|||
• |
FilterDumpProperties (Object) |
|||
• |
FilterMirrorProperties (Object) |
|||
• |
FilterRedirectorProperties (Object) |
|||
• |
FilterRewriterProperties (Object) |
|||
• |
InputBarrierProperties (Object) |
|||
• |
InputLinuxProperties (Object) |
|||
• |
EventLoopBaseProperties (Object) |
|||
• |
IothreadProperties (Object) |
|||
• |
MainLoopProperties (Object) |
|||
• |
MemoryBackendProperties (Object) |
|||
• |
MemoryBackendFileProperties (Object) |
|||
• |
MemoryBackendMemfdProperties (Object) |
|||
• |
MemoryBackendEpcProperties (Object) |
|||
• |
PrManagerHelperProperties (Object) |
|||
• |
QtestProperties (Object) |
|||
• |
RemoteObjectProperties (Object) |
|||
• |
VfioUserServerProperties (Object) |
|||
• |
RngProperties (Object) |
|||
• |
RngEgdProperties (Object) |
|||
• |
RngRandomProperties (Object) |
|||
• |
SevGuestProperties (Object) |
|||
• |
ThreadContextProperties (Object) |
|||
• |
ObjectType (Enum) |
|||
• |
ObjectOptions (Object) |
|||
• |
object−add (Command) |
|||
• |
object−del (Command) |
|||
• |
Device infrastructure (qdev)
• |
device−list−properties (Command) |
|||
• |
device_add (Command) |
|||
• |
device_del (Command) |
|||
• |
DEVICE_DELETED (Event) |
|||
• |
DEVICE_UNPLUG_GUEST_ERROR (Event) |
|||
• |
Machines
• |
SysEmuTarget (Enum) |
|||
• |
CpuS390State (Enum) |
|||
• |
CpuInfoS390 (Object) |
|||
• |
CpuInfoFast (Object) |
|||
• |
query−cpus−fast (Command) |
|||
• |
MachineInfo (Object) |
|||
• |
query−machines (Command) |
|||
• |
CurrentMachineParams (Object) |
|||
• |
query−current−machine (Command) |
|||
• |
TargetInfo (Object) |
|||
• |
query−target (Command) |
|||
• |
UuidInfo (Object) |
|||
• |
query−uuid (Command) |
|||
• |
GuidInfo (Object) |
|||
• |
query−vm−generation−id (Command) |
|||
• |
system_reset (Command) |
|||
• |
system_powerdown (Command) |
|||
• |
system_wakeup (Command) |
|||
• |
LostTickPolicy (Enum) |
|||
• |
inject−nmi (Command) |
|||
• |
KvmInfo (Object) |
|||
• |
query−kvm (Command) |
|||
• |
NumaOptionsType (Enum) |
|||
• |
NumaOptions (Object) |
|||
• |
NumaNodeOptions (Object) |
|||
• |
NumaDistOptions (Object) |
|||
• |
CXLFixedMemoryWindowOptions (Object) |
|||
• |
CXLFMWProperties (Object) |
|||
• |
X86CPURegister32 (Enum) |
|||
• |
X86CPUFeatureWordInfo (Object) |
|||
• |
DummyForceArrays (Object) |
|||
• |
NumaCpuOptions (Object) |
|||
• |
HmatLBMemoryHierarchy (Enum) |
|||
• |
HmatLBDataType (Enum) |
|||
• |
NumaHmatLBOptions (Object) |
|||
• |
HmatCacheAssociativity (Enum) |
|||
• |
HmatCacheWritePolicy (Enum) |
|||
• |
NumaHmatCacheOptions (Object) |
|||
• |
memsave (Command) |
|||
• |
pmemsave (Command) |
|||
• |
Memdev (Object) |
|||
• |
query−memdev (Command) |
|||
• |
CpuInstanceProperties (Object) |
|||
• |
HotpluggableCPU (Object) |
|||
• |
query−hotpluggable−cpus (Command) |
|||
• |
set−numa−node (Command) |
|||
• |
balloon (Command) |
|||
• |
BalloonInfo (Object) |
|||
• |
query−balloon (Command) |
|||
• |
BALLOON_CHANGE (Event) |
|||
• |
MemoryInfo (Object) |
|||
• |
query−memory−size−summary (Command) |
|||
• |
PCDIMMDeviceInfo (Object) |
|||
• |
VirtioPMEMDeviceInfo (Object) |
|||
• |
VirtioMEMDeviceInfo (Object) |
|||
• |
SgxEPCDeviceInfo (Object) |
|||
• |
MemoryDeviceInfoKind (Enum) |
|||
• |
PCDIMMDeviceInfoWrapper (Object) |
|||
• |
VirtioPMEMDeviceInfoWrapper (Object) |
|||
• |
VirtioMEMDeviceInfoWrapper (Object) |
|||
• |
SgxEPCDeviceInfoWrapper (Object) |
|||
• |
MemoryDeviceInfo (Object) |
|||
• |
SgxEPC (Object) |
|||
• |
SgxEPCProperties (Object) |
|||
• |
query−memory−devices (Command) |
|||
• |
MEMORY_DEVICE_SIZE_CHANGE (Event) |
|||
• |
MEM_UNPLUG_ERROR (Event) |
|||
• |
BootConfiguration (Object) |
|||
• |
SMPConfiguration (Object) |
|||
• |
x−query−irq (Command) |
|||
• |
x−query−jit (Command) |
|||
• |
x−query−numa (Command) |
|||
• |
x−query−opcount (Command) |
|||
• |
x−query−ramblock (Command) |
|||
• |
x−query−rdma (Command) |
|||
• |
x−query−roms (Command) |
|||
• |
x−query−usb (Command) |
|||
• |
SmbiosEntryPointType (Enum) |
|||
• |
MemorySizeConfiguration (Object) |
|||
• |
dumpdtb (Command) |
|||
• |
CpuModelInfo (Object) |
|||
• |
CpuModelExpansionType (Enum) |
|||
• |
CpuModelCompareResult (Enum) |
|||
• |
CpuModelBaselineInfo (Object) |
|||
• |
CpuModelCompareInfo (Object) |
|||
• |
query−cpu−model−comparison (Command) |
|||
• |
query−cpu−model−baseline (Command) |
|||
• |
CpuModelExpansionInfo (Object) |
|||
• |
query−cpu−model−expansion (Command) |
|||
• |
CpuDefinitionInfo (Object) |
|||
• |
query−cpu−definitions (Command) |
|||
• |
Record/replay
• |
ReplayMode (Enum) |
|||
• |
ReplayInfo (Object) |
|||
• |
query−replay (Command) |
|||
• |
replay−break (Command) |
|||
• |
replay−delete−break (Command) |
|||
• |
replay−seek (Command) |
|||
• |
Yank feature
• |
YankInstanceType (Enum) |
|||
• |
YankInstanceBlockNode (Object) |
|||
• |
YankInstanceChardev (Object) |
|||
• |
YankInstance (Object) |
|||
• |
yank (Command) |
|||
• |
query−yank (Command) |
|||
• |
Miscellanea
• |
add_client (Command) |
|||
• |
NameInfo (Object) |
|||
• |
query−name (Command) |
|||
• |
IOThreadInfo (Object) |
|||
• |
query−iothreads (Command) |
|||
• |
stop (Command) |
|||
• |
cont (Command) |
|||
• |
x−exit−preconfig (Command) |
|||
• |
human−monitor−command (Command) |
|||
• |
getfd (Command) |
|||
• |
get−win32−socket (Command) |
|||
• |
closefd (Command) |
|||
• |
AddfdInfo (Object) |
|||
• |
add−fd (Command) |
|||
• |
remove−fd (Command) |
|||
• |
FdsetFdInfo (Object) |
|||
• |
FdsetInfo (Object) |
|||
• |
query−fdsets (Command) |
|||
• |
CommandLineParameterType (Enum) |
|||
• |
CommandLineParameterInfo (Object) |
|||
• |
CommandLineOptionInfo (Object) |
|||
• |
query−command−line−options (Command) |
|||
• |
RTC_CHANGE (Event) |
|||
• |
VFU_CLIENT_HANGUP (Event) |
|||
• |
rtc−reset−reinjection (Command) |
|||
• |
SevState (Enum) |
|||
• |
SevInfo (Object) |
|||
• |
query−sev (Command) |
|||
• |
SevLaunchMeasureInfo (Object) |
|||
• |
query−sev−launch−measure (Command) |
|||
• |
SevCapability (Object) |
|||
• |
query−sev−capabilities (Command) |
|||
• |
sev−inject−launch−secret (Command) |
|||
• |
SevAttestationReport (Object) |
|||
• |
query−sev−attestation−report (Command) |
|||
• |
dump−skeys (Command) |
|||
• |
GICCapability (Object) |
|||
• |
query−gic−capabilities (Command) |
|||
• |
SGXEPCSection (Object) |
|||
• |
SGXInfo (Object) |
|||
• |
query−sgx (Command) |
|||
• |
query−sgx−capabilities (Command) |
|||
• |
EvtchnPortType (Enum) |
|||
• |
EvtchnInfo (Object) |
|||
• |
xen−event−list (Command) |
|||
• |
xen−event−inject (Command) |
|||
• |
Audio
• |
AudiodevPerDirectionOptions (Object) |
|||
• |
AudiodevGenericOptions (Object) |
|||
• |
AudiodevAlsaPerDirectionOptions (Object) |
|||
• |
AudiodevAlsaOptions (Object) |
|||
• |
AudiodevSndioOptions (Object) |
|||
• |
AudiodevCoreaudioPerDirectionOptions (Object) |
|||
• |
AudiodevCoreaudioOptions (Object) |
|||
• |
AudiodevDsoundOptions (Object) |
|||
• |
AudiodevJackPerDirectionOptions (Object) |
|||
• |
AudiodevJackOptions (Object) |
|||
• |
AudiodevOssPerDirectionOptions (Object) |
|||
• |
AudiodevOssOptions (Object) |
|||
• |
AudiodevPaPerDirectionOptions (Object) |
|||
• |
AudiodevPaOptions (Object) |
|||
• |
AudiodevPipewirePerDirectionOptions (Object) |
|||
• |
AudiodevPipewireOptions (Object) |
|||
• |
AudiodevSdlPerDirectionOptions (Object) |
|||
• |
AudiodevSdlOptions (Object) |
|||
• |
AudiodevWavOptions (Object) |
|||
• |
AudioFormat (Enum) |
|||
• |
AudiodevDriver (Enum) |
|||
• |
Audiodev (Object) |
|||
• |
query−audiodevs (Command) |
|||
• |
ACPI
• |
AcpiTableOptions (Object) |
|||
• |
ACPISlotType (Enum) |
|||
• |
ACPIOSTInfo (Object) |
|||
• |
query−acpi−ospm−status (Command) |
|||
• |
ACPI_DEVICE_OST (Event) |
|||
• |
PCI
• |
PciMemoryRange (Object) |
|||
• |
PciMemoryRegion (Object) |
|||
• |
PciBusInfo (Object) |
|||
• |
PciBridgeInfo (Object) |
|||
• |
PciDeviceClass (Object) |
|||
• |
PciDeviceId (Object) |
|||
• |
PciDeviceInfo (Object) |
|||
• |
PciInfo (Object) |
|||
• |
query−pci (Command) |
|||
• |
Statistics
• |
StatsType (Enum) |
|||
• |
StatsUnit (Enum) |
|||
• |
StatsProvider (Enum) |
|||
• |
StatsTarget (Enum) |
|||
• |
StatsRequest (Object) |
|||
• |
StatsVCPUFilter (Object) |
|||
• |
StatsFilter (Object) |
|||
• |
StatsValue (Alternate) |
|||
• |
Stats (Object) |
|||
• |
StatsResult (Object) |
|||
• |
query−stats (Command) |
|||
• |
StatsSchemaValue (Object) |
|||
• |
StatsSchema (Object) |
|||
• |
query−stats−schemas (Command) |
|||
• |
Virtio devices
• |
VirtioInfo (Object) |
|||
• |
x−query−virtio (Command) |
|||
• |
VhostStatus (Object) |
|||
• |
VirtioStatus (Object) |
|||
• |
x−query−virtio−status (Command) |
|||
• |
VirtioDeviceStatus (Object) |
|||
• |
VhostDeviceProtocols (Object) |
|||
• |
VirtioDeviceFeatures (Object) |
|||
• |
VirtQueueStatus (Object) |
|||
• |
x−query−virtio−queue−status (Command) |
|||
• |
VirtVhostQueueStatus (Object) |
|||
• |
x−query−virtio−vhost−queue−status (Command) |
|||
• |
VirtioRingDesc (Object) |
|||
• |
VirtioRingAvail (Object) |
|||
• |
VirtioRingUsed (Object) |
|||
• |
VirtioQueueElement (Object) |
|||
• |
x−query−virtio−queue−element (Command) |
|||
• |
Cryptography devices
• |
QCryptodevBackendAlgType (Enum) |
|||
• |
QCryptodevBackendServiceType (Enum) |
|||
• |
QCryptodevBackendType (Enum) |
|||
• |
QCryptodevBackendClient (Object) |
|||
• |
QCryptodevInfo (Object) |
|||
• |
query−cryptodev (Command) |
|||
• |
CXL devices
• |
CxlEventLog (Enum) |
|||
• |
cxl−inject−general−media−event (Command) |
|||
• |
cxl−inject−dram−event (Command) |
|||
• |
cxl−inject−memory−module−event (Command) |
|||
• |
cxl−inject−poison (Command) |
|||
• |
CxlUncorErrorType (Enum) |
|||
• |
CXLUncorErrorRecord (Object) |
|||
• |
cxl−inject−uncorrectable−errors (Command) |
|||
• |
CxlCorErrorType (Enum) |
|||
• |
cxl−inject−correctable−error (Command) |
This document describes all commands currently supported by QMP.
Most of the time their usage is exactly the same as in the user Monitor, this means that any other document which also describe commands (the manpage, QEMU's manual, etc) can and should be consulted.
QMP has two types of commands: regular and query commands. Regular commands usually change the Virtual Machine's state someway, while query commands just return information. The sections below are divided accordingly.
It's important to observe that all communication examples are formatted in a reader−friendly way, so that they're easier to understand. However, in real protocol usage, they're emitted as a single line.
Also, the following notation is used to denote data flow:
Example:
−> data issued by the Client <− Server data response
Please refer to the QEMU Machine Protocol Specification for detailed information on the Server command and response formats.
QEMU error classes
GenericError
this is used for errors that don't require a specific error class. This should be the default case for most errors
CommandNotFound
the requested command has not been found
DeviceNotActive
a device has failed to be become active
DeviceNotFound
the requested device has not been found
KVMMissingCap
the requested operation can't be fulfilled because a required KVM capability is missing
1.2
An enumeration of the I/O operation types
read |
read operation |
|||
write |
write operation |
2.1
An enumeration of three options: on, off, and auto
auto |
QEMU selects the value between on and off |
|||
on |
Enabled |
|||
off |
Disabled |
2.2
An enumeration of three values: on, off, and split
on |
Enabled |
|||
off |
Disabled |
|||
split |
Mixed |
2.6
A fat type wrapping 'str', to be embedded in lists.
str: string
Not documented
1.2
This is a string value or the explicit lack of a string (null pointer in C). Intended for cases when 'optional absent' already has a different meaning.
s: string
the string value
n: null
no string value
2.10
An enumeration of options for specifying a PCI BAR
off |
The specified feature is disabled |
|||
auto |
The PCI BAR for the feature is automatically selected |
|||
bar0 |
PCI BAR0 is used for the feature |
|||
bar1 |
PCI BAR1 is used for the feature |
|||
bar2 |
PCI BAR2 is used for the feature |
|||
bar3 |
PCI BAR3 is used for the feature |
|||
bar4 |
PCI BAR4 is used for the feature |
|||
bar5 |
PCI BAR5 is used for the feature |
2.12
An enumeration of PCIe link speeds in units of GT/s
2_5 |
2.5GT/s |
|||
5 |
5.0GT/s |
|||
8 |
8.0GT/s |
|||
16 |
16.0GT/s |
4.0
An enumeration of PCIe link width
1 |
x1 |
|||
2 |
x2 |
|||
4 |
x4 |
|||
8 |
x8 |
|||
12 |
x12 |
|||
16 |
x16 |
|||
32 |
x32 |
4.0
Host memory policy types
default
restore default policy, remove any nondefault policy
preferred
set the preferred host nodes for allocation
bind |
a strict policy that restricts memory allocation to the host nodes specified |
interleave
memory allocations are interleaved across the set of host nodes specified
2.1
Indicates whether a netfilter is attached to a netdev's transmit queue or receive queue or both.
all |
the filter is attached both to the receive and the transmit queue of the netdev (default). | ||
rx |
the filter is attached to the receive queue of the netdev, where it will receive packets sent to the netdev. | ||
tx |
the filter is attached to the transmit queue of the netdev, where it will receive packets sent by the netdev. |
2.5
Keys to toggle input−linux between host and guest.
ctrl−ctrl
Not documented
alt−alt
Not documented
shift−shift
Not documented
meta−meta
Not documented
scrolllock
Not documented
ctrl−scrolllock
Not documented
4.0
human−readable−text: string
Formatted output intended for humans.
6.2
The network address family
ipv4 |
IPV4 family |
|||
ipv6 |
IPV6 family |
|||
unix |
unix socket |
|||
vsock |
vsock family (since 2.8) |
unknown
otherwise
2.1
host: string
host part of the address
port: string
port part of the address
Captures a socket address or address range in the Internet namespace.
numeric: boolean (optional)
true if the host/port are guaranteed to be numeric, false if name resolution should be attempted. Defaults to false. (Since 2.9)
to: int (optional)
If present, this is range of possible addresses, with port between port and to.
ipv4: boolean (optional)
whether to accept IPv4 addresses, default try both IPv4 and IPv6
ipv6: boolean (optional)
whether to accept IPv6 addresses, default try both IPv4 and IPv6
keep−alive: boolean (optional)
enable keep−alive when connecting to this socket. Not supported for passive sockets. (Since 4.2)
mptcp: boolean (optional) (If: HAVE_IPPROTO_MPTCP)
enable multi−path TCP. (Since 6.1)
The members of InetSocketAddressBase
1.3
Captures a socket address in the local ("Unix socket") namespace.
path: string
filesystem path to use
abstract: boolean (optional) (If: CONFIG_LINUX)
if true, this is a Linux abstract socket address. path will be prefixed by a null byte, and optionally padded with null bytes. Defaults to false. (Since 5.1)
tight: boolean (optional) (If: CONFIG_LINUX)
if false, pad an abstract socket address with enough null bytes to make it fill struct sockaddr_un member sun_path. Defaults to true. (Since 5.1)
1.3
Captures a socket address in the vsock namespace.
cid: string
unique host identifier
port: string
port
string types are used to allow for possible future hostname or service resolution support.
2.8
data: InetSocketAddress
Not documented
1.3
data: UnixSocketAddress
Not documented
1.3
data: VsockSocketAddress
Not documented
2.8
data: String
Not documented
1.3
Captures the address of a socket, which could also be a named file descriptor
type: SocketAddressType
Not documented
The members of
InetSocketAddressWrapper when type is "inet"
The members of UnixSocketAddressWrapper when type is
"unix"
The members of VsockSocketAddressWrapper when type is
"vsock"
The members of StringWrapper when type is
"fd"
This type is deprecated in favor of SocketAddress. The difference between SocketAddressLegacy and SocketAddress is that the latter has fewer {} on the wire.
1.3
Available SocketAddress types
inet |
Internet address | ||
unix |
Unix domain socket | ||
vsock |
VMCI address | ||
fd |
decimal is for file descriptor number, otherwise a file descriptor name. Named file descriptors are permitted in monitor commands, in combination with the 'getfd' command. Decimal file descriptors are permitted at startup or other contexts where no monitor context is active. |
2.9
Captures the address of a socket, which could also be a named file descriptor
type: SocketAddressType
Transport type
The members of
InetSocketAddress when type is "inet"
The members of UnixSocketAddress when type is
"unix"
The members of VsockSocketAddress when type is
"vsock"
The members of String when type is "fd"
2.9
An enumeration of VM run states.
debug |
QEMU is running on a debugger |
finish−migrate
guest is paused to finish the migration process
inmigrate
guest is paused waiting for an incoming migration. Note that this state does not tell whether the machine will start at the end of the migration. This depends on the command−line −S option and any invocation of 'stop' or 'cont' that has happened since QEMU was started.
internal−error
An internal error that prevents further guest execution has occurred
io−error
the last IOP has failed and the device is configured to pause on I/O errors
paused |
guest has been paused via the 'stop' command |
postmigrate
guest is paused following a successful 'migrate'
prelaunch
QEMU was started with −S and guest has not started
restore−vm
guest is paused to restore VM state
running
guest is actively running
save−vm
guest is paused to save the VM state
shutdown
guest is shut down (and −no−shutdown is in use)
suspended
guest is suspended (ACPI S3)
watchdog
the watchdog action is configured to pause and has been triggered
guest−panicked
guest has been panicked as a result of guest OS panic
colo |
guest is paused to save/restore VM state under colo checkpoint, VM can not get into this state unless colo capability is enabled for migration. (since 2.8) |
An enumeration of reasons for a Shutdown.
none |
No shutdown request pending |
host−error
An error prevents further use of guest
host−qmp−quit
Reaction to the QMP command 'quit'
host−qmp−system−reset
Reaction to the QMP command 'system_reset'
host−signal
Reaction to a signal, such as SIGINT
host−ui
Reaction to a UI event, like window close
guest−shutdown
Guest shutdown/suspend request, via ACPI or other hardware−specific means
guest−reset
Guest reset request, and command line turns that into a shutdown
guest−panic
Guest panicked, and command line turns that into a shutdown
subsystem−reset
Partial guest reset that does not trigger QMP events and ignores −−no−reboot. This is useful for sanitizing hypercalls on s390 that are used during kexec/kdump/boot
snapshot−load
A snapshot is being loaded by the record & replay subsystem. This value is used only within QEMU. It doesn't occur in QMP. (since 7.2)
Information about VCPU run state
running: boolean
true if all VCPUs are runnable, false if not runnable
singlestep: boolean
true if using TCG with one guest instruction per translation block
status: RunState
the virtual machine RunState
deprecated
Member 'singlestep' is deprecated (with no replacement).
0.14
singlestep is enabled on the command line with '−accel tcg,one−insn−per−tb=on', or with the HMP 'one−insn−per−tb' command.
Query the run status of all VCPUs
StatusInfo reflecting all VCPUs
0.14
−> { "execute": "query−status" } <− { "return": { "running": true, "singlestep": false, "status": "running" } }
Emitted when the virtual machine has shut down, indicating that qemu is about to exit.
guest: boolean
If true, the shutdown was triggered by a guest request (such as a guest−initiated ACPI shutdown request or other hardware−specific action) rather than a host request (such as sending qemu a SIGINT). (since 2.10)
reason: ShutdownCause
The ShutdownCause which resulted in the SHUTDOWN. (since 4.0)
If the command−line option "−no−shutdown" has been specified, qemu will not exit, and a STOP event will eventually follow the SHUTDOWN event
0.12
<− { "event": "SHUTDOWN", "data": { "guest": true, "reason": "guest−shutdown" }, "timestamp": { "seconds": 1267040730, "microseconds": 682951 } }
Emitted when the virtual machine is powered down through the power control system, such as via ACPI.
0.12
<− { "event": "POWERDOWN", "timestamp": { "seconds": 1267040730, "microseconds": 682951 } }
Emitted when the virtual machine is reset
guest: boolean
If true, the reset was triggered by a guest request (such as a guest−initiated ACPI reboot request or other hardware−specific action) rather than a host request (such as the QMP command system_reset). (since 2.10)
reason: ShutdownCause
The ShutdownCause of the RESET. (since 4.0)
0.12
<− { "event": "RESET", "data": { "guest": false, "reason": "guest−reset" }, "timestamp": { "seconds": 1267041653, "microseconds": 9518 } }
Emitted when the virtual machine is stopped
0.12
<− { "event": "STOP", "timestamp": { "seconds": 1267041730, "microseconds": 281295 } }
Emitted when the virtual machine resumes execution
0.12
<− { "event": "RESUME", "timestamp": { "seconds": 1271770767, "microseconds": 582542 } }
Emitted when guest enters a hardware suspension state, for example, S3 state, which is sometimes called standby state
1.1
<− { "event": "SUSPEND", "timestamp": { "seconds": 1344456160, "microseconds": 309119 } }
Emitted when guest enters a hardware suspension state with data saved on disk, for example, S4 state, which is sometimes called hibernate state
QEMU shuts down (similar to event SHUTDOWN) when entering this state
1.2
<− { "event": "SUSPEND_DISK", "timestamp": { "seconds": 1344456160, "microseconds": 309119 } }
Emitted when the guest has woken up from suspend state and is running
1.1
<− { "event": "WAKEUP", "timestamp": { "seconds": 1344522075, "microseconds": 745528 } }
Emitted when the watchdog device's timer is expired
action: WatchdogAction
action that has been taken
If action is "reset", "shutdown", or "pause" the WATCHDOG event is followed respectively by the RESET, SHUTDOWN, or STOP events
This event is rate−limited.
0.13
<− { "event": "WATCHDOG", "data": { "action": "reset" }, "timestamp": { "seconds": 1267061043, "microseconds": 959568 } }
An enumeration of the actions taken when the watchdog device's timer is expired
reset |
system resets |
shutdown
system shutdown, note that it is similar to powerdown, which tries to set to system status and notify guest
poweroff
system poweroff, the emulator program exits
pause |
system pauses, similar to stop |
|||
debug |
system enters debug state |
|||
none |
nothing is done |
inject−nmi
a non−maskable interrupt is injected into the first VCPU (all VCPUS on x86) (since 2.4)
2.1
Possible QEMU actions upon guest reboot
reset |
Reset the VM |
shutdown
Shutdown the VM and exit, according to the shutdown action
6.0
Possible QEMU actions upon guest shutdown
poweroff
Shutdown the VM and exit
pause |
pause the VM |
6.0
none |
Continue VM execution |
|||
pause |
Pause the VM |
shutdown
Shutdown the VM and exit, according to the shutdown action
exit−failure
Shutdown the VM and exit with nonzero status (since 7.1)
6.0
Set watchdog action
action: WatchdogAction
Not documented
2.11
Set the actions that will be taken by the emulator in response to guest events.
reboot: RebootAction (optional)
RebootAction action taken on guest reboot.
shutdown: ShutdownAction (optional)
ShutdownAction action taken on guest shutdown.
panic: PanicAction (optional)
PanicAction action taken on guest panic.
watchdog: WatchdogAction (optional)
WatchdogAction action taken when watchdog timer expires .
Nothing on success.
6.0
−> { "execute": "set−action", "arguments": { "reboot": "shutdown", "shutdown" : "pause", "panic": "pause", "watchdog": "inject−nmi" } } <− { "return": {} }
Emitted when guest OS panic is detected
action: GuestPanicAction
action that has been taken, currently always "pause"
info: GuestPanicInformation (optional)
information about a panic (since 2.9)
1.5
<− { "event": "GUEST_PANICKED", "data": { "action": "pause" }, "timestamp": { "seconds": 1648245231, "microseconds": 900001 } }
Emitted when guest OS crash loaded is detected
action: GuestPanicAction
action that has been taken, currently always "run"
info: GuestPanicInformation (optional)
information about a panic
5.0
<− { "event": "GUEST_CRASHLOADED", "data": { "action": "run" }, "timestamp": { "seconds": 1648245259, "microseconds": 893771 } }
An enumeration of the actions taken when guest OS panic is detected
pause |
system pauses |
poweroff
system powers off (since 2.8)
run |
system continues to run (since 5.0) |
2.1
An enumeration of the guest panic information types
hyper−v
hyper−v guest panic information type
s390 |
s390 guest panic information type (Since: 2.12) |
2.9
Information about a guest panic
type: GuestPanicInformationType
Crash type that defines the hypervisor specific information
The members of
GuestPanicInformationHyperV when type is
"hyper−v"
The members of GuestPanicInformationS390 when type is
"s390"
2.9
Hyper−V specific guest panic information (HV crash MSRs)
arg1: int
Not documented
arg2: int
Not documented
arg3: int
Not documented
arg4: int
Not documented
arg5: int
Not documented
2.9
Reason why the CPU is in a crashed state.
unknown
no crash reason was set
disabled−wait
the CPU has entered a disabled wait state
extint−loop
clock comparator or cpu timer interrupt with new PSW enabled for external interrupts
pgmint−loop
program interrupt with BAD new PSW
opint−loop
operation exception interrupt with invalid code at the program interrupt new PSW
2.12
S390 specific guest panic information (PSW)
core: int
core id of the CPU that crashed
psw−mask: int
control fields of guest PSW
psw−addr: int
guest instruction address
reason: S390CrashReason
guest crash reason
2.12
Emitted when a memory failure occurs on host side.
recipient: MemoryFailureRecipient
recipient is defined as MemoryFailureRecipient.
action: MemoryFailureAction
action that has been taken. action is defined as MemoryFailureAction.
flags: MemoryFailureFlags
flags for MemoryFailureAction. action is defined as MemoryFailureFlags.
5.2
<− { "event": "MEMORY_FAILURE", "data": { "recipient": "hypervisor", "action": "fatal", "flags": { "action−required": false, "recursive": false } }, "timestamp": { "seconds": 1267061043, "microseconds": 959568 } }
Hardware memory failure occurs, handled by recipient.
hypervisor
memory failure at QEMU process address space. (none guest memory, but used by QEMU itself).
guest |
memory failure at guest memory, |
5.2
Actions taken by QEMU in response to a hardware memory failure.
ignore |
the memory failure could be ignored. This will only be the case for action−optional failures. | ||
inject |
memory failure occurred in guest memory, the guest enabled MCE handling mechanism, and QEMU could inject the MCE into the guest successfully. | ||
fatal |
the failure is unrecoverable. This occurs for action−required failures if the recipient is the hypervisor; QEMU will exit. | ||
reset |
the failure is unrecoverable but confined to the guest. This occurs if the recipient is a guest guest which is not ready to handle memory failures. |
5.2
Additional information on memory failures.
action−required: boolean
whether a memory failure event is action−required or action−optional (e.g. a failure during memory scrub).
recursive: boolean
whether the failure occurred while the previous failure was still in progress.
5.2
An enumeration of the options specified when enabling notify VM exit
run |
enable the feature, do nothing and continue if the notify VM exit happens. |
internal−error
enable the feature, raise a internal error if the notify VM exit happens.
disable
disable the feature.
7.2
The type of network endpoint that will be using the credentials. Most types of credential require different setup / structures depending on whether they will be used in a server versus a client.
client |
the network endpoint is acting as the client |
|||
server |
the network endpoint is acting as the server |
2.5
The data format that the secret is provided in
raw |
raw bytes. When encoded in JSON only valid UTF−8 sequences can be used | ||
base64 |
arbitrary base64 encoded binary data |
2.6
The supported algorithms for computing content digests
md5 |
MD5. Should not be used in any new code, legacy compat only |
|||
sha1 |
SHA−1. Should not be used in any new code, legacy compat only |
|||
sha224 |
SHA−224. (since 2.7) |
|||
sha256 |
SHA−256. Current recommended strong hash. |
|||
sha384 |
SHA−384. (since 2.7) |
|||
sha512 |
SHA−512. (since 2.7) |
ripemd160
RIPEMD−160. (since 2.7)
2.6
The supported algorithms for content encryption ciphers
aes−128
AES with 128 bit / 16 byte keys
aes−192
AES with 192 bit / 24 byte keys
aes−256
AES with 256 bit / 32 byte keys
des |
DES with 56 bit / 8 byte keys. Do not use except in VNC. (since 6.1) | ||
3des |
3DES(EDE) with 192 bit / 24 byte keys (since 2.9) |
cast5−128
Cast5 with 128 bit / 16 byte keys
serpent−128
Serpent with 128 bit / 16 byte keys
serpent−192
Serpent with 192 bit / 24 byte keys
serpent−256
Serpent with 256 bit / 32 byte keys
twofish−128
Twofish with 128 bit / 16 byte keys
twofish−192
Twofish with 192 bit / 24 byte keys
twofish−256
Twofish with 256 bit / 32 byte keys
2.6
The supported modes for content encryption ciphers
ecb |
Electronic Code Book |
|||
cbc |
Cipher Block Chaining |
|||
xts |
XEX with tweaked code book and ciphertext stealing |
|||
ctr |
Counter (Since 2.8) |
2.6
The supported algorithms for generating initialization vectors for full disk encryption. The 'plain' generator should not be used for disks with sector numbers larger than 2ˆ32, except where compatibility with pre−existing Linux dm−crypt volumes is required.
plain |
64−bit sector number truncated to 32−bits |
plain64
64−bit sector number
essiv |
64−bit sector number encrypted with a hash of the encryption key |
2.6
The supported full disk encryption formats
qcow |
QCow/QCow2 built−in AES−CBC encryption. Use only for liberating data from old images. | ||
luks |
LUKS encryption format. Recommended for new images |
2.6
The common options that apply to all full disk encryption formats
format: QCryptoBlockFormat
the encryption format
2.6
The options that apply to QCow/QCow2 AES−CBC encryption format
key−secret: string (optional)
the ID of a QCryptoSecret object providing the decryption key. Mandatory except when probing image for metadata only.
2.6
The options that apply to LUKS encryption format
key−secret: string (optional)
the ID of a QCryptoSecret object providing the decryption key. Mandatory except when probing image for metadata only.
2.6
The options that apply to LUKS encryption format initialization
cipher−alg: QCryptoCipherAlgorithm (optional)
the cipher algorithm for data encryption Currently defaults to 'aes−256'.
cipher−mode: QCryptoCipherMode (optional)
the cipher mode for data encryption Currently defaults to 'xts'
ivgen−alg: QCryptoIVGenAlgorithm (optional)
the initialization vector generator Currently defaults to 'plain64'
ivgen−hash−alg: QCryptoHashAlgorithm (optional)
the initialization vector generator hash Currently defaults to 'sha256'
hash−alg: QCryptoHashAlgorithm (optional)
the master key hash algorithm Currently defaults to 'sha256'
iter−time: int (optional)
number of milliseconds to spend in PBKDF passphrase processing. Currently defaults to 2000. (since 2.8)
The members of QCryptoBlockOptionsLUKS
2.6
The options that are available for all encryption formats when opening an existing volume
The members
of QCryptoBlockOptionsBase
The members of QCryptoBlockOptionsQCow when format is
"qcow"
The members of QCryptoBlockOptionsLUKS when format is
"luks"
2.6
The options that are available for all encryption formats when initializing a new volume
The members
of QCryptoBlockOptionsBase
The members of QCryptoBlockOptionsQCow when format is
"qcow"
The members of QCryptoBlockCreateOptionsLUKS when format is
"luks"
2.6
The common information that applies to all full disk encryption formats
format: QCryptoBlockFormat
the encryption format
2.7
Information about the LUKS block encryption key slot options
active: boolean
whether the key slot is currently in use
key−offset: int
offset to the key material in bytes
iters: int (optional)
number of PBKDF2 iterations for key material
stripes: int (optional)
number of stripes for splitting key material
2.7
Information about the LUKS block encryption options
cipher−alg: QCryptoCipherAlgorithm
the cipher algorithm for data encryption
cipher−mode: QCryptoCipherMode
the cipher mode for data encryption
ivgen−alg: QCryptoIVGenAlgorithm
the initialization vector generator
ivgen−hash−alg: QCryptoHashAlgorithm (optional)
the initialization vector generator hash
hash−alg: QCryptoHashAlgorithm
the master key hash algorithm
payload−offset: int
offset to the payload data in bytes
master−key−iters: int
number of PBKDF2 iterations for key material
uuid: string
unique identifier for the volume
slots: array of QCryptoBlockInfoLUKSSlot
information about each key slot
2.7
Information about the block encryption options
The members
of QCryptoBlockInfoBase
The members of QCryptoBlockInfoLUKS when format is
"luks"
2.7
Defines state of keyslots that are affected by the update
active |
The slots contain the given password and marked as active |
inactive
The slots are erased (contain garbage) and marked as inactive
5.1
This struct defines the update parameters that activate/de−activate set of keyslots
state: QCryptoBlockLUKSKeyslotState
the desired state of the keyslots
new−secret: string (optional)
The ID of a QCryptoSecret object providing the password to be written into added active keyslots
old−secret: string (optional)
Optional (for deactivation only) If given will deactivate all keyslots that match password located in QCryptoSecret with this ID
iter−time: int (optional)
Optional (for activation only) Number of milliseconds to spend in PBKDF passphrase processing for the newly activated keyslot. Currently defaults to 2000.
keyslot: int (optional)
Optional. ID of the keyslot to activate/deactivate. For keyslot activation, keyslot should not be active already (this is unsafe to update an active keyslot), but possible if 'force' parameter is given. If keyslot is not given, first free keyslot will be written.
For keyslot deactivation, this parameter specifies the exact keyslot to deactivate
secret: string (optional)
Optional. The ID of a QCryptoSecret object providing the password to use to retrieve current master key. Defaults to the same secret that was used to open the image
5.1
The options that are available for all encryption formats when amending encryption settings
The members
of QCryptoBlockOptionsBase
The members of QCryptoBlockAmendOptionsLUKS when format is
"luks"
5.1
Properties for objects of classes derived from secret−common.
loaded: boolean (optional)
if true, the secret is loaded immediately when applying this option and will probably fail when processing the next option. Don't use; only provided for compatibility. (default: false)
format: QCryptoSecretFormat (optional)
the data format that the secret is provided in (default: raw)
keyid: string (optional)
the name of another secret that should be used to decrypt the provided data. If not present, the data is assumed to be unencrypted.
iv: string (optional)
the random initialization vector used for encryption of this particular secret. Should be a base64 encrypted string of the 16−byte IV. Mandatory if keyid is given. Ignored if keyid is absent.
deprecated
Member loaded is deprecated. Setting true doesn't make sense, and false is already the default.
2.6
Properties for secret objects.
Either data or file must be provided, but not both.
data: string (optional)
the associated with the secret from
file: string (optional)
the filename to load the data associated with the secret from
The members of SecretCommonProperties
2.6
Properties for secret_keyring objects.
serial: int
serial number that identifies a key to get from the kernel
The members of SecretCommonProperties
5.1
Properties for objects of classes derived from tls−creds.
verify−peer: boolean (optional)
if true the peer credentials will be verified once the handshake is completed. This is a no−op for anonymous credentials. (default: true)
dir: string (optional)
the path of the directory that contains the credential files
endpoint: QCryptoTLSCredsEndpoint (optional)
whether the QEMU network backend that uses the credentials will be acting as a client or as a server (default: client)
priority: string (optional)
a gnutls priority string as described at https://gnutls.org/manual/html_node/Priority−Strings.html
2.5
Properties for tls−creds−anon objects.
loaded: boolean (optional)
if true, the credentials are loaded immediately when applying this option and will ignore options that are processed later. Don't use; only provided for compatibility. (default: false)
The members of TlsCredsProperties
deprecated
Member loaded is deprecated. Setting true doesn't make sense, and false is already the default.
2.5
Properties for tls−creds−psk objects.
loaded: boolean (optional)
if true, the credentials are loaded immediately when applying this option and will ignore options that are processed later. Don't use; only provided for compatibility. (default: false)
username: string (optional)
the username which will be sent to the server. For clients only. If absent, "qemu" is sent and the property will read back as an empty string.
The members of TlsCredsProperties
deprecated
Member loaded is deprecated. Setting true doesn't make sense, and false is already the default.
3.0
Properties for tls−creds−x509 objects.
loaded: boolean (optional)
if true, the credentials are loaded immediately when applying this option and will ignore options that are processed later. Don't use; only provided for compatibility. (default: false)
sanity−check: boolean (optional)
if true, perform some sanity checks before using the credentials (default: true)
passwordid: string (optional)
For the server−key.pem and client−key.pem files which contain sensitive private keys, it is possible to use an encrypted version by providing the passwordid parameter. This provides the ID of a previously created secret object containing the password for decryption.
The members of TlsCredsProperties
deprecated
Member loaded is deprecated. Setting true doesn't make sense, and false is already the default.
2.5
The supported algorithms for asymmetric encryption ciphers
rsa |
RSA algorithm |
7.1
The type of asymmetric keys.
public |
Not documented |
private
Not documented
7.1
The padding algorithm for RSA.
raw |
no padding used |
|||
pkcs1 |
pkcs1#v1.5 |
7.1
Specific parameters for RSA algorithm.
hash−alg: QCryptoHashAlgorithm
QCryptoHashAlgorithm
padding−alg: QCryptoRSAPaddingAlgorithm
QCryptoRSAPaddingAlgorithm
7.1
The options that are available for all asymmetric key algorithms when creating a new QCryptoAkCipher.
alg: QCryptoAkCipherAlgorithm
Not documented
The members of QCryptoAkCipherOptionsRSA when alg is "rsa"
7.1
Type of a background job.
commit |
block commit job type, see "block−commit" | ||
stream |
block stream job type, see "block−stream" | ||
mirror |
drive mirror job type, see "drive−mirror" | ||
backup |
drive backup job type, see "drive−backup" | ||
create |
image creation job type, see "blockdev−create" (since 3.0) | ||
amend |
image options amend job type, see "x−blockdev−amend" (since 5.1) |
snapshot−load
snapshot load job type, see "snapshot−load" (since 6.0)
snapshot−save
snapshot save job type, see "snapshot−save" (since 6.0)
snapshot−delete
snapshot delete job type, see "snapshot−delete" (since 6.0)
1.7
Indicates the present state of a given job in its lifetime.
undefined
Erroneous, default state. Should not ever be visible.
created
The job has been created, but not yet started.
running
The job is currently running.
paused |
The job is running, but paused. The pause may be requested by either the QMP user or by internal processes. | ||
ready |
The job is running, but is ready for the user to signal completion. This is used for long−running jobs like mirror that are designed to run indefinitely. |
standby
The job is ready, but paused. This is nearly identical to paused. The job may return to ready or otherwise be canceled.
waiting
The job is waiting for other jobs in the transaction to converge to the waiting state. This status will likely not be visible for the last job in a transaction.
pending
The job has finished its work, but has finalization steps that it needs to make prior to completing. These changes will require manual intervention via job−finalize if auto−finalize was set to false. These pending changes may still fail.
aborting
The job is in the process of being aborted, and will finish with an error. The job will afterwards report that it is concluded. This status may not be visible to the management process.
concluded
The job has finished all work. If auto−dismiss was set to false, the job will remain in the query list until it is dismissed via job−dismiss.
null |
The job is in the process of being dismantled. This state should not ever be visible externally. |
2.12
Represents command verbs that can be applied to a job.
cancel |
see job−cancel |
|||
pause |
see job−pause |
|||
resume |
see job−resume |
set−speed
see block−job−set−speed
complete
see job−complete
dismiss
see job−dismiss
finalize
see job−finalize
2.12
Emitted when a job transitions to a different status.
id: string
The job identifier
status: JobStatus
The new job status
3.0
Pause an active job.
This command returns immediately after marking the active job for pausing. Pausing an already paused job is an error.
The job will pause as soon as possible, which means transitioning into the PAUSED state if it was RUNNING, or into STANDBY if it was READY. The corresponding JOB_STATUS_CHANGE event will be emitted.
Cancelling a paused job automatically resumes it.
id: string
The job identifier.
3.0
Resume a paused job.
This command returns immediately after resuming a paused job. Resuming an already running job is an error.
id: string
The job identifier.
3.0
Instruct an active background job to cancel at the next opportunity. This command returns immediately after marking the active job for cancellation.
The job will cancel as soon as possible and then emit a JOB_STATUS_CHANGE event. Usually, the status will change to ABORTING, but it is possible that a job successfully completes (e.g. because it was almost done and there was no opportunity to cancel earlier than completing the job) and transitions to PENDING instead.
id: string
The job identifier.
3.0
Manually trigger completion of an active job in the READY state.
id: string
The job identifier.
3.0
Deletes a job that is in the CONCLUDED state. This command only needs to be run explicitly for jobs that don't have automatic dismiss enabled.
This command will refuse to operate on any job that has not yet reached its terminal state, JOB_STATUS_CONCLUDED. For jobs that make use of JOB_READY event, job−cancel or job−complete will still need to be used as appropriate.
id: string
The job identifier.
3.0
Instructs all jobs in a transaction (or a single job if it is not part of any transaction) to finalize any graph changes and do any necessary cleanup. This command requires that all involved jobs are in the PENDING state.
For jobs in a transaction, instructing one job to finalize will force ALL jobs in the transaction to finalize, so it is only necessary to instruct a single member job to finalize.
id: string
The identifier of any job in the transaction, or of a job that is not part of any transaction.
3.0
Information about a job.
id: string
The job identifier
type: JobType
The kind of job that is being performed
status: JobStatus
Current job state/status
current−progress: int
Progress made until now. The unit is arbitrary and the value can only meaningfully be used for the ratio of current−progress to total−progress. The value is monotonically increasing.
total−progress: int
Estimated current−progress value at the completion of the job. This value can arbitrarily change while the job is running, in both directions.
error: string (optional)
If this field is present, the job failed; if it is still missing in the CONCLUDED state, this indicates successful completion.
The value is a human−readable error message to describe the reason for the job failure. It should not be parsed by applications.
3.0
Return information about jobs.
a list with a JobInfo for each active job
3.0
id: string
unique snapshot id
name: string
user chosen name
vm−state−size: int
size of the VM state
date−sec: int
UTC date of the snapshot in seconds
date−nsec: int
fractional part in nano seconds to be used with date−sec
vm−clock−sec: int
VM clock relative to boot in seconds
vm−clock−nsec: int
fractional part in nano seconds to be used with vm−clock−sec
icount: int (optional)
Current instruction count. Appears when execution record/replay is enabled. Used for "time−traveling" to match the moment in the recorded execution with the snapshots. This counter may be obtained through query−replay command (since 5.2)
1.3
format: BlockdevQcow2EncryptionFormat
The encryption format
2.10
The members
of ImageInfoSpecificQCow2EncryptionBase
The members of QCryptoBlockInfoLUKS when format is
"luks"
2.10
compat: string
compatibility level
data−file: string (optional)
the filename of the external data file that is stored in the image and used as a default for opening the image (since: 4.0)
data−file−raw: boolean (optional)
True if the external data file must stay valid as a standalone (read−only) raw image without looking at qcow2 metadata (since: 4.0)
extended−l2: boolean (optional)
true if the image has extended L2 entries; only valid for compat >= 1.1 (since 5.2)
lazy−refcounts: boolean (optional)
on or off; only valid for compat >= 1.1
corrupt: boolean (optional)
true if the image has been marked corrupt; only valid for compat >= 1.1 (since 2.2)
refcount−bits: int
width of a refcount entry in bits (since 2.3)
encrypt: ImageInfoSpecificQCow2Encryption (optional)
details about encryption parameters; only set if image is encrypted (since 2.10)
bitmaps: array of Qcow2BitmapInfo (optional)
A list of qcow2 bitmap details (since 4.0)
compression−type: Qcow2CompressionType
the image cluster compression method (since 5.1)
1.7
create−type: string
The create type of VMDK image
cid: int
Content id of image
parent−cid: int
Parent VMDK image's cid
extents: array of VmdkExtentInfo
List of extent files
1.7
Information about a VMDK extent file
filename: string
Name of the extent file
format: string
Extent type (e.g. FLAT or SPARSE)
virtual−size: int
Number of bytes covered by this extent
cluster−size: int (optional)
Cluster size in bytes (for non−flat extents)
compressed: boolean (optional)
Whether this extent contains compressed data
8.0
encryption−format: RbdImageEncryptionFormat (optional)
Image encryption format
6.1
extent−size−hint: int (optional)
Extent size hint (if available)
8.0
luks |
Since 2.7 |
|||
rbd |
Since 6.1 |
|||
file |
Since 8.0 |
|||
qcow2 |
Not documented |
|||
vmdk |
Not documented |
1.7
data: ImageInfoSpecificQCow2
Not documented
1.7
data: ImageInfoSpecificVmdk
Not documented
6.1
data: QCryptoBlockInfoLUKS
Not documented
2.7
data: ImageInfoSpecificRbd
Not documented
6.1
data: ImageInfoSpecificFile
Not documented
8.0
A discriminated record of image format specific information structures.
type: ImageInfoSpecificKind
Not documented
The members of
ImageInfoSpecificQCow2Wrapper when type is "qcow2"
The members of ImageInfoSpecificVmdkWrapper when type is
"vmdk"
The members of ImageInfoSpecificLUKSWrapper when type is
"luks"
The members of ImageInfoSpecificRbdWrapper when type is
"rbd"
The members of ImageInfoSpecificFileWrapper when type is
"file"
1.7
Information about a QEMU image file
filename: string
name of the image file
format: string
format of the image file
virtual−size: int
maximum capacity in bytes of the image
actual−size: int (optional)
actual size on disk in bytes of the image
dirty−flag: boolean (optional)
true if image is not cleanly closed
cluster−size: int (optional)
size of a cluster in bytes
encrypted: boolean (optional)
true if the image is encrypted
compressed: boolean (optional)
true if the image is compressed (Since 1.7)
backing−filename: string (optional)
name of the backing file
full−backing−filename: string (optional)
full path of the backing file
backing−filename−format: string (optional)
the format of the backing file
snapshots: array of SnapshotInfo (optional)
list of VM snapshots
format−specific: ImageInfoSpecific (optional)
structure supplying additional format−specific information (since 1.7)
8.0
Information about a QEMU image file, and potentially its backing image
backing−image: ImageInfo (optional)
info of the backing image
The members of BlockNodeInfo
1.3
Information about all nodes in the block graph starting at some node, annotated with information about that node in relation to its parent.
name: string
Child name of the root node in the BlockGraphInfo struct, in its role as the child of some undescribed parent node
info: BlockGraphInfo
Block graph information starting at this node
8.0
Information about all nodes in a block (sub)graph in the form of BlockNodeInfo data. The base BlockNodeInfo struct contains the information for the (sub)graph's root node.
children: array of BlockChildInfo
Array of links to this node's child nodes' information
The members of BlockNodeInfo
8.0
Information about a QEMU image file check
filename: string
name of the image file checked
format: string
format of the image file checked
check−errors: int
number of unexpected errors occurred during check
image−end−offset: int (optional)
offset (in bytes) where the image ends, this field is present if the driver for the image format supports it
corruptions: int (optional)
number of corruptions found during the check if any
leaks: int (optional)
number of leaks found during the check if any
corruptions−fixed: int (optional)
number of corruptions fixed during the check if any
leaks−fixed: int (optional)
number of leaks fixed during the check if any
total−clusters: int (optional)
total number of clusters, this field is present if the driver for the image format supports it
allocated−clusters: int (optional)
total number of allocated clusters, this field is present if the driver for the image format supports it
fragmented−clusters: int (optional)
total number of fragmented clusters, this field is present if the driver for the image format supports it
compressed−clusters: int (optional)
total number of compressed clusters, this field is present if the driver for the image format supports it
1.4
Mapping information from a virtual block range to a host file range
start: int
virtual (guest) offset of the first byte described by this entry
length: int
the number of bytes of the mapped virtual range
data: boolean
reading the image will actually read data from a file (in particular, if offset is present this means that the sectors are not simply preallocated, but contain actual data in raw format)
zero: boolean
whether the virtual blocks read as zeroes
depth: int
number of layers (0 = top image, 1 = top image's backing file, ..., n − 1 = bottom image (where n is the number of images in the chain)) before reaching one for which the range is allocated
present: boolean
true if this layer provides the data, false if adding a backing layer could impact this region (since 6.1)
offset: int (optional)
if present, the image file stores the data for this range in raw format at the given (host) offset
filename: string (optional)
filename that is referred to by offset
2.6
Cache mode information for a block device
writeback: boolean
true if writeback mode is enabled
direct: boolean
true if the host page cache is bypassed (O_DIRECT)
no−flush: boolean
true if flush requests are ignored for the device
2.3
Information about the backing device for a block device.
file: string
the filename of the backing device
node−name: string (optional)
the name of the block driver node (Since 2.0)
ro: boolean
true if the backing device was open read−only
drv: string
the name of the block format used to open the backing device. As of 0.14 this can be: 'blkdebug', 'bochs', 'cloop', 'cow', 'dmg', 'file', 'file', 'ftp', 'ftps', 'host_cdrom', 'host_device', 'http', 'https', 'luks', 'nbd', 'parallels', 'qcow', 'qcow2', 'raw', 'vdi', 'vmdk', 'vpc', 'vvfat' 2.2: 'archipelago' added, 'cow' dropped 2.3: 'host_floppy' deprecated 2.5: 'host_floppy' dropped 2.6: 'luks' added 2.8: 'replication' added, 'tftp' dropped 2.9: 'archipelago' dropped
backing_file: string (optional)
the name of the backing file (for copy−on−write)
backing_file_depth: int
number of files in the backing file chain (since: 1.2)
encrypted: boolean
true if the backing device is encrypted
detect_zeroes: BlockdevDetectZeroesOptions
detect and optimize zero writes (Since 2.1)
bps: int
total throughput limit in bytes per second is specified
bps_rd: int
read throughput limit in bytes per second is specified
bps_wr: int
write throughput limit in bytes per second is specified
iops: int
total I/O operations per second is specified
iops_rd: int
read I/O operations per second is specified
iops_wr: int
write I/O operations per second is specified
image: ImageInfo
the info of image used (since: 1.6)
bps_max: int (optional)
total throughput limit during bursts, in bytes (Since 1.7)
bps_rd_max: int (optional)
read throughput limit during bursts, in bytes (Since 1.7)
bps_wr_max: int (optional)
write throughput limit during bursts, in bytes (Since 1.7)
iops_max: int (optional)
total I/O operations per second during bursts, in bytes (Since 1.7)
iops_rd_max: int (optional)
read I/O operations per second during bursts, in bytes (Since 1.7)
iops_wr_max: int (optional)
write I/O operations per second during bursts, in bytes (Since 1.7)
bps_max_length: int (optional)
maximum length of the bps_max burst period, in seconds. (Since 2.6)
bps_rd_max_length: int (optional)
maximum length of the bps_rd_max burst period, in seconds. (Since 2.6)
bps_wr_max_length: int (optional)
maximum length of the bps_wr_max burst period, in seconds. (Since 2.6)
iops_max_length: int (optional)
maximum length of the iops burst period, in seconds. (Since 2.6)
iops_rd_max_length: int (optional)
maximum length of the iops_rd_max burst period, in seconds. (Since 2.6)
iops_wr_max_length: int (optional)
maximum length of the iops_wr_max burst period, in seconds. (Since 2.6)
iops_size: int (optional)
an I/O size in bytes (Since 1.7)
group: string (optional)
throttle group name (Since 2.4)
cache: BlockdevCacheInfo
the cache mode used for the block device (since: 2.3)
write_threshold: int
configured write threshold for the device. 0 if disabled. (Since 2.3)
dirty−bitmaps: array of BlockDirtyInfo (optional)
dirty bitmaps information (only present if node has one or more dirty bitmaps) (Since 4.2)
0.14
An enumeration of block device I/O status.
ok |
The last I/O operation has succeeded |
|||
failed |
The last I/O operation has failed |
nospace
The last I/O operation has failed due to a no−space condition
1.0
Block dirty bitmap information.
name: string (optional)
the name of the dirty bitmap (Since 2.4)
count: int
number of dirty bytes according to the dirty bitmap
granularity: int
granularity of the dirty bitmap in bytes (since 1.4)
recording: boolean
true if the bitmap is recording new writes from the guest. (since 4.0)
busy: boolean
true if the bitmap is in−use by some operation (NBD or jobs) and cannot be modified via QMP or used by another operation. (since 4.0)
persistent: boolean
true if the bitmap was stored on disk, is scheduled to be stored on disk, or both. (since 4.0)
inconsistent: boolean (optional)
true if this is a persistent bitmap that was improperly stored. Implies persistent to be true; recording and busy to be false. This bitmap cannot be used. To remove it, use block−dirty−bitmap−remove. (Since 4.0)
1.3
An enumeration of flags that a bitmap can report to the user.
in−use |
This flag is set by any process actively modifying the qcow2 file, and cleared when the updated bitmap is flushed to the qcow2 image. The presence of this flag in an offline image means that the bitmap was not saved correctly after its last usage, and may contain inconsistent data. | ||
auto |
The bitmap must reflect all changes of the virtual disk by any application that would write to this qcow2 file. |
4.0
Qcow2 bitmap information.
name: string
the name of the bitmap
granularity: int
granularity of the bitmap in bytes
flags: array of Qcow2BitmapInfoFlags
flags of the bitmap
4.0
Block latency histogram.
boundaries: array of int
list of interval boundary values in nanoseconds, all greater than zero and in ascending order. For example, the list [10, 50, 100] produces the following histogram intervals: [0, 10), [10, 50), [50, 100), [100, +inf).
bins: array of int
list of io request counts corresponding to histogram intervals, one more element than boundaries has. For the example above, bins may be something like [3, 1, 5, 2], and corresponding histogram looks like:
5| * 4| * 3| * * 2| * * * 1| * * * * +−−−−−−−−−−−−−−−−−− 10 50 100
4.0
Block device information. This structure describes a virtual device and the backing device associated with it.
device: string
The device name associated with the virtual device.
qdev: string (optional)
The qdev ID, or if no ID is assigned, the QOM path of the block device. (since 2.10)
type: string
This field is returned only for compatibility reasons, it should not be used (always returns 'unknown')
removable: boolean
True if the device supports removable media.
locked: boolean
True if the guest has locked this device from having its media removed
tray_open: boolean (optional)
True if the device's tray is open (only present if it has a tray)
io−status: BlockDeviceIoStatus (optional)
BlockDeviceIoStatus. Only present if the device supports it and the VM is configured to stop on errors (supported device models: virtio−blk, IDE, SCSI except scsi−generic)
inserted: BlockDeviceInfo (optional)
BlockDeviceInfo describing the device if media is present
0.14
Image file size calculation information. This structure describes the size requirements for creating a new image file.
The size requirements depend on the new image file format. File size always equals virtual disk size for the 'raw' format, even for sparse POSIX files. Compact formats such as 'qcow2' represent unallocated and zero regions efficiently so file size may be smaller than virtual disk size.
The values are upper bounds that are guaranteed to fit the new image file. Subsequent modification, such as internal snapshot or further bitmap creation, may require additional space and is not covered here.
required: int
Size required for a new image file, in bytes, when copying just allocated guest−visible contents.
fully−allocated: int
Image file size, in bytes, once data has been written to all sectors, when copying just guest−visible contents.
bitmaps: int (optional)
Additional size required if all the top−level bitmap metadata in the source image were to be copied to the destination, present only when source and destination both support persistent bitmaps. (since 5.1)
2.10
Get a list of BlockInfo for all virtual block devices.
a list of BlockInfo describing each virtual block device. Filter nodes that were created implicitly are skipped over.
0.14
−> { "execute": "query−block" } <− { "return":[ { "io−status": "ok", "device":"ide0−hd0", "locked":false, "removable":false, "inserted":{ "ro":false, "drv":"qcow2", "encrypted":false, "file":"disks/test.qcow2", "backing_file_depth":1, "bps":1000000, "bps_rd":0, "bps_wr":0, "iops":1000000, "iops_rd":0, "iops_wr":0, "bps_max": 8000000, "bps_rd_max": 0, "bps_wr_max": 0, "iops_max": 0, "iops_rd_max": 0, "iops_wr_max": 0, "iops_size": 0, "detect_zeroes": "on", "write_threshold": 0, "image":{ "filename":"disks/test.qcow2", "format":"qcow2", "virtual−size":2048000, "backing_file":"base.qcow2", "full−backing−filename":"disks/base.qcow2", "backing−filename−format":"qcow2", "snapshots":[ { "id": "1", "name": "snapshot1", "vm−state−size": 0, "date−sec": 10000200, "date−nsec": 12, "vm−clock−sec": 206, "vm−clock−nsec": 30 } ], "backing−image":{ "filename":"disks/base.qcow2", "format":"qcow2", "virtual−size":2048000 } } }, "qdev": "ide_disk", "type":"unknown" }, { "io−status": "ok", "device":"ide1−cd0", "locked":false, "removable":true, "qdev": "/machine/unattached/device[23]", "tray_open": false, "type":"unknown" }, { "device":"floppy0", "locked":false, "removable":true, "qdev": "/machine/unattached/device[20]", "type":"unknown" }, { "device":"sd0", "locked":false, "removable":true, "type":"unknown" } ] }
Statistics of a block device during a given interval of time.
interval_length: int
Interval used for calculating the statistics, in seconds.
min_rd_latency_ns: int
Minimum latency of read operations in the defined interval, in nanoseconds.
min_wr_latency_ns: int
Minimum latency of write operations in the defined interval, in nanoseconds.
min_zone_append_latency_ns: int
Minimum latency of zone append operations in the defined interval, in nanoseconds (since 8.1)
min_flush_latency_ns: int
Minimum latency of flush operations in the defined interval, in nanoseconds.
max_rd_latency_ns: int
Maximum latency of read operations in the defined interval, in nanoseconds.
max_wr_latency_ns: int
Maximum latency of write operations in the defined interval, in nanoseconds.
max_zone_append_latency_ns: int
Maximum latency of zone append operations in the defined interval, in nanoseconds (since 8.1)
max_flush_latency_ns: int
Maximum latency of flush operations in the defined interval, in nanoseconds.
avg_rd_latency_ns: int
Average latency of read operations in the defined interval, in nanoseconds.
avg_wr_latency_ns: int
Average latency of write operations in the defined interval, in nanoseconds.
avg_zone_append_latency_ns: int
Average latency of zone append operations in the defined interval, in nanoseconds (since 8.1)
avg_flush_latency_ns: int
Average latency of flush operations in the defined interval, in nanoseconds.
avg_rd_queue_depth: number
Average number of pending read operations in the defined interval.
avg_wr_queue_depth: number
Average number of pending write operations in the defined interval.
avg_zone_append_queue_depth: number
Average number of pending zone append operations in the defined interval (since 8.1).
2.5
Statistics of a virtual block device or a block backing device.
rd_bytes: int
The number of bytes read by the device.
wr_bytes: int
The number of bytes written by the device.
zone_append_bytes: int
The number of bytes appended by the zoned devices (since 8.1)
unmap_bytes: int
The number of bytes unmapped by the device (Since 4.2)
rd_operations: int
The number of read operations performed by the device.
wr_operations: int
The number of write operations performed by the device.
zone_append_operations: int
The number of zone append operations performed by the zoned devices (since 8.1)
flush_operations: int
The number of cache flush operations performed by the device (since 0.15)
unmap_operations: int
The number of unmap operations performed by the device (Since 4.2)
rd_total_time_ns: int
Total time spent on reads in nanoseconds (since 0.15).
wr_total_time_ns: int
Total time spent on writes in nanoseconds (since 0.15).
zone_append_total_time_ns: int
Total time spent on zone append writes in nanoseconds (since 8.1)
flush_total_time_ns: int
Total time spent on cache flushes in nanoseconds (since 0.15).
unmap_total_time_ns: int
Total time spent on unmap operations in nanoseconds (Since 4.2)
wr_highest_offset: int
The offset after the greatest byte written to the device. The intended use of this information is for growable sparse files (like qcow2) that are used on top of a physical device.
rd_merged: int
Number of read requests that have been merged into another request (Since 2.3).
wr_merged: int
Number of write requests that have been merged into another request (Since 2.3).
zone_append_merged: int
Number of zone append requests that have been merged into another request (since 8.1)
unmap_merged: int
Number of unmap requests that have been merged into another request (Since 4.2)
idle_time_ns: int (optional)
Time since the last I/O operation, in nanoseconds. If the field is absent it means that there haven't been any operations yet (Since 2.5).
failed_rd_operations: int
The number of failed read operations performed by the device (Since 2.5)
failed_wr_operations: int
The number of failed write operations performed by the device (Since 2.5)
failed_zone_append_operations: int
The number of failed zone append write operations performed by the zoned devices (since 8.1)
failed_flush_operations: int
The number of failed flush operations performed by the device (Since 2.5)
failed_unmap_operations: int
The number of failed unmap operations performed by the device (Since 4.2)
invalid_rd_operations: int
The number of invalid read operations performed by the device (Since 2.5)
invalid_wr_operations: int
The number of invalid write operations performed by the device (Since 2.5)
invalid_zone_append_operations: int
The number of invalid zone append operations performed by the zoned device (since 8.1)
invalid_flush_operations: int
The number of invalid flush operations performed by the device (Since 2.5)
invalid_unmap_operations: int
The number of invalid unmap operations performed by the device (Since 4.2)
account_invalid: boolean
Whether invalid operations are included in the last access statistics (Since 2.5)
account_failed: boolean
Whether failed operations are included in the latency and last access statistics (Since 2.5)
timed_stats: array of BlockDeviceTimedStats
Statistics specific to the set of previously defined intervals of time (Since 2.5)
rd_latency_histogram: BlockLatencyHistogramInfo (optional)
BlockLatencyHistogramInfo. (Since 4.0)
wr_latency_histogram: BlockLatencyHistogramInfo (optional)
BlockLatencyHistogramInfo. (Since 4.0)
zone_append_latency_histogram: BlockLatencyHistogramInfo (optional)
BlockLatencyHistogramInfo. (since 8.1)
flush_latency_histogram: BlockLatencyHistogramInfo (optional)
BlockLatencyHistogramInfo. (Since 4.0)
0.14
File driver statistics
discard−nb−ok: int
The number of successful discard operations performed by the driver.
discard−nb−failed: int
The number of failed discard operations performed by the driver.
discard−bytes−ok: int
The number of bytes discarded by the driver.
4.2
NVMe driver statistics
completion−errors: int
The number of completion errors.
aligned−accesses: int
The number of aligned accesses performed by the driver.
unaligned−accesses: int
The number of unaligned accesses performed by the driver.
5.2
Block driver specific statistics
driver: BlockdevDriver
Not documented
The members of
BlockStatsSpecificFile when driver is "file"
The members of BlockStatsSpecificFile when
driver is "host_device" (If:
HAVE_HOST_BLOCK_DEVICE)
The members of BlockStatsSpecificNvme when driver is
"nvme"
4.2
Statistics of a virtual block device or a block backing device.
device: string (optional)
If the stats are for a virtual block device, the name corresponding to the virtual block device.
node−name: string (optional)
The node name of the device. (Since 2.3)
qdev: string (optional)
The qdev ID, or if no ID is assigned, the QOM path of the block device. (since 3.0)
stats: BlockDeviceStats
A BlockDeviceStats for the device.
driver−specific: BlockStatsSpecific (optional)
Optional driver−specific stats. (Since 4.2)
parent: BlockStats (optional)
This describes the file block device if it has one. Contains recursively the statistics of the underlying protocol (e.g. the host file for a qcow2 image). If there is no underlying protocol, this field is omitted
backing: BlockStats (optional)
This describes the backing block device if it has one. (Since 2.0)
0.14
Query the BlockStats for all virtual block devices.
query−nodes: boolean (optional)
If true, the command will query all the block nodes that have a node name, in a list which will include "parent" information, but not "backing". If false or omitted, the behavior is as before − query all the device backends, recursively including their "parent" and "backing". Filter nodes that were created implicitly are skipped over in this mode. (Since 2.3)
A list of BlockStats for each virtual block devices.
0.14
−> { "execute": "query−blockstats" } <− { "return":[ { "device":"ide0−hd0", "parent":{ "stats":{ "wr_highest_offset":3686448128, "wr_bytes":9786368, "wr_operations":751, "rd_bytes":122567168, "rd_operations":36772 "wr_total_times_ns":313253456 "rd_total_times_ns":3465673657 "flush_total_times_ns":49653 "flush_operations":61, "rd_merged":0, "wr_merged":0, "idle_time_ns":2953431879, "account_invalid":true, "account_failed":false } }, "stats":{ "wr_highest_offset":2821110784, "wr_bytes":9786368, "wr_operations":692, "rd_bytes":122739200, "rd_operations":36604 "flush_operations":51, "wr_total_times_ns":313253456 "rd_total_times_ns":3465673657 "flush_total_times_ns":49653, "rd_merged":0, "wr_merged":0, "idle_time_ns":2953431879, "account_invalid":true, "account_failed":false }, "qdev": "/machine/unattached/device[23]" }, { "device":"ide1−cd0", "stats":{ "wr_highest_offset":0, "wr_bytes":0, "wr_operations":0, "rd_bytes":0, "rd_operations":0 "flush_operations":0, "wr_total_times_ns":0 "rd_total_times_ns":0 "flush_total_times_ns":0, "rd_merged":0, "wr_merged":0, "account_invalid":false, "account_failed":false }, "qdev": "/machine/unattached/device[24]" }, { "device":"floppy0", "stats":{ "wr_highest_offset":0, "wr_bytes":0, "wr_operations":0, "rd_bytes":0, "rd_operations":0 "flush_operations":0, "wr_total_times_ns":0 "rd_total_times_ns":0 "flush_total_times_ns":0, "rd_merged":0, "wr_merged":0, "account_invalid":false, "account_failed":false }, "qdev": "/machine/unattached/device[16]" }, { "device":"sd0", "stats":{ "wr_highest_offset":0, "wr_bytes":0, "wr_operations":0, "rd_bytes":0, "rd_operations":0 "flush_operations":0, "wr_total_times_ns":0 "rd_total_times_ns":0 "flush_total_times_ns":0, "rd_merged":0, "wr_merged":0, "account_invalid":false, "account_failed":false } } ] }
An enumeration of possible behaviors for errors on I/O operations. The exact meaning depends on whether the I/O was initiated by a guest or by a block job
report |
for guest operations, report the error to the guest; for jobs, cancel the job | ||
ignore |
ignore the error, only report a QMP event (BLOCK_IO_ERROR or BLOCK_JOB_ERROR). The backup, mirror and commit block jobs retry the failing request later and may still complete successfully. The stream block job continues to stream and will complete with an error. | ||
enospc |
same as stop on ENOSPC, same as report otherwise. | ||
stop |
for guest operations, stop the virtual machine; for jobs, pause the job | ||
auto |
inherit the error handling policy of the backend (since: 2.7) |
1.3
An enumeration of possible behaviors for the initial synchronization phase of storage mirroring.
top |
copies data in the topmost image to the destination |
|||
full |
copies data from all images to the destination |
|||
none |
only copy data written from now on |
incremental
only copy data described by the dirty bitmap. (since: 2.4)
bitmap |
only copy data described by the dirty bitmap. (since: 4.2) Behavior on completion is determined by the BitmapSyncMode. |
1.3
An enumeration of possible behaviors for the synchronization of a bitmap when used for data copy operations.
on−success
The bitmap is only synced when the operation is successful. This is the behavior always used for 'INCREMENTAL' backups.
never |
The bitmap is never synchronized with the operation, and is treated solely as a read−only manifest of blocks to copy. | ||
always |
The bitmap is always synchronized with the operation, regardless of whether or not the operation was successful. |
4.2
An enumeration whose values tell the mirror block job when to trigger writes to the target.
background
copy data in background only.
write−blocking
when data is written to the source, write it (synchronously) to the target as well. In addition, data is copied in background just like in background mode.
3.0
Information about a long−running block device operation.
type: string
the job type ('stream' for image streaming)
device: string
The job identifier. Originally the device name but other values are allowed since QEMU 2.7
len: int
Estimated offset value at the completion of the job. This value can arbitrarily change while the job is running, in both directions.
offset: int
Progress made until now. The unit is arbitrary and the value can only meaningfully be used for the ratio of offset to len. The value is monotonically increasing.
busy: boolean
false if the job is known to be in a quiescent state, with no pending I/O. (Since 1.3)
paused: boolean
whether the job is paused or, if busy is true, will pause itself as soon as possible. (Since 1.3)
speed: int
the rate limit, bytes per second
io−status: BlockDeviceIoStatus
the status of the job (since 1.3)
ready: boolean
true if the job may be completed (since 2.2)
status: JobStatus
Current job state/status (since 2.12)
auto−finalize: boolean
Job will finalize itself when PENDING, moving to the CONCLUDED state. (since 2.12)
auto−dismiss: boolean
Job will dismiss itself when CONCLUDED, moving to the NULL state and disappearing from the query list. (since 2.12)
error: string (optional)
Error information if the job did not complete successfully. Not set if the job completed successfully. (since 2.12.1)
1.1
Return information about long−running block device operations.
a list of BlockJobInfo for each active block job
1.1
Resize a block image while a guest is running.
Either device or node−name must be set but not both.
device: string (optional)
the name of the device to get the image resized
node−name: string (optional)
graph node name to get the image resized (Since 2.0)
size: int
new image size in bytes
• |
nothing on success |
|||
• |
If device is not a valid block device, DeviceNotFound |
0.14
−> { "execute": "block_resize", "arguments": { "device": "scratch", "size": 1073741824 } } <− { "return": {} }
An enumeration that tells QEMU how to set the backing file path in a new image file.
existing
QEMU should look for an existing image file.
absolute−paths
QEMU should create a new image with absolute paths for the backing file. If there is no backing file available, the new image will not be backed either.
1.1
Either device or node−name must be set but not both.
device: string (optional)
the name of the device to take a snapshot of.
node−name: string (optional)
graph node name to generate the snapshot from (Since 2.0)
snapshot−file: string
the target of the new overlay image. If the file exists, or if it is a device, the overlay will be created in the existing file/device. Otherwise, a new file will be created.
snapshot−node−name: string (optional)
the graph node name of the new image (Since 2.0)
format: string (optional)
the format of the overlay image, default is 'qcow2'.
mode: NewImageMode (optional)
whether and how QEMU should create a new image, default is 'absolute−paths'.
node: string
device or node name that will have a snapshot taken.
overlay: string
reference to the existing block device that will become the overlay of node, as part of taking the snapshot. It must not have a current backing file (this can be achieved by passing "backing": null to blockdev−add).
2.5
Optional parameters for backup. These parameters don't affect functionality, but may significantly affect performance.
use−copy−range: boolean (optional)
Use copy offloading. Default false.
max−workers: int (optional)
Maximum number of parallel requests for the sustained background copying process. Doesn't influence copy−before−write operations. Default 64.
max−chunk: int (optional)
Maximum request length for the sustained background copying process. Doesn't influence copy−before−write operations. 0 means unlimited. If max−chunk is non−zero then it should not be less than job cluster size which is calculated as maximum of target image cluster size and 64k. Default 0.
6.0
job−id: string (optional)
identifier for the newly−created block job. If omitted, the device name will be used. (Since 2.7)
device: string
the device name or node−name of a root node which should be copied.
sync: MirrorSyncMode
what parts of the disk image should be copied to the destination (all the disk, only the sectors allocated in the topmost image, from a dirty bitmap, or only new I/O).
speed: int (optional)
the maximum speed, in bytes per second. The default is 0, for unlimited.
bitmap: string (optional)
The name of a dirty bitmap to use. Must be present if sync is "bitmap" or "incremental". Can be present if sync is "full" or "top". Must not be present otherwise. (Since 2.4 (drive−backup), 3.1 (blockdev−backup))
bitmap−mode: BitmapSyncMode (optional)
Specifies the type of data the bitmap should contain after the operation concludes. Must be present if a bitmap was provided, Must NOT be present otherwise. (Since 4.2)
compress: boolean (optional)
true to compress data, if the target format supports it. (default: false) (since 2.8)
on−source−error: BlockdevOnError (optional)
the action to take on an error on the source, default 'report'. 'stop' and 'enospc' can only be used if the block device supports io−status (see BlockInfo).
on−target−error: BlockdevOnError (optional)
the action to take on an error on the target, default 'report' (no limitations, since this applies to a different block device than device).
auto−finalize: boolean (optional)
When false, this job will wait in a PENDING state after it has finished its work, waiting for block−job−finalize before making any block graph changes. When true, this job will automatically perform its abort or commit actions. Defaults to true. (Since 2.12)
auto−dismiss: boolean (optional)
When false, this job will wait in a CONCLUDED state after it has completely ceased all work, and awaits block−job−dismiss. When true, this job will automatically disappear from the query list without user intervention. Defaults to true. (Since 2.12)
filter−node−name: string (optional)
the node name that should be assigned to the filter driver that the backup job inserts into the graph above node specified by drive. If this option is not given, a node name is autogenerated. (Since: 4.2)
x−perf: BackupPerf (optional)
Performance options. (Since 6.0)
unstable
Member x−perf is experimental.
on−source−error and on−target−error only affect background I/O. If an error occurs during a guest write request, the device's rerror/werror actions will be used.
4.2
target: string
the target of the new image. If the file exists, or if it is a device, the existing file/device will be used as the new destination. If it does not exist, a new file will be created.
format: string (optional)
the format of the new destination, default is to probe if mode is 'existing', else the format of the source
mode: NewImageMode (optional)
whether and how QEMU should create a new image, default is 'absolute−paths'.
The members of BackupCommon
1.6
target: string
the device name or node−name of the backup target node.
The members of BackupCommon
2.3
Takes a synchronous snapshot of a block device.
For the arguments, see the documentation of BlockdevSnapshotSync.
• |
nothing on success |
|||
• |
If device is not a valid block device, DeviceNotFound |
0.14
−> { "execute": "blockdev−snapshot−sync", "arguments": { "device": "ide−hd0", "snapshot−file": "/some/place/my−image", "format": "qcow2" } } <− { "return": {} }
Takes a snapshot of a block device.
Take a snapshot, by installing 'node' as the backing image of 'overlay'. Additionally, if 'node' is associated with a block device, the block device changes to using 'overlay' as its new active image.
For the arguments, see the documentation of BlockdevSnapshot.
allow−write−only−overlay
If present, the check whether this operation is safe was relaxed so that it can be used to change backing file of a destination of a blockdev−mirror. (since 5.0)
2.5
−> { "execute": "blockdev−add", "arguments": { "driver": "qcow2", "node−name": "node1534", "file": { "driver": "file", "filename": "hd1.qcow2" }, "backing": null } } <− { "return": {} } −> { "execute": "blockdev−snapshot", "arguments": { "node": "ide−hd0", "overlay": "node1534" } } <− { "return": {} }
Change the backing file in the image file metadata. This does not cause QEMU to reopen the image file to reparse the backing filename (it may, however, perform a reopen to change permissions from r/o −> r/w −> r/o, if needed). The new backing file string is written into the image file metadata, and the QEMU internal strings are updated.
image−node−name: string
The name of the block driver state node of the image to modify. The "device" argument is used to verify "image−node−name" is in the chain described by "device".
device: string
The device name or node−name of the root node that owns image−node−name.
backing−file: string
The string to write as the backing file. This string is not validated, so care should be taken when specifying the string or the image chain may not be able to be reopened again.
• |
Nothing on success |
|||
• |
If "device" does not exist or cannot be determined, DeviceNotFound |
2.1
Live commit of data from overlay image nodes into backing nodes − i.e., writes data between 'top' and 'base' into 'base'.
If top == base, that is an error. If top has no overlays on top of it, or if it is in use by a writer, the job will not be completed by itself. The user needs to complete the job with the block−job−complete command after getting the ready event. (Since 2.0)
If the base image is smaller than top, then the base image will be resized to be the same size as top. If top is smaller than the base image, the base will not be truncated. If you want the base image size to match the size of the smaller top, you can safely truncate it yourself once the commit operation successfully completes.
job−id: string (optional)
identifier for the newly−created block job. If omitted, the device name will be used. (Since 2.7)
device: string
the device name or node−name of a root node
base−node: string (optional)
The node name of the backing image to write data into. If not specified, this is the deepest backing image. (since: 3.1)
base: string (optional)
Same as base−node, except that it is a file name rather than a node name. This must be the exact filename string that was used to open the node; other strings, even if addressing the same file, are not accepted
top−node: string (optional)
The node name of the backing image within the image chain which contains the topmost data to be committed down. If not specified, this is the active layer. (since: 3.1)
top: string (optional)
Same as top−node, except that it is a file name rather than a node name. This must be the exact filename string that was used to open the node; other strings, even if addressing the same file, are not accepted
backing−file: string (optional)
The backing file string to write into the overlay image of 'top'. If 'top' does not have an overlay image, or if 'top' is in use by a writer, specifying a backing file string is an error.
This filename is not validated. If a pathname string is such that it cannot be resolved by QEMU, that means that subsequent QMP or HMP commands must use node−names for the image in question, as filename lookup methods will fail.
If not specified, QEMU will automatically determine the backing file string to use, or error out if there is no obvious choice. Care should be taken when specifying the string, to specify a valid filename or protocol. (Since 2.1)
speed: int (optional)
the maximum speed, in bytes per second
on−error: BlockdevOnError (optional)
the action to take on an error. 'ignore' means that the request should be retried. (default: report; Since: 5.0)
filter−node−name: string (optional)
the node name that should be assigned to the filter driver that the commit job inserts into the graph above top. If this option is not given, a node name is autogenerated. (Since: 2.9)
auto−finalize: boolean (optional)
When false, this job will wait in a PENDING state after it has finished its work, waiting for block−job−finalize before making any block graph changes. When true, this job will automatically perform its abort or commit actions. Defaults to true. (Since 3.1)
auto−dismiss: boolean (optional)
When false, this job will wait in a CONCLUDED state after it has completely ceased all work, and awaits block−job−dismiss. When true, this job will automatically disappear from the query list without user intervention. Defaults to true. (Since 3.1)
deprecated
Members base and top are deprecated. Use base−node and top−node instead.
• |
Nothing on success |
|||
• |
If device does not exist, DeviceNotFound |
|||
• |
Any other error returns a GenericError. |
1.3
−> { "execute": "block−commit", "arguments": { "device": "virtio0", "top": "/tmp/snap1.qcow2" } } <− { "return": {} }
Start a point−in−time copy of a block device to a new destination. The status of ongoing drive−backup operations can be checked with query−block−jobs where the BlockJobInfo.type field has the value 'backup'. The operation can be stopped before it has completed using the block−job−cancel command.
The members of DriveBackup
deprecated
This command is deprecated. Use blockdev−backup instead.
• |
nothing on success |
|||
• |
If device is not a valid block device, GenericError |
1.6
−> { "execute": "drive−backup", "arguments": { "device": "drive0", "sync": "full", "target": "backup.img" } } <− { "return": {} }
Start a point−in−time copy of a block device to a new destination. The status of ongoing blockdev−backup operations can be checked with query−block−jobs where the BlockJobInfo.type field has the value 'backup'. The operation can be stopped before it has completed using the block−job−cancel command.
The members of BlockdevBackup
• |
nothing on success |
|||
• |
If device is not a valid block device, DeviceNotFound |
2.3
−> { "execute": "blockdev−backup", "arguments": { "device": "src−id", "sync": "full", "target": "tgt−id" } } <− { "return": {} }
Get the named block driver list
flat: boolean (optional)
Omit the nested data about backing image ("backing−image" key) if true. Default is false (Since 5.0)
the list of BlockDeviceInfo
2.0
−> { "execute": "query−named−block−nodes" } <− { "return": [ { "ro":false, "drv":"qcow2", "encrypted":false, "file":"disks/test.qcow2", "node−name": "my−node", "backing_file_depth":1, "detect_zeroes":"off", "bps":1000000, "bps_rd":0, "bps_wr":0, "iops":1000000, "iops_rd":0, "iops_wr":0, "bps_max": 8000000, "bps_rd_max": 0, "bps_wr_max": 0, "iops_max": 0, "iops_rd_max": 0, "iops_wr_max": 0, "iops_size": 0, "write_threshold": 0, "image":{ "filename":"disks/test.qcow2", "format":"qcow2", "virtual−size":2048000, "backing_file":"base.qcow2", "full−backing−filename":"disks/base.qcow2", "backing−filename−format":"qcow2", "snapshots":[ { "id": "1", "name": "snapshot1", "vm−state−size": 0, "date−sec": 10000200, "date−nsec": 12, "vm−clock−sec": 206, "vm−clock−nsec": 30 } ], "backing−image":{ "filename":"disks/base.qcow2", "format":"qcow2", "virtual−size":2048000 } } } ] }
block−backend
corresponds to BlockBackend
block−job
corresponds to BlockJob
block−driver
corresponds to BlockDriverState
4.0
id: int
Block graph node identifier. This id is generated only for x−debug−query−block−graph and does not relate to any other identifiers in Qemu.
type: XDbgBlockGraphNodeType
Type of graph node. Can be one of block−backend, block−job or block−driver−state.
name: string
Human readable name of the node. Corresponds to node−name for block−driver−state nodes; is not guaranteed to be unique in the whole graph (with block−jobs and block−backends).
4.0
Enum of base block permissions.
consistent−read
A user that has the "permission" of consistent reads is guaranteed that their view of the contents of the block device is complete and self−consistent, representing the contents of a disk at a specific point. For most block devices (including their backing files) this is true, but the property cannot be maintained in a few situations like for intermediate nodes of a commit block job.
write |
This permission is required to change the visible disk contents. |
write−unchanged
This permission (which is weaker than BLK_PERM_WRITE) is both enough and required for writes to the block node when the caller promises that the visible disk content doesn't change. As the BLK_PERM_WRITE permission is strictly stronger, either is sufficient to perform an unchanging write.
resize |
This permission is required to change the size of a block node. |
4.0
Block Graph edge description for x−debug−query−block−graph.
parent: int
parent id
child: int
child id
name: string
name of the relation (examples are 'file' and 'backing')
perm: array of BlockPermission
granted permissions for the parent operating on the child
shared−perm: array of BlockPermission
permissions that can still be granted to other users of the child while it is still attached to this parent
4.0
Block Graph − list of nodes and list of edges.
nodes: array of XDbgBlockGraphNode
Not documented
edges: array of XDbgBlockGraphEdge
Not documented
4.0
Get the block graph.
unstable
This command is meant for debugging.
4.0
Start mirroring a block device's writes to a new destination. target specifies the target of the new image. If the file exists, or if it is a device, it will be used as the new destination for writes. If it does not exist, a new file will be created. format specifies the format of the mirror image, default is to probe if mode='existing', else the format of the source.
The members of DriveMirror
• |
nothing on success |
|||
• |
If device is not a valid block device, GenericError |
1.3
−> { "execute": "drive−mirror", "arguments": { "device": "ide−hd0", "target": "/some/place/my−image", "sync": "full", "format": "qcow2" } } <− { "return": {} }
A set of parameters describing drive mirror setup.
job−id: string (optional)
identifier for the newly−created block job. If omitted, the device name will be used. (Since 2.7)
device: string
the device name or node−name of a root node whose writes should be mirrored.
target: string
the target of the new image. If the file exists, or if it is a device, the existing file/device will be used as the new destination. If it does not exist, a new file will be created.
format: string (optional)
the format of the new destination, default is to probe if mode is 'existing', else the format of the source
node−name: string (optional)
the new block driver state node name in the graph (Since 2.1)
replaces: string (optional)
with sync=full graph node name to be replaced by the new image when a whole image copy is done. This can be used to repair broken Quorum files. By default, device is replaced, although implicitly created filters on it are kept. (Since 2.1)
mode: NewImageMode (optional)
whether and how QEMU should create a new image, default is 'absolute−paths'.
speed: int (optional)
the maximum speed, in bytes per second
sync: MirrorSyncMode
what parts of the disk image should be copied to the destination (all the disk, only the sectors allocated in the topmost image, or only new I/O).
granularity: int (optional)
granularity of the dirty bitmap, default is 64K if the image format doesn't have clusters, 4K if the clusters are smaller than that, else the cluster size. Must be a power of 2 between 512 and 64M (since 1.4).
buf−size: int (optional)
maximum amount of data in flight from source to target (since 1.4).
on−source−error: BlockdevOnError (optional)
the action to take on an error on the source, default 'report'. 'stop' and 'enospc' can only be used if the block device supports io−status (see BlockInfo).
on−target−error: BlockdevOnError (optional)
the action to take on an error on the target, default 'report' (no limitations, since this applies to a different block device than device).
unmap: boolean (optional)
Whether to try to unmap target sectors where source has only zero. If true, and target unallocated sectors will read as zero, target image sectors will be unmapped; otherwise, zeroes will be written. Both will result in identical contents. Default is true. (Since 2.4)
copy−mode: MirrorCopyMode (optional)
when to copy data to the destination; defaults to 'background' (Since: 3.0)
auto−finalize: boolean (optional)
When false, this job will wait in a PENDING state after it has finished its work, waiting for block−job−finalize before making any block graph changes. When true, this job will automatically perform its abort or commit actions. Defaults to true. (Since 3.1)
auto−dismiss: boolean (optional)
When false, this job will wait in a CONCLUDED state after it has completely ceased all work, and awaits block−job−dismiss. When true, this job will automatically disappear from the query list without user intervention. Defaults to true. (Since 3.1)
1.3
node: string
name of device/node which the bitmap is tracking
name: string
name of the dirty bitmap
2.4
node: string
name of device/node which the bitmap is tracking
name: string
name of the dirty bitmap (must be less than 1024 bytes)
granularity: int (optional)
the bitmap granularity, default is 64k for block−dirty−bitmap−add
persistent: boolean (optional)
the bitmap is persistent, i.e. it will be saved to the corresponding block device image file on its close. For now only Qcow2 disks support persistent bitmaps. Default is false for block−dirty−bitmap−add. (Since: 2.10)
disabled: boolean (optional)
the bitmap is created in the disabled state, which means that it will not track drive changes. The bitmap may be enabled with block−dirty−bitmap−enable. Default is false. (Since: 4.0)
2.4
local: string
name of the bitmap, attached to the same node as target bitmap.
external: BlockDirtyBitmap
bitmap with specified node
4.1
node: string
name of device/node which the target bitmap is tracking
target: string
name of the destination dirty bitmap
bitmaps: array of BlockDirtyBitmapOrStr
name(s) of the source dirty bitmap(s) at node and/or fully specified BlockDirtyBitmap elements. The latter are supported since 4.1.
4.0
Create a dirty bitmap with a name on the node, and start tracking the writes.
• |
nothing on success |
|||
• |
If node is not a valid block device or node, DeviceNotFound |
|||
• |
If name is already taken, GenericError with an explanation |
2.4
−> { "execute": "block−dirty−bitmap−add", "arguments": { "node": "drive0", "name": "bitmap0" } } <− { "return": {} }
Stop write tracking and remove the dirty bitmap that was created with block−dirty−bitmap−add. If the bitmap is persistent, remove it from its storage too.
• |
nothing on success |
|||
• |
If node is not a valid block device or node, DeviceNotFound |
|||
• |
If name is not found, GenericError with an explanation |
|||
• |
if name is frozen by an operation, GenericError |
2.4
−> { "execute": "block−dirty−bitmap−remove", "arguments": { "node": "drive0", "name": "bitmap0" } } <− { "return": {} }
Clear (reset) a dirty bitmap on the device, so that an incremental backup from this point in time forward will only backup clusters modified after this clear operation.
• |
nothing on success |
|||
• |
If node is not a valid block device, DeviceNotFound |
|||
• |
If name is not found, GenericError with an explanation |
2.4
−> { "execute": "block−dirty−bitmap−clear", "arguments": { "node": "drive0", "name": "bitmap0" } } <− { "return": {} }
Enables a dirty bitmap so that it will begin tracking disk changes.
• |
nothing on success |
|||
• |
If node is not a valid block device, DeviceNotFound |
|||
• |
If name is not found, GenericError with an explanation |
4.0
−> { "execute": "block−dirty−bitmap−enable", "arguments": { "node": "drive0", "name": "bitmap0" } } <− { "return": {} }
Disables a dirty bitmap so that it will stop tracking disk changes.
• |
nothing on success |
|||
• |
If node is not a valid block device, DeviceNotFound |
|||
• |
If name is not found, GenericError with an explanation |
4.0
−> { "execute": "block−dirty−bitmap−disable", "arguments": { "node": "drive0", "name": "bitmap0" } } <− { "return": {} }
Merge dirty bitmaps listed in bitmaps to the target dirty bitmap. Dirty bitmaps in bitmaps will be unchanged, except if it also appears as the target bitmap. Any bits already set in target will still be set after the merge, i.e., this operation does not clear the target. On error, target is unchanged.
The resulting bitmap will count as dirty any clusters that were dirty in any of the source bitmaps. This can be used to achieve backup checkpoints, or in simpler usages, to copy bitmaps.
• |
nothing on success | ||
• |
If node is not a valid block device, DeviceNotFound | ||
• |
If any bitmap in bitmaps or target is not found, GenericError | ||
• |
If any of the bitmaps have different sizes or granularities, GenericError |
4.0
−> { "execute": "block−dirty−bitmap−merge", "arguments": { "node": "drive0", "target": "bitmap0", "bitmaps": ["bitmap1"] } } <− { "return": {} }
SHA256 hash of dirty bitmap data
sha256: string
ASCII representation of SHA256 bitmap hash
2.10
Get bitmap SHA256.
unstable
This command is meant for debugging.
• |
BlockDirtyBitmapSha256 on success | ||
• |
If node is not a valid block device, DeviceNotFound | ||
• |
If name is not found or if hashing has failed, GenericError with an explanation |
2.10
Start mirroring a block device's writes to a new destination.
job−id: string (optional)
identifier for the newly−created block job. If omitted, the device name will be used. (Since 2.7)
device: string
The device name or node−name of a root node whose writes should be mirrored.
target: string
the id or node−name of the block device to mirror to. This mustn't be attached to guest.
replaces: string (optional)
with sync=full graph node name to be replaced by the new image when a whole image copy is done. This can be used to repair broken Quorum files. By default, device is replaced, although implicitly created filters on it are kept.
speed: int (optional)
the maximum speed, in bytes per second
sync: MirrorSyncMode
what parts of the disk image should be copied to the destination (all the disk, only the sectors allocated in the topmost image, or only new I/O).
granularity: int (optional)
granularity of the dirty bitmap, default is 64K if the image format doesn't have clusters, 4K if the clusters are smaller than that, else the cluster size. Must be a power of 2 between 512 and 64M
buf−size: int (optional)
maximum amount of data in flight from source to target
on−source−error: BlockdevOnError (optional)
the action to take on an error on the source, default 'report'. 'stop' and 'enospc' can only be used if the block device supports io−status (see BlockInfo).
on−target−error: BlockdevOnError (optional)
the action to take on an error on the target, default 'report' (no limitations, since this applies to a different block device than device).
filter−node−name: string (optional)
the node name that should be assigned to the filter driver that the mirror job inserts into the graph above device. If this option is not given, a node name is autogenerated. (Since: 2.9)
copy−mode: MirrorCopyMode (optional)
when to copy data to the destination; defaults to 'background' (Since: 3.0)
auto−finalize: boolean (optional)
When false, this job will wait in a PENDING state after it has finished its work, waiting for block−job−finalize before making any block graph changes. When true, this job will automatically perform its abort or commit actions. Defaults to true. (Since 3.1)
auto−dismiss: boolean (optional)
When false, this job will wait in a CONCLUDED state after it has completely ceased all work, and awaits block−job−dismiss. When true, this job will automatically disappear from the query list without user intervention. Defaults to true. (Since 3.1)
nothing on success.
2.6
−> { "execute": "blockdev−mirror", "arguments": { "device": "ide−hd0", "target": "target0", "sync": "full" } } <− { "return": {} }
A set of parameters describing block throttling.
device: string (optional)
Block device name
id: string (optional)
The name or QOM path of the guest device (since: 2.8)
bps: int
total throughput limit in bytes per second
bps_rd: int
read throughput limit in bytes per second
bps_wr: int
write throughput limit in bytes per second
iops: int
total I/O operations per second
iops_rd: int
read I/O operations per second
iops_wr: int
write I/O operations per second
bps_max: int (optional)
total throughput limit during bursts, in bytes (Since 1.7)
bps_rd_max: int (optional)
read throughput limit during bursts, in bytes (Since 1.7)
bps_wr_max: int (optional)
write throughput limit during bursts, in bytes (Since 1.7)
iops_max: int (optional)
total I/O operations per second during bursts, in bytes (Since 1.7)
iops_rd_max: int (optional)
read I/O operations per second during bursts, in bytes (Since 1.7)
iops_wr_max: int (optional)
write I/O operations per second during bursts, in bytes (Since 1.7)
bps_max_length: int (optional)
maximum length of the bps_max burst period, in seconds. It must only be set if bps_max is set as well. Defaults to 1. (Since 2.6)
bps_rd_max_length: int (optional)
maximum length of the bps_rd_max burst period, in seconds. It must only be set if bps_rd_max is set as well. Defaults to 1. (Since 2.6)
bps_wr_max_length: int (optional)
maximum length of the bps_wr_max burst period, in seconds. It must only be set if bps_wr_max is set as well. Defaults to 1. (Since 2.6)
iops_max_length: int (optional)
maximum length of the iops burst period, in seconds. It must only be set if iops_max is set as well. Defaults to 1. (Since 2.6)
iops_rd_max_length: int (optional)
maximum length of the iops_rd_max burst period, in seconds. It must only be set if iops_rd_max is set as well. Defaults to 1. (Since 2.6)
iops_wr_max_length: int (optional)
maximum length of the iops_wr_max burst period, in seconds. It must only be set if iops_wr_max is set as well. Defaults to 1. (Since 2.6)
iops_size: int (optional)
an I/O size in bytes (Since 1.7)
group: string (optional)
throttle group name (Since 2.4)
deprecated
Member device is deprecated. Use id instead.
1.1
Limit parameters for throttling. Since some limit combinations are illegal, limits should always be set in one transaction. All fields are optional. When setting limits, if a field is missing the current value is not changed.
iops−total: int (optional)
limit total I/O operations per second
iops−total−max: int (optional)
I/O operations burst
iops−total−max−length: int (optional)
length of the iops−total−max burst period, in seconds It must only be set if iops−total−max is set as well.
iops−read: int (optional)
limit read operations per second
iops−read−max: int (optional)
I/O operations read burst
iops−read−max−length: int (optional)
length of the iops−read−max burst period, in seconds It must only be set if iops−read−max is set as well.
iops−write: int (optional)
limit write operations per second
iops−write−max: int (optional)
I/O operations write burst
iops−write−max−length: int (optional)
length of the iops−write−max burst period, in seconds It must only be set if iops−write−max is set as well.
bps−total: int (optional)
limit total bytes per second
bps−total−max: int (optional)
total bytes burst
bps−total−max−length: int (optional)
length of the bps−total−max burst period, in seconds. It must only be set if bps−total−max is set as well.
bps−read: int (optional)
limit read bytes per second
bps−read−max: int (optional)
total bytes read burst
bps−read−max−length: int (optional)
length of the bps−read−max burst period, in seconds It must only be set if bps−read−max is set as well.
bps−write: int (optional)
limit write bytes per second
bps−write−max: int (optional)
total bytes write burst
bps−write−max−length: int (optional)
length of the bps−write−max burst period, in seconds It must only be set if bps−write−max is set as well.
iops−size: int (optional)
when limiting by iops max size of an I/O in bytes
2.11
Properties for throttle−group objects.
limits: ThrottleLimits (optional)
limits to apply for this throttle group
x−iops−total: int (optional)
Not documented
x−iops−total−max: int (optional)
Not documented
x−iops−total−max−length: int (optional)
Not documented
x−iops−read: int (optional)
Not documented
x−iops−read−max: int (optional)
Not documented
x−iops−read−max−length: int (optional)
Not documented
x−iops−write: int (optional)
Not documented
x−iops−write−max: int (optional)
Not documented
x−iops−write−max−length: int (optional)
Not documented
x−bps−total: int (optional)
Not documented
x−bps−total−max: int (optional)
Not documented
x−bps−total−max−length: int (optional)
Not documented
x−bps−read: int (optional)
Not documented
x−bps−read−max: int (optional)
Not documented
x−bps−read−max−length: int (optional)
Not documented
x−bps−write: int (optional)
Not documented
x−bps−write−max: int (optional)
Not documented
x−bps−write−max−length: int (optional)
Not documented
x−iops−size: int (optional)
Not documented
unstable
All members starting with x− are aliases for the same key without x− in the limits object. This is not a stable interface and may be removed or changed incompatibly in the future. Use limits for a supported stable interface.
2.11
Copy data from a backing file into a block device.
The block streaming operation is performed in the background until the entire backing file has been copied. This command returns immediately once streaming has started. The status of ongoing block streaming operations can be checked with query−block−jobs. The operation can be stopped before it has completed using the block−job−cancel command.
The node that receives the data is called the top image, can be located in any part of the chain (but always above the base image; see below) and can be specified using its device or node name. Earlier qemu versions only allowed 'device' to name the top level node; presence of the 'base−node' parameter during introspection can be used as a witness of the enhanced semantics of 'device'.
If a base file is specified then sectors are not copied from that base file and its backing chain. This can be used to stream a subset of the backing file chain instead of flattening the entire image. When streaming completes the image file will have the base file as its backing file, unless that node was changed while the job was running. In that case, base's parent's backing (or filtered, whichever exists) child (i.e., base at the beginning of the job) will be the new backing file.
On successful completion the image file is updated to drop the backing file and the BLOCK_JOB_COMPLETED event is emitted.
In case device is a filter node, block−stream modifies the first non−filter overlay node below it to point to the new backing node instead of modifying device itself.
job−id: string (optional)
identifier for the newly−created block job. If omitted, the device name will be used. (Since 2.7)
device: string
the device or node name of the top image
base: string (optional)
the common backing file name. It cannot be set if base−node or bottom is also set.
base−node: string (optional)
the node name of the backing file. It cannot be set if base or bottom is also set. (Since 2.8)
bottom: string (optional)
the last node in the chain that should be streamed into top. It cannot be set if base or base−node is also set. It cannot be filter node. (Since 6.0)
backing−file: string (optional)
The backing file string to write into the top image. This filename is not validated.
If a pathname string is such that it cannot be resolved by QEMU, that means that subsequent QMP or HMP commands must use node−names for the image in question, as filename lookup methods will fail.
If not specified, QEMU will automatically determine the backing file string to use, or error out if there is no obvious choice. Care should be taken when specifying the string, to specify a valid filename or protocol. (Since 2.1)
speed: int (optional)
the maximum speed, in bytes per second
on−error: BlockdevOnError (optional)
the action to take on an error (default report). 'stop' and 'enospc' can only be used if the block device supports io−status (see BlockInfo). (Since 1.3)
filter−node−name: string (optional)
the node name that should be assigned to the filter driver that the stream job inserts into the graph above device. If this option is not given, a node name is autogenerated. (Since: 6.0)
auto−finalize: boolean (optional)
When false, this job will wait in a PENDING state after it has finished its work, waiting for block−job−finalize before making any block graph changes. When true, this job will automatically perform its abort or commit actions. Defaults to true. (Since 3.1)
auto−dismiss: boolean (optional)
When false, this job will wait in a CONCLUDED state after it has completely ceased all work, and awaits block−job−dismiss. When true, this job will automatically disappear from the query list without user intervention. Defaults to true. (Since 3.1)
• |
Nothing on success. |
|||
• |
If device does not exist, DeviceNotFound. |
1.1
−> { "execute": "block−stream", "arguments": { "device": "virtio0", "base": "/tmp/master.qcow2" } } <− { "return": {} }
Set maximum speed for a background block operation.
This command can only be issued when there is an active block job.
Throttling can be disabled by setting the speed to 0.
device: string
The job identifier. This used to be a device name (hence the name of the parameter), but since QEMU 2.7 it can have other values.
speed: int
the maximum speed, in bytes per second, or 0 for unlimited. Defaults to 0.
• |
Nothing on success |
|||
• |
If no background operation is active on this device, DeviceNotActive |
1.1
Stop an active background block operation.
This command returns immediately after marking the active background block operation for cancellation. It is an error to call this command if no operation is in progress.
The operation will cancel as soon as possible and then emit the BLOCK_JOB_CANCELLED event. Before that happens the job is still visible when enumerated using query−block−jobs.
Note that if you issue 'block−job−cancel' after 'drive−mirror' has indicated (via the event BLOCK_JOB_READY) that the source and destination are synchronized, then the event triggered by this command changes to BLOCK_JOB_COMPLETED, to indicate that the mirroring has ended and the destination now has a point−in−time copy tied to the time of the cancellation.
For streaming, the image file retains its backing file unless the streaming operation happens to complete just as it is being cancelled. A new streaming operation can be started at a later time to finish copying all data from the backing file.
device: string
The job identifier. This used to be a device name (hence the name of the parameter), but since QEMU 2.7 it can have other values.
force: boolean (optional)
If true, and the job has already emitted the event BLOCK_JOB_READY, abandon the job immediately (even if it is paused) instead of waiting for the destination to complete its final synchronization (since 1.3)
• |
Nothing on success |
|||
• |
If no background operation is active on this device, DeviceNotActive |
1.1
Pause an active background block operation.
This command returns immediately after marking the active background block operation for pausing. It is an error to call this command if no operation is in progress or if the job is already paused.
The operation will pause as soon as possible. No event is emitted when the operation is actually paused. Cancelling a paused job automatically resumes it.
device: string
The job identifier. This used to be a device name (hence the name of the parameter), but since QEMU 2.7 it can have other values.
• |
Nothing on success |
|||
• |
If no background operation is active on this device, DeviceNotActive |
1.3
Resume an active background block operation.
This command returns immediately after resuming a paused background block operation. It is an error to call this command if no operation is in progress or if the job is not paused.
This command also clears the error status of the job.
device: string
The job identifier. This used to be a device name (hence the name of the parameter), but since QEMU 2.7 it can have other values.
• |
Nothing on success |
|||
• |
If no background operation is active on this device, DeviceNotActive |
1.3
Manually trigger completion of an active background block operation. This is supported for drive mirroring, where it also switches the device to write to the target path only. The ability to complete is signaled with a BLOCK_JOB_READY event.
This command completes an active background block operation synchronously. The ordering of this command's return with the BLOCK_JOB_COMPLETED event is not defined. Note that if an I/O error occurs during the processing of this command: 1) the command itself will fail; 2) the error will be processed according to the rerror/werror arguments that were specified when starting the operation.
A cancelled or paused job cannot be completed.
device: string
The job identifier. This used to be a device name (hence the name of the parameter), but since QEMU 2.7 it can have other values.
• |
Nothing on success |
|||
• |
If no background operation is active on this device, DeviceNotActive |
1.3
For jobs that have already concluded, remove them from the block−job−query list. This command only needs to be run for jobs which were started with QEMU 2.12+ job lifetime management semantics.
This command will refuse to operate on any job that has not yet reached its terminal state, JOB_STATUS_CONCLUDED. For jobs that make use of the BLOCK_JOB_READY event, block−job−cancel or block−job−complete will still need to be used as appropriate.
id: string
The job identifier.
Nothing on success
2.12
Once a job that has manual=true reaches the pending state, it can be instructed to finalize any graph changes and do any necessary cleanup via this command. For jobs in a transaction, instructing one job to finalize will force ALL jobs in the transaction to finalize, so it is only necessary to instruct a single member job to finalize.
id: string
The job identifier.
Nothing on success
2.12
Determines how to handle discard requests.
ignore |
Ignore the request |
|||
unmap |
Forward as an unmap request |
2.9
Describes the operation mode for the automatic conversion of plain zero writes by the OS to driver specific optimized zero write commands.
off |
Disabled (default) | ||
on |
Enabled | ||
unmap |
Enabled and even try to unmap blocks if possible. This requires also that BlockdevDiscardOptions is set to unmap for this device. |
2.1
Selects the AIO backend to handle I/O requests
threads
Use qemu's thread pool
native |
Use native AIO backend (only Linux and Windows) |
io_uring (If: CONFIG_LINUX_IO_URING)
Use linux io_uring (since 5.0)
2.9
Includes cache−related options for block devices
direct: boolean (optional)
enables use of O_DIRECT (bypass the host page cache; default: false)
no−flush: boolean (optional)
ignore any flush requests for the device (default: false)
2.9
Drivers that are supported in block device operations.
throttle
Since 2.11
nvme |
Since 2.12 |
copy−on−read
Since 3.0
blklogwrites
Since 3.0
blkreplay
Since 4.2
compress
Since 5.0
copy−before−write
Since 6.2
snapshot−access
Since 7.0
blkdebug
Not documented
blkverify
Not documented
bochs |
Not documented |
|||
cloop |
Not documented |
|||
dmg |
Not documented |
|||
file |
Not documented |
|||
ftp |
Not documented |
|||
ftps |
Not documented |
gluster
Not documented
host_cdrom (If: HAVE_HOST_BLOCK_DEVICE)
Not documented
host_device (If: HAVE_HOST_BLOCK_DEVICE)
Not documented
http |
Not documented |
|||
https |
Not documented |
io_uring (If: CONFIG_BLKIO)
Not documented
iscsi |
Not documented |
|||
luks |
Not documented |
|||
nbd |
Not documented |
|||
nfs |
Not documented |
null−aio
Not documented
null−co
Not documented
nvme−io_uring (If: CONFIG_BLKIO)
Not documented
parallels
Not documented
preallocate
Not documented
qcow |
Not documented |
|||
qcow2 |
Not documented |
|||
qed |
Not documented |
|||
quorum |
Not documented |
|||
raw |
Not documented |
|||
rbd |
Not documented |
replication (If: CONFIG_REPLICATION)
Not documented
ssh |
Not documented |
|||
vdi |
Not documented |
|||
vhdx |
Not documented |
virtio−blk−vfio−pci (If: CONFIG_BLKIO)
Not documented
virtio−blk−vhost−user (If: CONFIG_BLKIO)
Not documented
virtio−blk−vhost−vdpa (If: CONFIG_BLKIO)
Not documented
vmdk |
Not documented |
|||
vpc |
Not documented |
|||
vvfat |
Not documented |
2.9
Driver specific block device options for the file backend.
filename: string
path to the image file
pr−manager: string (optional)
the id for the object that will handle persistent reservations for this device (default: none, forward the commands via SG_IO; since 2.11)
aio: BlockdevAioOptions (optional)
AIO backend (default: threads) (since: 2.8)
aio−max−batch: int (optional)
maximum number of requests to batch together into a single submission in the AIO backend. The smallest value between this and the aio−max−batch value of the IOThread object is chosen. 0 means that the AIO backend will handle it automatically. (default: 0, since 6.2)
locking: OnOffAuto (optional)
whether to enable file locking. If set to 'auto', only enable when Open File Descriptor (OFD) locking API is available (default: auto, since 2.10)
drop−cache: boolean (optional) (If: CONFIG_LINUX)
invalidate page cache during live migration. This prevents stale data on the migration destination with cache.direct=off. Currently only supported on Linux hosts. (default: on, since: 4.0)
x−check−cache−dropped: boolean (optional)
whether to check that page cache was dropped on live migration. May cause noticeable delays if the image file is large, do not use in production. (default: off) (since: 3.0)
dynamic−auto−read−only
If present, enabled auto−read−only means that the driver will open the image read−only at first, dynamically reopen the image file read−write when the first writer is attached to the node and reopen read−only when the last writer is detached. This allows giving QEMU write permissions only on demand when an operation actually needs write access.
unstable
Member x−check−cache−dropped is meant for debugging.
2.9
Driver specific block device options for the null backend.
size: int (optional)
size of the device in bytes.
latency−ns: int (optional)
emulated latency (in nanoseconds) in processing requests. Default to zero which completes requests immediately. (Since 2.4)
read−zeroes: boolean (optional)
if true, reads from the device produce zeroes; if false, the buffer is left unchanged. (default: false; since: 4.1)
2.9
Driver specific block device options for the NVMe backend.
device: string
PCI controller address of the NVMe device in format hhhh:bb:ss.f (host:bus:slot.function)
namespace: int
namespace number of the device, starting from 1.
Note that the PCI device must have been unbound from any host kernel driver before instructing QEMU to add the blockdev.
2.12
Driver specific block device options for the vvfat protocol.
dir: string
directory to be exported as FAT image
fat−type: int (optional)
FAT type: 12, 16 or 32
floppy: boolean (optional)
whether to export a floppy image (true) or partitioned hard disk (false; default)
label: string (optional)
set the volume label, limited to 11 bytes. FAT16 and FAT32 traditionally have some restrictions on labels, which are ignored by most operating systems. Defaults to "QEMU VVFAT". (since 2.4)
rw: boolean (optional)
whether to allow write operations (default: false)
2.9
Driver specific block device options for image format that have no option besides their data source.
file: BlockdevRef
reference to or definition of the data source block device
2.9
Driver specific block device options for LUKS.
key−secret: string (optional)
the ID of a QCryptoSecret object providing the decryption key (since 2.6). Mandatory except when doing a metadata−only probe of the image.
The members of BlockdevOptionsGenericFormat
2.9
Driver specific block device options for image format that have no option besides their data source and an optional backing file.
backing: BlockdevRefOrNull (optional)
reference to or definition of the backing file block device, null disables the backing file entirely. Defaults to the backing file stored the image file.
The members of BlockdevOptionsGenericFormat
2.9
General overlap check modes.
none |
Do not perform any checks |
constant
Perform only checks which can be done in constant time and without reading anything from disk
cached |
Perform only checks which can be done without reading anything from disk | ||
all |
Perform all available overlap checks |
2.9
Structure of flags for each metadata structure. Setting a field to 'true' makes qemu guard that structure against unintended overwriting. The default value is chosen according to the template given.
template: Qcow2OverlapCheckMode (optional)
Specifies a template mode which can be adjusted using the other flags, defaults to 'cached'
bitmap−directory: boolean (optional)
since 3.0
main−header: boolean (optional)
Not documented
active−l1: boolean (optional)
Not documented
active−l2: boolean (optional)
Not documented
refcount−table: boolean (optional)
Not documented
refcount−block: boolean (optional)
Not documented
snapshot−table: boolean (optional)
Not documented
inactive−l1: boolean (optional)
Not documented
inactive−l2: boolean (optional)
Not documented
2.9
Specifies which metadata structures should be guarded against unintended overwriting.
flags: Qcow2OverlapCheckFlags
set of flags for separate specification of each metadata structure type
mode: Qcow2OverlapCheckMode
named mode which chooses a specific set of flags
2.9
aes |
AES−CBC with plain64 initialization vectors |
2.10
format: BlockdevQcowEncryptionFormat
Not documented
The members of QCryptoBlockOptionsQCow when format is "aes"
2.10
Driver specific block device options for qcow.
encrypt: BlockdevQcowEncryption (optional)
Image decryption options. Mandatory for encrypted images, except when doing a metadata−only probe of the image.
The members of BlockdevOptionsGenericCOWFormat
2.10
aes |
AES−CBC with plain64 initialization vectors |
|||
luks |
Not documented |
2.10
format: BlockdevQcow2EncryptionFormat
Not documented
The members of
QCryptoBlockOptionsQCow when format is "aes"
The members of QCryptoBlockOptionsLUKS when format is
"luks"
2.10
Filter driver intended to be inserted between format and protocol node and do preallocation in protocol node on write.
prealloc−align: int (optional)
on preallocation, align file length to this number, default 1048576 (1M)
prealloc−size: int (optional)
how much to preallocate, default 134217728 (128M)
The members of BlockdevOptionsGenericFormat
6.0
Driver specific block device options for qcow2.
lazy−refcounts: boolean (optional)
whether to enable the lazy refcounts feature (default is taken from the image file)
pass−discard−request: boolean (optional)
whether discard requests to the qcow2 device should be forwarded to the data source
pass−discard−snapshot: boolean (optional)
whether discard requests for the data source should be issued when a snapshot operation (e.g. deleting a snapshot) frees clusters in the qcow2 file
pass−discard−other: boolean (optional)
whether discard requests for the data source should be issued on other occasions where a cluster gets freed
discard−no−unref: boolean (optional)
when enabled, data clusters will remain preallocated when they are no longer used, e.g. because they are discarded or converted to zero clusters. As usual, whether the old data is discarded or kept on the protocol level (i.e. in the image file) depends on the setting of the pass−discard−request option. Keeping the clusters preallocated prevents qcow2 fragmentation that would otherwise be caused by freeing and re−allocating them later. Besides potential performance degradation, such fragmentation can lead to increased allocation of clusters past the end of the image file, resulting in image files whose file length can grow much larger than their guest disk size would suggest. If image file length is of concern (e.g. when storing qcow2 images directly on block devices), you should consider enabling this option. (since 8.1)
overlap−check: Qcow2OverlapChecks (optional)
which overlap checks to perform for writes to the image, defaults to 'cached' (since 2.2)
cache−size: int (optional)
the maximum total size of the L2 table and refcount block caches in bytes (since 2.2)
l2−cache−size: int (optional)
the maximum size of the L2 table cache in bytes (since 2.2)
l2−cache−entry−size: int (optional)
the size of each entry in the L2 cache in bytes. It must be a power of two between 512 and the cluster size. The default value is the cluster size (since 2.12)
refcount−cache−size: int (optional)
the maximum size of the refcount block cache in bytes (since 2.2)
cache−clean−interval: int (optional)
clean unused entries in the L2 and refcount caches. The interval is in seconds. The default value is 600 on supporting platforms, and 0 on other platforms. 0 disables this feature. (since 2.5)
encrypt: BlockdevQcow2Encryption (optional)
Image decryption options. Mandatory for encrypted images, except when doing a metadata−only probe of the image. (since 2.10)
data−file: BlockdevRef (optional)
reference to or definition of the external data file. This may only be specified for images that require an external data file. If it is not specified for such an image, the data file name is loaded from the image file. (since 4.0)
The members of BlockdevOptionsGenericCOWFormat
2.9
none |
Don't check the host key at all |
|||
hash |
Compare the host key with a given hash |
known_hosts
Check the host key against the known_hosts file
2.12
md5 |
The given hash is an md5 hash |
|||
sha1 |
The given hash is an sha1 hash |
|||
sha256 |
The given hash is an sha256 hash |
2.12
type: SshHostKeyCheckHashType
The hash algorithm used for the hash
hash: string
The expected hash value
2.12
mode: SshHostKeyCheckMode
Not documented
The members of SshHostKeyHash when mode is "hash"
2.12
server: InetSocketAddress
host address
path: string
path to the image on the host
user: string (optional)
user as which to connect, defaults to current local user name
host−key−check: SshHostKeyCheck (optional)
Defines how and what to check the host key against (default: known_hosts)
2.9
Trigger events supported by blkdebug.
l1_shrink_write_table
write zeros to the l1 table to shrink image. (since 2.11)
l1_shrink_free_l2_clusters
discard the l2 tables. (since 2.11)
cor_write
a write due to copy−on−read (since 2.11)
cluster_alloc_space
an allocation of file space for a cluster (since 4.1)
none |
triggers once at creation of the blkdebug node (since 4.1) |
l1_update
Not documented
l1_grow_alloc_table
Not documented
l1_grow_write_table
Not documented
l1_grow_activate_table
Not documented
l2_load
Not documented
l2_update
Not documented
l2_update_compressed
Not documented
l2_alloc_cow_read
Not documented
l2_alloc_write
Not documented
read_aio
Not documented
read_backing_aio
Not documented
read_compressed
Not documented
write_aio
Not documented
write_compressed
Not documented
vmstate_load
Not documented
vmstate_save
Not documented
cow_read
Not documented
cow_write
Not documented
reftable_load
Not documented
reftable_grow
Not documented
reftable_update
Not documented
refblock_load
Not documented
refblock_update
Not documented
refblock_update_part
Not documented
refblock_alloc
Not documented
refblock_alloc_hookup
Not documented
refblock_alloc_write
Not documented
refblock_alloc_write_blocks
Not documented
refblock_alloc_write_table
Not documented
refblock_alloc_switch_table
Not documented
cluster_alloc
Not documented
cluster_alloc_bytes
Not documented
cluster_free
Not documented
flush_to_os
Not documented
flush_to_disk
Not documented
pwritev_rmw_head
Not documented
pwritev_rmw_after_head
Not documented
pwritev_rmw_tail
Not documented
pwritev_rmw_after_tail
Not documented
pwritev
Not documented
pwritev_zero
Not documented
pwritev_done
Not documented
empty_image_prepare
Not documented
2.9
Kinds of I/O that blkdebug can inject errors in.
read |
.bdrv_co_preadv() |
|||
write |
.bdrv_co_pwritev() |
write−zeroes
.bdrv_co_pwrite_zeroes()
discard
.bdrv_co_pdiscard()
flush |
.bdrv_co_flush_to_disk() |
block−status
.bdrv_co_block_status()
4.1
Describes a single error injection for blkdebug.
event: BlkdebugEvent
trigger event
state: int (optional)
the state identifier blkdebug needs to be in to actually trigger the event; defaults to "any"
iotype: BlkdebugIOType (optional)
the type of I/O operations on which this error should be injected; defaults to "all read, write, write−zeroes, discard, and flush operations" (since: 4.1)
errno: int (optional)
error identifier (errno) to be returned; defaults to EIO
sector: int (optional)
specifies the sector index which has to be affected in order to actually trigger the event; defaults to "any sector"
once: boolean (optional)
disables further events after this one has been triggered; defaults to false
immediately: boolean (optional)
fail immediately; defaults to false
2.9
Describes a single state−change event for blkdebug.
event: BlkdebugEvent
trigger event
state: int (optional)
the current state identifier blkdebug needs to be in; defaults to "any"
new_state: int
the state identifier blkdebug is supposed to assume if this event is triggered
2.9
Driver specific block device options for blkdebug.
image: BlockdevRef
underlying raw block device (or image file)
config: string (optional)
filename of the configuration file
align: int (optional)
required alignment for requests in bytes, must be positive power of 2, or 0 for default
max−transfer: int (optional)
maximum size for I/O transfers in bytes, must be positive multiple of align and of the underlying file's request alignment (but need not be a power of 2), or 0 for default (since 2.10)
opt−write−zero: int (optional)
preferred alignment for write zero requests in bytes, must be positive multiple of align and of the underlying file's request alignment (but need not be a power of 2), or 0 for default (since 2.10)
max−write−zero: int (optional)
maximum size for write zero requests in bytes, must be positive multiple of align, of opt−write−zero, and of the underlying file's request alignment (but need not be a power of 2), or 0 for default (since 2.10)
opt−discard: int (optional)
preferred alignment for discard requests in bytes, must be positive multiple of align and of the underlying file's request alignment (but need not be a power of 2), or 0 for default (since 2.10)
max−discard: int (optional)
maximum size for discard requests in bytes, must be positive multiple of align, of opt−discard, and of the underlying file's request alignment (but need not be a power of 2), or 0 for default (since 2.10)
inject−error: array of BlkdebugInjectErrorOptions (optional)
array of error injection descriptions
set−state: array of BlkdebugSetStateOptions (optional)
array of state−change descriptions
take−child−perms: array of BlockPermission (optional)
Permissions to take on image in addition to what is necessary anyway (which depends on how the blkdebug node is used). Defaults to none. (since 5.0)
unshare−child−perms: array of BlockPermission (optional)
Permissions not to share on image in addition to what cannot be shared anyway (which depends on how the blkdebug node is used). Defaults to none. (since 5.0)
2.9
Driver specific block device options for blklogwrites.
file: BlockdevRef
block device
log: BlockdevRef
block device used to log writes to file
log−sector−size: int (optional)
sector size used in logging writes to file, determines granularity of offsets and sizes of writes (default: 512)
log−append: boolean (optional)
append to an existing log (default: false)
log−super−update−interval: int (optional)
interval of write requests after which the log super block is updated to disk (default: 4096)
3.0
Driver specific block device options for blkverify.
test: BlockdevRef
block device to be tested
raw: BlockdevRef
raw image used for verification
2.9
Driver specific block device options for blkreplay.
image: BlockdevRef
disk image which should be controlled with blkreplay
4.2
An enumeration of quorum read patterns.
quorum |
read all the children and do a quorum vote on reads |
|||
fifo |
read only from the first child that has not failed |
2.9
Driver specific block device options for Quorum
blkverify: boolean (optional)
true if the driver must print content mismatch set to false by default
children: array of BlockdevRef
the children block devices to use
vote−threshold: int
the vote limit under which a read will fail
rewrite−corrupted: boolean (optional)
rewrite corrupted data when quorum is reached (Since 2.1)
read−pattern: QuorumReadPattern (optional)
choose read pattern and set to quorum by default (Since 2.2)
2.9
Driver specific block device options for Gluster
volume: string
name of gluster volume where VM image resides
path: string
absolute path to image file in gluster volume
server: array of SocketAddress
gluster servers description
debug: int (optional)
libgfapi log level (default '4' which is Error) (Since 2.8)
logfile: string (optional)
libgfapi log file (default /dev/stderr) (Since 2.8)
2.9
Driver specific block device options for the io_uring backend.
filename: string
path to the image file
7.2
CONFIG_BLKIO
Driver specific block device options for the nvme−io_uring backend.
path: string
path to the NVMe namespace's character device (e.g. /dev/ng0n1).
7.2
CONFIG_BLKIO
Driver specific block device options for the virtio−blk−vfio−pci backend.
path: string
path to the PCI device's sysfs directory (e.g. /sys/bus/pci/devices/0000:00:01.0).
7.2
CONFIG_BLKIO
Driver specific block device options for the virtio−blk−vhost−user backend.
path: string
path to the vhost−user UNIX domain socket.
7.2
CONFIG_BLKIO
Driver specific block device options for the virtio−blk−vhost−vdpa backend.
path: string
path to the vhost−vdpa character device.
fdset |
Member path supports the special "/dev/fdset/N" path (since 8.1) |
7.2
CONFIG_BLKIO
An enumeration of libiscsi transport types
tcp |
Not documented |
|||
iser |
Not documented |
2.9
An enumeration of header digests supported by libiscsi
crc32c |
Not documented |
|||
none |
Not documented |
crc32c−none
Not documented
none−crc32c
Not documented
2.9
transport: IscsiTransport
The iscsi transport type
portal: string
The address of the iscsi portal
target: string
The target iqn name
lun: int (optional)
LUN to connect to. Defaults to 0.
user: string (optional)
User name to log in with. If omitted, no CHAP authentication is performed.
password−secret: string (optional)
The ID of a QCryptoSecret object providing the password for the login. This option is required if user is specified.
initiator−name: string (optional)
The iqn name we want to identify to the target as. If this option is not specified, an initiator name is generated automatically.
header−digest: IscsiHeaderDigest (optional)
The desired header digest. Defaults to none−crc32c.
timeout: int (optional)
Timeout in seconds after which a request will timeout. 0 means no timeout and is the default.
Driver specific block device options for iscsi
2.9
cephx |
Not documented |
|||
none |
Not documented |
3.0
luks−any
Used for opening either luks or luks2 (Since 8.0)
luks |
Not documented |
|||
luks2 |
Not documented |
6.1
key−secret: string
ID of a QCryptoSecret object providing a passphrase for unlocking the encryption
6.1
cipher−alg: QCryptoCipherAlgorithm (optional)
The encryption algorithm
The members of RbdEncryptionOptionsLUKSBase
6.1
The members of RbdEncryptionOptionsLUKSBase
6.1
The members of RbdEncryptionOptionsLUKSBase
6.1
The members of RbdEncryptionOptionsLUKSBase
8.0
The members of RbdEncryptionCreateOptionsLUKSBase
6.1
The members of RbdEncryptionCreateOptionsLUKSBase
6.1
format: RbdImageEncryptionFormat
Encryption format.
parent: RbdEncryptionOptions (optional)
Parent image encryption options (for cloned images). Can be left unspecified if this cloned image is encrypted using the same format and secret as its parent image (i.e. not explicitly formatted) or if its parent image is not encrypted. (Since 8.0)
The members of
RbdEncryptionOptionsLUKS when format is "luks"
The members of RbdEncryptionOptionsLUKS2 when format is
"luks2"
The members of RbdEncryptionOptionsLUKSAny when format is
"luks−any"
6.1
format: RbdImageEncryptionFormat
Not documented
The members of
RbdEncryptionCreateOptionsLUKS when format is
"luks"
The members of RbdEncryptionCreateOptionsLUKS2 when format
is "luks2"
6.1
pool: string
Ceph pool name.
namespace: string (optional)
Rados namespace name in the Ceph pool. (Since 5.0)
image: string
Image name in the Ceph pool.
conf: string (optional)
path to Ceph configuration file. Values in the configuration file will be overridden by options specified via QAPI.
snapshot: string (optional)
Ceph snapshot name.
encrypt: RbdEncryptionOptions (optional)
Image encryption options. (Since 6.1)
user: string (optional)
Ceph id name.
auth−client−required: array of RbdAuthMode (optional)
Acceptable authentication modes. This maps to Ceph configuration option "auth_client_required". (Since 3.0)
key−secret: string (optional)
ID of a QCryptoSecret object providing a key for cephx authentication. This maps to Ceph configuration option "key". (Since 3.0)
server: array of InetSocketAddressBase (optional)
Monitor host address and port. This maps to the "mon_host" Ceph option.
2.9
An enumeration of replication modes.
primary
Primary mode, the vm's state will be sent to secondary QEMU.
secondary
Secondary mode, receive the vm's state from primary QEMU.
2.9
CONFIG_REPLICATION
Driver specific block device options for replication
mode: ReplicationMode
the replication mode
top−id: string (optional)
In secondary mode, node name or device ID of the root node who owns the replication node chain. Must not be given in primary mode.
The members of BlockdevOptionsGenericFormat
2.9
CONFIG_REPLICATION
An enumeration of NFS transport types
inet |
TCP transport |
2.9
Captures the address of the socket
type: NFSTransport
transport type used for NFS (only TCP supported)
host: string
host address for NFS server
2.9
Driver specific block device option for NFS
server: NFSServer
host address
path: string
path of the image on the host
user: int (optional)
UID value to use when talking to the server (defaults to 65534 on Windows and getuid() on unix)
group: int (optional)
GID value to use when talking to the server (defaults to 65534 on Windows and getgid() in unix)
tcp−syn−count: int (optional)
number of SYNs during the session establishment (defaults to libnfs default)
readahead−size: int (optional)
set the readahead size in bytes (defaults to libnfs default)
page−cache−size: int (optional)
set the pagecache size in bytes (defaults to libnfs default)
debug: int (optional)
set the NFS debug level (max 2) (defaults to libnfs default)
2.9
Driver specific block device options shared by all protocols supported by the curl backend.
url: string
URL of the image file
readahead: int (optional)
Size of the read−ahead cache; must be a multiple of 512 (defaults to 256 kB)
timeout: int (optional)
Timeout for connections, in seconds (defaults to 5)
username: string (optional)
Username for authentication (defaults to none)
password−secret: string (optional)
ID of a QCryptoSecret object providing a password for authentication (defaults to no password)
proxy−username: string (optional)
Username for proxy authentication (defaults to none)
proxy−password−secret: string (optional)
ID of a QCryptoSecret object providing a password for proxy authentication (defaults to no password)
2.9
Driver specific block device options for HTTP connections over the curl backend. URLs must start with "http://".
cookie: string (optional)
List of cookies to set; format is "name1=content1; name2=content2;" as explained by CURLOPT_COOKIE(3). Defaults to no cookies.
cookie−secret: string (optional)
ID of a QCryptoSecret object providing the cookie data in a secure way. See cookie for the format. (since 2.10)
The members of BlockdevOptionsCurlBase
2.9
Driver specific block device options for HTTPS connections over the curl backend. URLs must start with "https://".
cookie: string (optional)
List of cookies to set; format is "name1=content1; name2=content2;" as explained by CURLOPT_COOKIE(3). Defaults to no cookies.
sslverify: boolean (optional)
Whether to verify the SSL certificate's validity (defaults to true)
cookie−secret: string (optional)
ID of a QCryptoSecret object providing the cookie data in a secure way. See cookie for the format. (since 2.10)
The members of BlockdevOptionsCurlBase
2.9
Driver specific block device options for FTP connections over the curl backend. URLs must start with "ftp://".
The members of BlockdevOptionsCurlBase
2.9
Driver specific block device options for FTPS connections over the curl backend. URLs must start with "ftps://".
sslverify: boolean (optional)
Whether to verify the SSL certificate's validity (defaults to true)
The members of BlockdevOptionsCurlBase
2.9
Driver specific block device options for NBD.
server: SocketAddress
NBD server address
export: string (optional)
export name
tls−creds: string (optional)
TLS credentials ID
tls−hostname: string (optional)
TLS hostname override for certificate validation (Since 7.0)
x−dirty−bitmap: string (optional)
A metadata context name such as "qemu:dirty−bitmap:NAME" or "qemu:allocation−depth" to query in place of the traditional "base:allocation" block status (see NBD_OPT_LIST_META_CONTEXT in the NBD protocol; and yes, naming this option x−context would have made more sense) (since 3.0)
reconnect−delay: int (optional)
On an unexpected disconnect, the nbd client tries to connect again until succeeding or encountering a serious error. During the first reconnect−delay seconds, all requests are paused and will be rerun on a successful reconnect. After that time, any delayed requests and all future requests before a successful reconnect will immediately fail. Default 0 (Since 4.2)
open−timeout: int (optional)
In seconds. If zero, the nbd driver tries the connection only once, and fails to open if the connection fails. If non−zero, the nbd driver will repeat connection attempts until successful or until open−timeout seconds have elapsed. Default 0 (Since 7.0)
unstable
Member x−dirty−bitmap is experimental.
2.9
Driver specific block device options for the raw driver.
offset: int (optional)
position where the block device starts
size: int (optional)
the assumed size of the device
The members of BlockdevOptionsGenericFormat
2.9
Driver specific block device options for the throttle driver
throttle−group: string
the name of the throttle−group object to use. It must already exist.
file: BlockdevRef
reference to or definition of the data source block device
2.11
Driver specific block device options for the copy−on−read driver.
bottom: string (optional)
The name of a non−filter node (allocation−bearing layer) that limits the COR operations in the backing chain (inclusive), so that no data below this node will be copied by this filter. If option is absent, the limit is not applied, so that data from all backing layers may be copied.
The members of BlockdevOptionsGenericFormat
6.0
An enumeration of possible behaviors for copy−before−write operation failures.
break−guest−write
report the error to the guest. This way, the guest will not be able to overwrite areas that cannot be backed up, so the backup process remains valid.
break−snapshot
continue guest write. Doing so will make the provided snapshot state invalid and any backup or export process based on it will finally fail.
7.1
Driver specific block device options for the copy−before−write driver, which does so called copy−before−write operations: when data is written to the filter, the filter first reads corresponding blocks from its file child and copies them to target child. After successfully copying, the write request is propagated to file child. If copying fails, the original write request is failed too and no data is written to file child.
target: BlockdevRef
The target for copy−before−write operations.
bitmap: BlockDirtyBitmap (optional)
If specified, copy−before−write filter will do copy−before−write operations only for dirty regions of the bitmap. Bitmap size must be equal to length of file and target child of the filter. Note also, that bitmap is used only to initialize internal bitmap of the process, so further modifications (or removing) of specified bitmap doesn't influence the filter. (Since 7.0)
on−cbw−error: OnCbwError (optional)
Behavior on failure of copy−before−write operation. Default is break−guest−write. (Since 7.1)
cbw−timeout: int (optional)
Zero means no limit. Non−zero sets the timeout in seconds for copy−before−write operation. When a timeout occurs, the respective copy−before−write operation will fail, and the on−cbw−error parameter will decide how this failure is handled. Default 0. (Since 7.1)
The members of BlockdevOptionsGenericFormat
6.2
Options for creating a block device. Many options are available for all block devices, independent of the block driver:
driver: BlockdevDriver
block driver name
node−name: string (optional)
the node name of the new node (Since 2.0). This option is required on the top level of blockdev−add. Valid node names start with an alphabetic character and may contain only alphanumeric characters, '−', '.' and '_'. Their maximum length is 31 characters.
discard: BlockdevDiscardOptions (optional)
discard−related options (default: ignore)
cache: BlockdevCacheOptions (optional)
cache−related options
read−only: boolean (optional)
whether the block device should be read−only (default: false). Note that some block drivers support only read−only access, either generally or in certain configurations. In this case, the default value does not work and the option must be specified explicitly.
auto−read−only: boolean (optional)
if true and read−only is false, QEMU may automatically decide not to open the image read−write as requested, but fall back to read−only instead (and switch between the modes later), e.g. depending on whether the image file is writable or whether a writing user is attached to the node (default: false, since 3.1)
detect−zeroes: BlockdevDetectZeroesOptions (optional)
detect and optimize zero writes (Since 2.1) (default: off)
force−share: boolean (optional)
force share all permission on added nodes. Requires read−only=true. (Since 2.10)
The members of
BlockdevOptionsBlkdebug when driver is "blkdebug"
The members of BlockdevOptionsBlklogwrites when driver is
"blklogwrites"
The members of BlockdevOptionsBlkverify when driver is
"blkverify"
The members of BlockdevOptionsBlkreplay when driver is
"blkreplay"
The members of BlockdevOptionsGenericFormat when driver is
"bochs"
The members of BlockdevOptionsGenericFormat when driver is
"cloop"
The members of BlockdevOptionsGenericFormat when driver is
"compress"
The members of BlockdevOptionsCbw when driver is
"copy−before−write"
The members of BlockdevOptionsCor when driver is
"copy−on−read"
The members of BlockdevOptionsGenericFormat when driver is
"dmg"
The members of BlockdevOptionsFile when driver is
"file"
The members of BlockdevOptionsCurlFtp when driver is
"ftp"
The members of BlockdevOptionsCurlFtps when driver is
"ftps"
The members of BlockdevOptionsGluster when driver is
"gluster"
The members of BlockdevOptionsFile when driver
is "host_cdrom" (If:
HAVE_HOST_BLOCK_DEVICE)
The members of BlockdevOptionsFile when driver
is "host_device" (If:
HAVE_HOST_BLOCK_DEVICE)
The members of BlockdevOptionsCurlHttp when driver is
"http"
The members of BlockdevOptionsCurlHttps when driver is
"https"
The members of BlockdevOptionsIoUring when
driver is "io_uring" (If:
CONFIG_BLKIO)
The members of BlockdevOptionsIscsi when driver is
"iscsi"
The members of BlockdevOptionsLUKS when driver is
"luks"
The members of BlockdevOptionsNbd when driver is
"nbd"
The members of BlockdevOptionsNfs when driver is
"nfs"
The members of BlockdevOptionsNull when driver is
"null−aio"
The members of BlockdevOptionsNull when driver is
"null−co"
The members of BlockdevOptionsNVMe when driver is
"nvme"
The members of BlockdevOptionsNvmeIoUring when
driver is
"nvme−io_uring" (If:
CONFIG_BLKIO)
The members of BlockdevOptionsGenericFormat when driver is
"parallels"
The members of BlockdevOptionsPreallocate when driver is
"preallocate"
The members of BlockdevOptionsQcow2 when driver is
"qcow2"
The members of BlockdevOptionsQcow when driver is
"qcow"
The members of BlockdevOptionsGenericCOWFormat when driver
is "qed"
The members of BlockdevOptionsQuorum when driver is
"quorum"
The members of BlockdevOptionsRaw when driver is
"raw"
The members of BlockdevOptionsRbd when driver is
"rbd"
The members of BlockdevOptionsReplication when
driver is "replication"
(If: CONFIG_REPLICATION)
The members of BlockdevOptionsGenericFormat when driver is
"snapshot−access"
The members of BlockdevOptionsSsh when driver is
"ssh"
The members of BlockdevOptionsThrottle when driver is
"throttle"
The members of BlockdevOptionsGenericFormat when driver is
"vdi"
The members of BlockdevOptionsGenericFormat when driver is
"vhdx"
The members of BlockdevOptionsVirtioBlkVfioPci when
driver is
"virtio−blk−vfio−pci"
(If: CONFIG_BLKIO)
The members of BlockdevOptionsVirtioBlkVhostUser when
driver is
"virtio−blk−vhost−user"
(If: CONFIG_BLKIO)
The members of BlockdevOptionsVirtioBlkVhostVdpa when
driver is
"virtio−blk−vhost−vdpa"
(If: CONFIG_BLKIO)
The members of BlockdevOptionsGenericCOWFormat when driver
is "vmdk"
The members of BlockdevOptionsGenericFormat when driver is
"vpc"
The members of BlockdevOptionsVVFAT when driver is
"vvfat"
Remaining options are determined by the block driver.
2.9
Reference to a block device.
definition: BlockdevOptions
defines a new block device inline
reference: string
references the ID of an existing block device
2.9
Reference to a block device.
definition: BlockdevOptions
defines a new block device inline
reference: string
references the ID of an existing block device. An empty string means that no block device should be referenced. Deprecated; use null instead.
null: null
No block device should be referenced (since 2.10)
2.9
Creates a new block device.
The members of BlockdevOptions
2.9
−> { "execute": "blockdev−add", "arguments": { "driver": "qcow2", "node−name": "test1", "file": { "driver": "file", "filename": "test.qcow2" } } } <− { "return": {} } −> { "execute": "blockdev−add", "arguments": { "driver": "qcow2", "node−name": "node0", "discard": "unmap", "cache": { "direct": true }, "file": { "driver": "file", "filename": "/tmp/test.qcow2" }, "backing": { "driver": "raw", "file": { "driver": "file", "filename": "/dev/fdset/4" } } } } <− { "return": {} }
Reopens one or more block devices using the given set of options. Any option not specified will be reset to its default value regardless of its previous status. If an option cannot be changed or a particular driver does not support reopening then the command will return an error. All devices in the list are reopened in one transaction, so if one of them fails then the whole transaction is cancelled.
The command receives a list of block devices to reopen. For each one of them, the top−level node−name option (from BlockdevOptions) must be specified and is used to select the block device to be reopened. Other node−name options must be either omitted or set to the current name of the appropriate node. This command won't change any node name and any attempt to do it will result in an error.
In the case of options that refer to child nodes, the behavior of this command depends on the value:
1. |
A set of options (BlockdevOptions): the child is reopened with the specified set of options. | ||
2. |
A reference to the current child: the child is reopened using its existing set of options. | ||
3. |
A reference to a different node: the current child is replaced with the specified one. | ||
4. |
NULL: the current child (if any) is detached. |
Options (1) and (2) are supported in all cases. Option (3) is supported for file and backing, and option (4) for backing only.
Unlike with blockdev−add, the backing option must always be present unless the node being reopened does not have a backing file and its image does not have a default backing file name as part of its metadata.
options: array of BlockdevOptions
Not documented
6.1
Deletes a block device that has been added using blockdev−add. The command will fail if the node is attached to a device or is otherwise being used.
node−name: string
Name of the graph node to delete.
2.9
−> { "execute": "blockdev−add", "arguments": { "driver": "qcow2", "node−name": "node0", "file": { "driver": "file", "filename": "test.qcow2" } } } <− { "return": {} } −> { "execute": "blockdev−del", "arguments": { "node−name": "node0" } } <− { "return": {} }
Driver specific image creation options for file.
filename: string
Filename for the new image file
size: int
Size of the virtual disk in bytes
preallocation: PreallocMode (optional)
Preallocation mode for the new image (default: off; allowed values: off, falloc (if CONFIG_POSIX_FALLOCATE), full (if CONFIG_POSIX))
nocow: boolean (optional)
Turn off copy−on−write (valid only on btrfs; default: off)
extent−size−hint: int (optional)
Extent size hint to add to the image file; 0 for not adding an extent size hint (default: 1 MB, since 5.1)
2.12
Driver specific image creation options for gluster.
location: BlockdevOptionsGluster
Where to store the new image file
size: int
Size of the virtual disk in bytes
preallocation: PreallocMode (optional)
Preallocation mode for the new image (default: off; allowed values: off, falloc (if CONFIG_GLUSTERFS_FALLOCATE), full (if CONFIG_GLUSTERFS_ZEROFILL))
2.12
Driver specific image creation options for LUKS.
file: BlockdevRef
Node to create the image format on
size: int
Size of the virtual disk in bytes
preallocation: PreallocMode (optional)
Preallocation mode for the new image (since: 4.2) (default: off; allowed values: off, metadata, falloc, full)
The members of QCryptoBlockCreateOptionsLUKS
2.12
Driver specific image creation options for NFS.
location: BlockdevOptionsNfs
Where to store the new image file
size: int
Size of the virtual disk in bytes
2.12
Driver specific image creation options for parallels.
file: BlockdevRef
Node to create the image format on
size: int
Size of the virtual disk in bytes
cluster−size: int (optional)
Cluster size in bytes (default: 1 MB)
2.12
Driver specific image creation options for qcow.
file: BlockdevRef
Node to create the image format on
size: int
Size of the virtual disk in bytes
backing−file: string (optional)
File name of the backing file if a backing file should be used
encrypt: QCryptoBlockCreateOptions (optional)
Encryption options if the image should be encrypted
2.12
v2 |
The original QCOW2 format as introduced in qemu 0.10 (version 2) | ||
v3 |
The extended QCOW2 format as introduced in qemu 1.1 (version 3) |
2.12
Compression type used in qcow2 image file
zlib |
zlib compression, see <http://zlib.net/> |
zstd (If: CONFIG_ZSTD)
zstd compression, see <http://github.com/facebook/zstd>
5.1
Driver specific image creation options for qcow2.
file: BlockdevRef
Node to create the image format on
data−file: BlockdevRef (optional)
Node to use as an external data file in which all guest data is stored so that only metadata remains in the qcow2 file (since: 4.0)
data−file−raw: boolean (optional)
True if the external data file must stay valid as a standalone (read−only) raw image without looking at qcow2 metadata (default: false; since: 4.0)
extended−l2: boolean (optional)
True to make the image have extended L2 entries (default: false; since 5.2)
size: int
Size of the virtual disk in bytes
version: BlockdevQcow2Version (optional)
Compatibility level (default: v3)
backing−file: string (optional)
File name of the backing file if a backing file should be used
backing−fmt: BlockdevDriver (optional)
Name of the block driver to use for the backing file
encrypt: QCryptoBlockCreateOptions (optional)
Encryption options if the image should be encrypted
cluster−size: int (optional)
qcow2 cluster size in bytes (default: 65536)
preallocation: PreallocMode (optional)
Preallocation mode for the new image (default: off; allowed values: off, falloc, full, metadata)
lazy−refcounts: boolean (optional)
True if refcounts may be updated lazily (default: off)
refcount−bits: int (optional)
Width of reference counts in bits (default: 16)
compression−type: Qcow2CompressionType (optional)
The image cluster compression method (default: zlib, since 5.1)
2.12
Driver specific image creation options for qed.
file: BlockdevRef
Node to create the image format on
size: int
Size of the virtual disk in bytes
backing−file: string (optional)
File name of the backing file if a backing file should be used
backing−fmt: BlockdevDriver (optional)
Name of the block driver to use for the backing file
cluster−size: int (optional)
Cluster size in bytes (default: 65536)
table−size: int (optional)
L1/L2 table size (in clusters)
2.12
Driver specific image creation options for rbd/Ceph.
location: BlockdevOptionsRbd
Where to store the new image file. This location cannot point to a snapshot.
size: int
Size of the virtual disk in bytes
cluster−size: int (optional)
RBD object size
encrypt: RbdEncryptionCreateOptions (optional)
Image encryption options. (Since 6.1)
2.12
Subformat options for VMDK images
monolithicSparse
Single file image with sparse cluster allocation
monolithicFlat
Single flat data image and a descriptor file
twoGbMaxExtentSparse
Data is split into 2GB (per virtual LBA) sparse extent files, in addition to a descriptor file
twoGbMaxExtentFlat
Data is split into 2GB (per virtual LBA) flat extent files, in addition to a descriptor file
streamOptimized
Single file image sparse cluster allocation, optimized for streaming over network.
4.0
Adapter type info for VMDK images
ide |
Not documented |
buslogic
Not documented
lsilogic
Not documented
legacyESX
Not documented
4.0
Driver specific image creation options for VMDK.
file: BlockdevRef
Where to store the new image file. This refers to the image file for monolithcSparse and streamOptimized format, or the descriptor file for other formats.
size: int
Size of the virtual disk in bytes
extents: array of BlockdevRef (optional)
Where to store the data extents. Required for monolithcFlat, twoGbMaxExtentSparse and twoGbMaxExtentFlat formats. For monolithicFlat, only one entry is required; for twoGbMaxExtent* formats, the number of entries required is calculated as extent_number = virtual_size / 2GB. Providing more extents than will be used is an error.
subformat: BlockdevVmdkSubformat (optional)
The subformat of the VMDK image. Default: "monolithicSparse".
backing−file: string (optional)
The path of backing file. Default: no backing file is used.
adapter−type: BlockdevVmdkAdapterType (optional)
The adapter type used to fill in the descriptor. Default: ide.
hwversion: string (optional)
Hardware version. The meaningful options are "4" or "6". Default: "4".
toolsversion: string (optional)
VMware guest tools version. Default: "2147483647" (Since 6.2)
zeroed−grain: boolean (optional)
Whether to enable zeroed−grain feature for sparse subformats. Default: false.
4.0
Driver specific image creation options for SSH.
location: BlockdevOptionsSsh
Where to store the new image file
size: int
Size of the virtual disk in bytes
2.12
Driver specific image creation options for VDI.
file: BlockdevRef
Node to create the image format on
size: int
Size of the virtual disk in bytes
preallocation: PreallocMode (optional)
Preallocation mode for the new image (default: off; allowed values: off, metadata)
2.12
dynamic
Growing image file
fixed |
Preallocated fixed−size image file |
2.12
Driver specific image creation options for vhdx.
file: BlockdevRef
Node to create the image format on
size: int
Size of the virtual disk in bytes
log−size: int (optional)
Log size in bytes, must be a multiple of 1 MB (default: 1 MB)
block−size: int (optional)
Block size in bytes, must be a multiple of 1 MB and not larger than 256 MB (default: automatically choose a block size depending on the image size)
subformat: BlockdevVhdxSubformat (optional)
vhdx subformat (default: dynamic)
block−state−zero: boolean (optional)
Force use of payload blocks of type 'ZERO'. Non−standard, but default. Do not set to 'off' when using 'qemu−img convert' with subformat=dynamic.
2.12
dynamic
Growing image file
fixed |
Preallocated fixed−size image file |
2.12
Driver specific image creation options for vpc (VHD).
file: BlockdevRef
Node to create the image format on
size: int
Size of the virtual disk in bytes
subformat: BlockdevVpcSubformat (optional)
vhdx subformat (default: dynamic)
force−size: boolean (optional)
Force use of the exact byte size instead of rounding to the next size that can be represented in CHS geometry (default: false)
2.12
Options for creating an image format on a given node.
driver: BlockdevDriver
block driver to create the image format
The members of
BlockdevCreateOptionsFile when driver is "file"
The members of BlockdevCreateOptionsGluster when driver is
"gluster"
The members of BlockdevCreateOptionsLUKS when driver is
"luks"
The members of BlockdevCreateOptionsNfs when driver is
"nfs"
The members of BlockdevCreateOptionsParallels when driver is
"parallels"
The members of BlockdevCreateOptionsQcow when driver is
"qcow"
The members of BlockdevCreateOptionsQcow2 when driver is
"qcow2"
The members of BlockdevCreateOptionsQed when driver is
"qed"
The members of BlockdevCreateOptionsRbd when driver is
"rbd"
The members of BlockdevCreateOptionsSsh when driver is
"ssh"
The members of BlockdevCreateOptionsVdi when driver is
"vdi"
The members of BlockdevCreateOptionsVhdx when driver is
"vhdx"
The members of BlockdevCreateOptionsVmdk when driver is
"vmdk"
The members of BlockdevCreateOptionsVpc when driver is
"vpc"
2.12
Starts a job to create an image format on a given node. The job is automatically finalized, but a manual job−dismiss is required.
job−id: string
Identifier for the newly created job.
options: BlockdevCreateOptions
Options for the image creation.
3.0
Driver specific image amend options for LUKS.
The members of QCryptoBlockAmendOptionsLUKS
5.1
Driver specific image amend options for qcow2. For now, only encryption options can be amended
encrypt: QCryptoBlockAmendOptions (optional)
Encryption options to be amended
5.1
Options for amending an image format
driver: BlockdevDriver
Block driver of the node to amend.
The members of
BlockdevAmendOptionsLUKS when driver is "luks"
The members of BlockdevAmendOptionsQcow2 when driver is
"qcow2"
5.1
Starts a job to amend format specific options of an existing open block device The job is automatically finalized, but a manual job−dismiss is required.
job−id: string
Identifier for the newly created job.
node−name: string
Name of the block node to work on
options: BlockdevAmendOptions
Options (driver specific)
force: boolean (optional)
Allow unsafe operations, format specific For luks that allows erase of the last active keyslot (permanent loss of data), and replacement of an active keyslot (possible loss of data if IO error happens)
unstable
This command is experimental.
5.1
An enumeration of action that has been taken when a DISK I/O occurs
ignore |
error has been ignored |
|||
report |
error has been reported to the device |
|||
stop |
error caused VM to be stopped |
2.1
Emitted when a disk image is being marked corrupt. The image can be identified by its device or node name. The 'device' field is always present for compatibility reasons, but it can be empty ("") if the image does not have a device name associated.
device: string
device name. This is always present for compatibility reasons, but it can be empty ("") if the image does not have a device name associated.
node−name: string (optional)
node name (Since: 2.4)
msg: string
informative message for human consumption, such as the kind of corruption being detected. It should not be parsed by machine as it is not guaranteed to be stable
offset: int (optional)
if the corruption resulted from an image access, this is the host's access offset into the image
size: int (optional)
if the corruption resulted from an image access, this is the access size
fatal: boolean
if set, the image is marked corrupt and therefore unusable after this event and must be repaired (Since 2.2; before, every BLOCK_IMAGE_CORRUPTED event was fatal)
If action is "stop", a STOP event will eventually follow the BLOCK_IO_ERROR event.
<− { "event": "BLOCK_IMAGE_CORRUPTED", "data": { "device": "", "node−name": "drive", "fatal": false, "msg": "L2 table offset 0x2a2a2a00 unaligned (L1 index: 0)" }, "timestamp": { "seconds": 1648243240, "microseconds": 906060 } }
1.7
Emitted when a disk I/O error occurs
device: string
device name. This is always present for compatibility reasons, but it can be empty ("") if the image does not have a device name associated.
node−name: string (optional)
node name. Note that errors may be reported for the root node that is directly attached to a guest device rather than for the node where the error occurred. The node name is not present if the drive is empty. (Since: 2.8)
operation: IoOperationType
I/O operation
action: BlockErrorAction
action that has been taken
nospace: boolean (optional)
true if I/O error was caused due to a no−space condition. This key is only present if query−block's io−status is present, please see query−block documentation for more information (since: 2.2)
reason: string
human readable string describing the error cause. (This field is a debugging aid for humans, it should not be parsed by applications) (since: 2.2)
If action is "stop", a STOP event will eventually follow the BLOCK_IO_ERROR event
0.13
<− { "event": "BLOCK_IO_ERROR", "data": { "device": "ide0−hd1", "node−name": "#block212", "operation": "write", "action": "stop", "reason": "No space left on device" }, "timestamp": { "seconds": 1265044230, "microseconds": 450486 } }
Emitted when a block job has completed
type: JobType
job type
device: string
The job identifier. Originally the device name but other values are allowed since QEMU 2.7
len: int
maximum progress value
offset: int
current progress value. On success this is equal to len. On failure this is less than len
speed: int
rate limit, bytes per second
error: string (optional)
error message. Only present on failure. This field contains a human−readable error message. There are no semantics other than that streaming has failed and clients should not try to interpret the error string
1.1
<− { "event": "BLOCK_JOB_COMPLETED", "data": { "type": "stream", "device": "virtio−disk0", "len": 10737418240, "offset": 10737418240, "speed": 0 }, "timestamp": { "seconds": 1267061043, "microseconds": 959568 } }
Emitted when a block job has been cancelled
type: JobType
job type
device: string
The job identifier. Originally the device name but other values are allowed since QEMU 2.7
len: int
maximum progress value
offset: int
current progress value. On success this is equal to len. On failure this is less than len
speed: int
rate limit, bytes per second
1.1
<− { "event": "BLOCK_JOB_CANCELLED", "data": { "type": "stream", "device": "virtio−disk0", "len": 10737418240, "offset": 134217728, "speed": 0 }, "timestamp": { "seconds": 1267061043, "microseconds": 959568 } }
Emitted when a block job encounters an error
device: string
The job identifier. Originally the device name but other values are allowed since QEMU 2.7
operation: IoOperationType
I/O operation
action: BlockErrorAction
action that has been taken
1.3
<− { "event": "BLOCK_JOB_ERROR", "data": { "device": "ide0−hd1", "operation": "write", "action": "stop" }, "timestamp": { "seconds": 1265044230, "microseconds": 450486 } }
Emitted when a block job is ready to complete
type: JobType
job type
device: string
The job identifier. Originally the device name but other values are allowed since QEMU 2.7
len: int
maximum progress value
offset: int
current progress value. On success this is equal to len. On failure this is less than len
speed: int
rate limit, bytes per second
The "ready to complete" status is always reset by a BLOCK_JOB_ERROR event
1.3
<− { "event": "BLOCK_JOB_READY", "data": { "device": "drive0", "type": "mirror", "speed": 0, "len": 2097152, "offset": 2097152 }, "timestamp": { "seconds": 1265044230, "microseconds": 450486 } }
Emitted when a block job is awaiting explicit authorization to finalize graph changes via block−job−finalize. If this job is part of a transaction, it will not emit this event until the transaction has converged first.
type: JobType
job type
id: string
The job identifier.
2.12
<− { "event": "BLOCK_JOB_PENDING", "data": { "type": "mirror", "id": "backup_1" }, "timestamp": { "seconds": 1265044230, "microseconds": 450486 } }
Preallocation mode of QEMU image file
off |
no preallocation |
metadata
preallocate only for metadata
falloc |
like full preallocation but allocate disk space by posix_fallocate() rather than writing data. | ||
full |
preallocate all data by writing it to the device to ensure disk space is really available. This data may or may not be zero, depending on the image format and storage. full preallocation also sets up metadata correctly. |
2.2
Emitted when writes on block device reaches or exceeds the configured write threshold. For thin−provisioned devices, this means the device should be extended to avoid pausing for disk exhaustion. The event is one shot. Once triggered, it needs to be re−registered with another block−set−write−threshold command.
node−name: string
graph node name on which the threshold was exceeded.
amount−exceeded: int
amount of data which exceeded the threshold, in bytes.
write−threshold: int
last configured threshold, in bytes.
2.3
Change the write threshold for a block drive. An event will be delivered if a write to this block drive crosses the configured threshold. The threshold is an offset, thus must be non−negative. Default is no write threshold. Setting the threshold to zero disables it.
This is useful to transparently resize thin−provisioned drives without the guest OS noticing.
node−name: string
graph node name on which the threshold must be set.
write−threshold: int
configured threshold for the block device, bytes. Use 0 to disable the threshold.
2.3
−> { "execute": "block−set−write−threshold", "arguments": { "node−name": "mydev", "write−threshold": 17179869184 } } <− { "return": {} }
Dynamically reconfigure the block driver state graph. It can be used to add, remove, insert or replace a graph node. Currently only the Quorum driver implements this feature to add or remove its child. This is useful to fix a broken quorum child.
If node is specified, it will be inserted under parent. child may not be specified in this case. If both parent and child are specified but node is not, child will be detached from parent.
parent: string
the id or name of the parent node.
child: string (optional)
the name of a child under the given parent node.
node: string (optional)
the name of the node that will be added.
unstable
This command is experimental, and its API is not stable. It does not support all kinds of operations, all kinds of children, nor all block drivers.
FIXME Removing children from a quorum node means introducing gaps in the child indices. This cannot be represented in the 'children' list of BlockdevOptionsQuorum, as returned by .bdrv_refresh_filename().
Warning: The data in a new quorum child MUST be consistent with that of the rest of the array.
2.7
1. Add a new node to a quorum −> { "execute": "blockdev−add", "arguments": { "driver": "raw", "node−name": "new_node", "file": { "driver": "file", "filename": "test.raw" } } } <− { "return": {} } −> { "execute": "x−blockdev−change", "arguments": { "parent": "disk1", "node": "new_node" } } <− { "return": {} } 2. Delete a quorum's node −> { "execute": "x−blockdev−change", "arguments": { "parent": "disk1", "child": "children.1" } } <− { "return": {} }
Move node and its children into the iothread. If iothread is null then move node and its children into the main loop.
The node must not be attached to a BlockBackend.
node−name: string
the name of the block driver node
iothread: StrOrNull
the name of the IOThread object or null for the main loop
force: boolean (optional)
true if the node and its children should be moved when a BlockBackend is already attached
unstable
This command is experimental and intended for test cases that need control over IOThreads only.
2.12
1. Move a node into an IOThread −> { "execute": "x−blockdev−set−iothread", "arguments": { "node−name": "disk1", "iothread": "iothread0" } } <− { "return": {} } 2. Move a node into the main loop −> { "execute": "x−blockdev−set−iothread", "arguments": { "node−name": "disk1", "iothread": null } } <− { "return": {} }
An enumeration of the quorum operation types
read |
read operation |
|||
write |
write operation |
|||
flush |
flush operation |
2.6
Emitted by the Quorum block driver if it fails to establish a quorum
reference: string
device name if defined else node name
sector−num: int
number of the first sector of the failed read operation
sectors−count: int
failed read operation sector count
This event is rate−limited.
2.0
<− { "event": "QUORUM_FAILURE", "data": { "reference": "usr1", "sector−num": 345435, "sectors−count": 5 }, "timestamp": { "seconds": 1344522075, "microseconds": 745528 } }
Emitted to report a corruption of a Quorum file
type: QuorumOpType
quorum operation type (Since 2.6)
error: string (optional)
error message. Only present on failure. This field contains a human−readable error message. There are no semantics other than that the block layer reported an error and clients should not try to interpret the error string.
node−name: string
the graph node name of the block driver state
sector−num: int
number of the first sector of the failed read operation
sectors−count: int
failed read operation sector count
This event is rate−limited.
2.0
1. Read operation <− { "event": "QUORUM_REPORT_BAD", "data": { "node−name": "node0", "sector−num": 345435, "sectors−count": 5, "type": "read" }, "timestamp": { "seconds": 1344522075, "microseconds": 745528 } } 2. Flush operation <− { "event": "QUORUM_REPORT_BAD", "data": { "node−name": "node0", "sector−num": 0, "sectors−count": 2097120, "type": "flush", "error": "Broken pipe" }, "timestamp": { "seconds": 1456406829, "microseconds": 291763 } }
device: string
the device name or node−name of a root node to generate the snapshot from
name: string
the name of the internal snapshot to be created
In transaction, if name is empty, or any snapshot matching name exists, the operation will fail. Only some image formats support it, for example, qcow2, and rbd.
1.7
Synchronously take an internal snapshot of a block device, when the format of the image used supports it. If the name is an empty string, or a snapshot with name already exists, the operation will fail.
For the arguments, see the documentation of BlockdevSnapshotInternal.
• |
nothing on success |
|||
• |
If device is not a valid block device, GenericError |
|||
• |
If any snapshot matching name exists, or name is empty, GenericError |
|||
• |
If the format of the image used does not support it, GenericError |
1.7
−> { "execute": "blockdev−snapshot−internal−sync", "arguments": { "device": "ide−hd0", "name": "snapshot0" } } <− { "return": {} }
Synchronously delete an internal snapshot of a block device, when the format of the image used support it. The snapshot is identified by name or id or both. One of the name or id is required. Return SnapshotInfo for the successfully deleted snapshot.
device: string
the device name or node−name of a root node to delete the snapshot from
id: string (optional)
optional the snapshot's ID to be deleted
name: string (optional)
optional the snapshot's name to be deleted
• |
SnapshotInfo on success |
|||
• |
If device is not a valid block device, GenericError |
|||
• |
If snapshot not found, GenericError |
|||
• |
If the format of the image used does not support it, GenericError |
|||
• |
If id and name are both not specified, GenericError |
1.7
−> { "execute": "blockdev−snapshot−delete−internal−sync", "arguments": { "device": "ide−hd0", "name": "snapshot0" } } <− { "return": { "id": "1", "name": "snapshot0", "vm−state−size": 0, "date−sec": 1000012, "date−nsec": 10, "vm−clock−sec": 100, "vm−clock−nsec": 20, "icount": 220414 } }
Not used by QMP; hack to let us use BlockGraphInfoList internally
unused−block−graph−info: array of BlockGraphInfo
Not documented
8.0
Policy that BIOS should use to interpret cylinder/head/sector addresses. Note that Bochs BIOS and SeaBIOS will not actually translate logical CHS to physical; instead, they will use logical block addressing.
auto |
If cylinder/heads/sizes are passed, choose between none and LBA depending on the size of the disk. If they are not passed, choose none if QEMU can guess that the disk had 16 or fewer heads, large if QEMU can guess that the disk had 131072 or fewer tracks across all heads (i.e. cylinders*heads<131072), otherwise LBA. | ||
none |
The physical disk geometry is equal to the logical geometry. | ||
lba |
Assume 63 sectors per track and one of 16, 32, 64, 128 or 255 heads (if fewer than 255 are enough to cover the whole disk with 1024 cylinders/head). The number of cylinders/head is then computed based on the number of sectors and heads. | ||
large |
The number of cylinders per head is scaled down to 1024 by correspondingly scaling up the number of heads. | ||
rechs |
Same as large, but first convert a 16−head geometry to 15−head, by proportionally scaling up the number of cylinders/head. |
2.0
Type of Floppy drive to be emulated by the Floppy Disk Controller.
144 |
1.44MB 3.5" drive |
|||
288 |
2.88MB 3.5" drive |
|||
120 |
1.2MB 5.25" drive |
|||
none |
No drive connected |
|||
auto |
Automatically determined by inserted media at boot |
2.6
Information about a persistent reservation manager
id: string
the identifier of the persistent reservation manager
connected: boolean
true if the persistent reservation manager is connected to the underlying storage or helper
3.0
Returns a list of information about each persistent reservation manager.
a list of PRManagerInfo for each persistent reservation manager
3.0
Ejects the medium from a removable drive.
device: string (optional)
Block device name
id: string (optional)
The name or QOM path of the guest device (since: 2.8)
force: boolean (optional)
If true, eject regardless of whether the drive is locked. If not specified, the default value is false.
deprecated
Member device is deprecated. Use id instead.
• |
Nothing on success |
|||
• |
If device is not a valid block device, DeviceNotFound |
Ejecting a device with no media results in success
0.14
−> { "execute": "eject", "arguments": { "id": "ide1−0−1" } } <− { "return": {} }
Opens a block device's tray. If there is a block driver state tree inserted as a medium, it will become inaccessible to the guest (but it will remain associated to the block device, so closing the tray will make it accessible again).
If the tray was already open before, this will be a no−op.
Once the tray opens, a DEVICE_TRAY_MOVED event is emitted. There are cases in which no such event will be generated, these include:
• |
if the guest has locked the tray, force is false and the guest does not respond to the eject request | ||
• |
if the BlockBackend denoted by device does not have a guest device attached to it | ||
• |
if the guest device does not have an actual tray |
device: string (optional)
Block device name
id: string (optional)
The name or QOM path of the guest device (since: 2.8)
force: boolean (optional)
if false (the default), an eject request will be sent to the guest if it has locked the tray (and the tray will not be opened immediately); if true, the tray will be opened regardless of whether it is locked
deprecated
Member device is deprecated. Use id instead.
2.5
−> { "execute": "blockdev−open−tray", "arguments": { "id": "ide0−1−0" } } <− { "timestamp": { "seconds": 1418751016, "microseconds": 716996 }, "event": "DEVICE_TRAY_MOVED", "data": { "device": "ide1−cd0", "id": "ide0−1−0", "tray−open": true } } <− { "return": {} }
Closes a block device's tray. If there is a block driver state tree associated with the block device (which is currently ejected), that tree will be loaded as the medium.
If the tray was already closed before, this will be a no−op.
device: string (optional)
Block device name
id: string (optional)
The name or QOM path of the guest device (since: 2.8)
deprecated
Member device is deprecated. Use id instead.
2.5
−> { "execute": "blockdev−close−tray", "arguments": { "id": "ide0−1−0" } } <− { "timestamp": { "seconds": 1418751345, "microseconds": 272147 }, "event": "DEVICE_TRAY_MOVED", "data": { "device": "ide1−cd0", "id": "ide0−1−0", "tray−open": false } } <− { "return": {} }
Removes a medium (a block driver state tree) from a block device. That block device's tray must currently be open (unless there is no attached guest device).
If the tray is open and there is no medium inserted, this will be a no−op.
id: string
The name or QOM path of the guest device
2.12
−> { "execute": "blockdev−remove−medium", "arguments": { "id": "ide0−1−0" } } <− { "error": { "class": "GenericError", "desc": "Tray of device 'ide0−1−0' is not open" } } −> { "execute": "blockdev−open−tray", "arguments": { "id": "ide0−1−0" } } <− { "timestamp": { "seconds": 1418751627, "microseconds": 549958 }, "event": "DEVICE_TRAY_MOVED", "data": { "device": "ide1−cd0", "id": "ide0−1−0", "tray−open": true } } <− { "return": {} } −> { "execute": "blockdev−remove−medium", "arguments": { "id": "ide0−1−0" } } <− { "return": {} }
Inserts a medium (a block driver state tree) into a block device. That block device's tray must currently be open (unless there is no attached guest device) and there must be no medium inserted already.
id: string
The name or QOM path of the guest device
node−name: string
name of a node in the block driver state graph
2.12
−> { "execute": "blockdev−add", "arguments": { "node−name": "node0", "driver": "raw", "file": { "driver": "file", "filename": "fedora.iso" } } } <− { "return": {} } −> { "execute": "blockdev−insert−medium", "arguments": { "id": "ide0−1−0", "node−name": "node0" } } <− { "return": {} }
Specifies the new read−only mode of a block device subject to the blockdev−change−medium command.
retain |
Retains the current read−only mode |
read−only
Makes the device read−only
read−write
Makes the device writable
2.3
Changes the medium inserted into a block device by ejecting the current medium and loading a new image file which is inserted as the new medium (this command combines blockdev−open−tray, blockdev−remove−medium, blockdev−insert−medium and blockdev−close−tray).
device: string (optional)
Block device name
id: string (optional)
The name or QOM path of the guest device (since: 2.8)
filename: string
filename of the new image to be loaded
format: string (optional)
format to open the new image with (defaults to the probed format)
read−only−mode: BlockdevChangeReadOnlyMode (optional)
change the read−only mode of the device; defaults to 'retain'
force: boolean (optional)
if false (the default), an eject request through blockdev−open−tray will be sent to the guest if it has locked the tray (and the tray will not be opened immediately); if true, the tray will be opened regardless of whether it is locked. (since 7.1)
deprecated
Member device is deprecated. Use id instead.
2.5
1. Change a removable medium −> { "execute": "blockdev−change−medium", "arguments": { "id": "ide0−1−0", "filename": "/srv/images/Fedora−12−x86_64−DVD.iso", "format": "raw" } } <− { "return": {} } 2. Load a read−only medium into a writable drive −> { "execute": "blockdev−change−medium", "arguments": { "id": "floppyA", "filename": "/srv/images/ro.img", "format": "raw", "read−only−mode": "retain" } } <− { "error": { "class": "GenericError", "desc": "Could not open '/srv/images/ro.img': Permission denied" } } −> { "execute": "blockdev−change−medium", "arguments": { "id": "floppyA", "filename": "/srv/images/ro.img", "format": "raw", "read−only−mode": "read−only" } } <− { "return": {} }
Emitted whenever the tray of a removable device is moved by the guest or by HMP/QMP commands
device: string
Block device name. This is always present for compatibility reasons, but it can be empty ("") if the image does not have a device name associated.
id: string
The name or QOM path of the guest device (since 2.8)
tray−open: boolean
true if the tray has been opened or false if it has been closed
1.1
<− { "event": "DEVICE_TRAY_MOVED", "data": { "device": "ide1−cd0", "id": "/machine/unattached/device[22]", "tray−open": true }, "timestamp": { "seconds": 1265044230, "microseconds": 450486 } }
Emitted whenever the connected status of a persistent reservation manager changes.
id: string
The id of the PR manager object
connected: boolean
true if the PR manager is connected to a backend
3.0
<− { "event": "PR_MANAGER_STATUS_CHANGED", "data": { "id": "pr−helper0", "connected": true }, "timestamp": { "seconds": 1519840375, "microseconds": 450486 } }
Change I/O throttle limits for a block drive.
Since QEMU 2.4, each device with I/O limits is member of a throttle group.
If two or more devices are members of the same group, the limits will apply to the combined I/O of the whole group in a round−robin fashion. Therefore, setting new I/O limits to a device will affect the whole group.
The name of the group can be specified using the 'group' parameter. If the parameter is unset, it is assumed to be the current group of that device. If it's not in any group yet, the name of the device will be used as the name for its group.
The 'group' parameter can also be used to move a device to a different group. In this case the limits specified in the parameters will be applied to the new group only.
I/O limits can be disabled by setting all of them to 0. In this case the device will be removed from its group and the rest of its members will not be affected. The 'group' parameter is ignored.
The members of BlockIOThrottle
• |
Nothing on success |
|||
• |
If device is not a valid block device, DeviceNotFound |
1.1
−> { "execute": "block_set_io_throttle", "arguments": { "id": "virtio−blk−pci0/virtio−backend", "bps": 0, "bps_rd": 0, "bps_wr": 0, "iops": 512, "iops_rd": 0, "iops_wr": 0, "bps_max": 0, "bps_rd_max": 0, "bps_wr_max": 0, "iops_max": 0, "iops_rd_max": 0, "iops_wr_max": 0, "bps_max_length": 0, "iops_size": 0 } } <− { "return": {} } −> { "execute": "block_set_io_throttle", "arguments": { "id": "ide0−1−0", "bps": 1000000, "bps_rd": 0, "bps_wr": 0, "iops": 0, "iops_rd": 0, "iops_wr": 0, "bps_max": 8000000, "bps_rd_max": 0, "bps_wr_max": 0, "iops_max": 0, "iops_rd_max": 0, "iops_wr_max": 0, "bps_max_length": 60, "iops_size": 0 } } <− { "return": {} }
Manage read, write and flush latency histograms for the device.
If only id parameter is specified, remove all present latency histograms for the device. Otherwise, add/reset some of (or all) latency histograms.
id: string
The name or QOM path of the guest device.
boundaries: array of int (optional)
list of interval boundary values (see description in BlockLatencyHistogramInfo definition). If specified, all latency histograms are removed, and empty ones created for all io types with intervals corresponding to boundaries (except for io types, for which specific boundaries are set through the following parameters).
boundaries−read: array of int (optional)
list of interval boundary values for read latency histogram. If specified, old read latency histogram is removed, and empty one created with intervals corresponding to boundaries−read. The parameter has higher priority then boundaries.
boundaries−write: array of int (optional)
list of interval boundary values for write latency histogram.
boundaries−zap: array of int (optional)
list of interval boundary values for zone append write latency histogram.
boundaries−flush: array of int (optional)
list of interval boundary values for flush latency histogram.
error if device is not found or any boundary arrays are invalid.
4.0
Set new histograms for all io types with intervals [0, 10), [10, 50), [50, 100), [100, +inf): −> { "execute": "block−latency−histogram−set", "arguments": { "id": "drive0", "boundaries": [10, 50, 100] } } <− { "return": {} }
Set new histogram only for write, other histograms will remain not changed (or not created): −> { "execute": "block−latency−histogram−set", "arguments": { "id": "drive0", "boundaries−write": [10, 50, 100] } } <− { "return": {} }
Set new histograms with the following intervals: read, flush: [0, 10), [10, 50), [50, 100), [100, +inf) write: [0, 1000), [1000, 5000), [5000, +inf) −> { "execute": "block−latency−histogram−set", "arguments": { "id": "drive0", "boundaries": [10, 50, 100], "boundaries−write": [1000, 5000] } } <− { "return": {} }
Remove all latency histograms: −> { "execute": "block−latency−histogram−set", "arguments": { "id": "drive0" } } <− { "return": {} }
Keep this type consistent with the nbd−server−start arguments. The only intended difference is using SocketAddress instead of SocketAddressLegacy.
addr: SocketAddress
Address on which to listen.
tls−creds: string (optional)
ID of the TLS credentials object (since 2.6).
tls−authz: string (optional)
ID of the QAuthZ authorization object used to validate the client's x509 distinguished name. This object is is only resolved at time of use, so can be deleted and recreated on the fly while the NBD server is active. If missing, it will default to denying access (since 4.0).
max−connections: int (optional)
The maximum number of connections to allow at the same time, 0 for unlimited. Setting this to 1 also stops the server from advertising multiple client support (since 5.2; default: 0)
4.2
Start an NBD server listening on the given host and port. Block devices can then be exported using nbd−server−add. The NBD server will present them as named exports; for example, another QEMU instance could refer to them as "nbd:HOST:PORT:exportname=NAME".
Keep this type consistent with the NbdServerOptions type. The only intended difference is using SocketAddressLegacy instead of SocketAddress.
addr: SocketAddressLegacy
Address on which to listen.
tls−creds: string (optional)
ID of the TLS credentials object (since 2.6).
tls−authz: string (optional)
ID of the QAuthZ authorization object used to validate the client's x509 distinguished name. This object is is only resolved at time of use, so can be deleted and recreated on the fly while the NBD server is active. If missing, it will default to denying access (since 4.0).
max−connections: int (optional)
The maximum number of connections to allow at the same time, 0 for unlimited. Setting this to 1 also stops the server from advertising multiple client support (since 5.2; default: 0).
error if the server is already running.
1.3
An NBD block export (common options shared between nbd−server−add and the NBD branch of block−export−add).
name: string (optional)
Export name. If unspecified, the device parameter is used as the export name. (Since 2.12)
description: string (optional)
Free−form description of the export, up to 4096 bytes. (Since 5.0)
5.0
An NBD block export (distinct options used in the NBD branch of block−export−add).
bitmaps: array of BlockDirtyBitmapOrStr (optional)
Also export each of the named dirty bitmaps reachable from device, so the NBD client can use NBD_OPT_SET_META_CONTEXT with the metadata context name "qemu:dirty−bitmap:BITMAP" to inspect each bitmap. Since 7.1 bitmap may be specified by node/name pair.
allocation−depth: boolean (optional)
Also export the allocation depth map for device, so the NBD client can use NBD_OPT_SET_META_CONTEXT with the metadata context name "qemu:allocation−depth" to inspect allocation details. (since 5.2)
The members of BlockExportOptionsNbdBase
5.2
A vhost−user−blk block export.
addr: SocketAddress
The vhost−user socket on which to listen. Both 'unix' and 'fd' SocketAddress types are supported. Passed fds must be UNIX domain sockets.
logical−block−size: int (optional)
Logical block size in bytes. Defaults to 512 bytes.
num−queues: int (optional)
Number of request virtqueues. Must be greater than 0. Defaults to 1.
5.2
Possible allow_other modes for FUSE exports.
off |
Do not pass allow_other as a mount option. | ||
on |
Pass allow_other as a mount option. | ||
auto |
Try mounting with allow_other first, and if that fails, retry without allow_other. |
6.1
Options for exporting a block graph node on some (file) mountpoint as a raw image.
mountpoint: string
Path on which to export the block device via FUSE. This must point to an existing regular file.
growable: boolean (optional)
Whether writes beyond the EOF should grow the block node accordingly. (default: false)
allow−other: FuseExportAllowOther (optional)
If this is off, only qemu's user is allowed access to this export. That cannot be changed even with chmod or chown. Enabling this option will allow other users access to the export with the FUSE mount option "allow_other". Note that using allow_other as a non−root user requires user_allow_other to be enabled in the global fuse.conf configuration file. In auto mode (the default), the FUSE export driver will first attempt to mount the export with allow_other, and if that fails, try again without. (since 6.1; default: auto)
6.0
CONFIG_FUSE
A vduse−blk block export.
name: string
the name of VDUSE device (must be unique across the host).
num−queues: int (optional)
the number of virtqueues. Defaults to 1.
queue−size: int (optional)
the size of virtqueue. Defaults to 256.
logical−block−size: int (optional)
Logical block size in bytes. Range [512, PAGE_SIZE] and must be power of 2. Defaults to 512 bytes.
serial: string (optional)
the serial number of virtio block device. Defaults to empty string.
7.1
An NBD block export, per legacy nbd−server−add command.
device: string
The device name or node name of the node to be exported
writable: boolean (optional)
Whether clients should be able to write to the device via the NBD connection (default false).
bitmap: string (optional)
Also export a single dirty bitmap reachable from device, so the NBD client can use NBD_OPT_SET_META_CONTEXT with the metadata context name "qemu:dirty−bitmap:BITMAP" to inspect the bitmap (since 4.0).
The members of BlockExportOptionsNbdBase
5.0
Export a block node to QEMU's embedded NBD server.
The export name will be used as the id for the resulting block export.
The members of NbdServerAddOptions
deprecated
This command is deprecated. Use block−export−add instead.
error if the server is not running, or export with the same name already exists.
1.3
Mode for removing a block export.
safe |
Remove export if there are no existing connections, fail otherwise. | ||
hard |
Drop all connections immediately and remove export. |
Potential additional modes to be added in the future:
hide: Just hide export from new clients, leave existing connections as is. Remove export after all clients are disconnected.
soft: Hide export from new clients, answer with ESHUTDOWN for all further requests from existing clients.
2.12
Remove NBD export by name.
name: string
Block export id.
mode: BlockExportRemoveMode (optional)
Mode of command operation. See BlockExportRemoveMode description. Default is 'safe'.
deprecated
This command is deprecated. Use block−export−del instead.
error if
• |
the server is not running |
|||
• |
export is not found |
|||
• |
mode is 'safe' and there are existing connections |
2.12
Stop QEMU's embedded NBD server, and unregister all devices previously added via nbd−server−add.
1.3
An enumeration of block export types
nbd |
NBD export |
vhost−user−blk (If: CONFIG_VHOST_USER_BLK_SERVER)
vhost−user−blk export (since 5.2)
fuse (If: CONFIG_FUSE)
FUSE export (since: 6.0)
vduse−blk (If: CONFIG_VDUSE_BLK_EXPORT)
vduse−blk export (since 7.1)
4.2
Describes a block export, i.e. how single node should be exported on an external interface.
id: string
A unique identifier for the block export (across all export types)
node−name: string
The node name of the block node to be exported (since: 5.2)
writable: boolean (optional)
True if clients should be able to write to the export (default false)
writethrough: boolean (optional)
If true, caches are flushed after every write request to the export before completion is signalled. (since: 5.2; default: false)
iothread: string (optional)
The name of the iothread object where the export will run. The default is to use the thread currently associated with the block node. (since: 5.2)
fixed−iothread: boolean (optional)
True prevents the block node from being moved to another thread while the export is active. If true and iothread is given, export creation fails if the block node cannot be moved to the iothread. The default is false. (since: 5.2)
type: BlockExportType
Not documented
The members of
BlockExportOptionsNbd when type is "nbd"
The members of BlockExportOptionsVhostUserBlk when
type is
"vhost−user−blk" (If:
CONFIG_VHOST_USER_BLK_SERVER)
The members of BlockExportOptionsFuse when
type is "fuse" (If:
CONFIG_FUSE)
The members of BlockExportOptionsVduseBlk when
type is "vduse−blk" (If:
CONFIG_VDUSE_BLK_EXPORT)
4.2
Creates a new block export.
The members of BlockExportOptions
5.2
Request to remove a block export. This drops the user's reference to the export, but the export may still stay around after this command returns until the shutdown of the export has completed.
id: string
Block export id.
mode: BlockExportRemoveMode (optional)
Mode of command operation. See BlockExportRemoveMode description. Default is 'safe'.
Error if the export is not found or mode is 'safe' and the export is still in use (e.g. by existing client connections)
5.2
Emitted when a block export is removed and its id can be reused.
id: string
Block export id.
5.2
Information about a single block export.
id: string
The unique identifier for the block export
type: BlockExportType
The block export type
node−name: string
The node name of the block node that is exported
shutting−down: boolean
True if the export is shutting down (e.g. after a block−export−del command, but before the shutdown has completed)
5.2
A list of BlockExportInfo describing all block exports
5.2
Information about a character device.
label: string
the label of the character device
filename: string
the filename of the character device
frontend−open: boolean
shows whether the frontend device attached to this backend (e.g. with the chardev=... option) is in open or closed state (since 2.1)
filename is encoded using the QEMU command line character device encoding. See the QEMU man page for details.
0.14
Returns information about current character devices.
a list of ChardevInfo
0.14
−> { "execute": "query−chardev" } <− { "return": [ { "label": "charchannel0", "filename": "unix:/var/lib/libvirt/qemu/seabios.rhel6.agent,server=on", "frontend−open": false }, { "label": "charmonitor", "filename": "unix:/var/lib/libvirt/qemu/seabios.rhel6.monitor,server=on", "frontend−open": true }, { "label": "charserial0", "filename": "pty:/dev/pts/2", "frontend−open": true } ] }
Information about a character device backend
name: string
The backend name
2.0
Returns information about character device backends.
a list of ChardevBackendInfo
2.0
−> { "execute": "query−chardev−backends" } <− { "return":[ { "name":"udp" }, { "name":"tcp" }, { "name":"unix" }, { "name":"spiceport" } ] }
An enumeration of data format.
utf8 |
Data is a UTF−8 string (RFC 3629) |
|||
base64 |
Data is Base64 encoded binary (RFC 3548) |
1.4
Write to a ring buffer character device.
device: string
the ring buffer character device name
data: string
data to write
format: DataFormat (optional)
data encoding (default 'utf8').
• |
base64: data must be base64 encoded text. Its binary decoding gets written. | ||
• |
utf8: data's UTF−8 encoding is written | ||
• |
data itself is always Unicode regardless of format, like any other string. |
Nothing on success
1.4
−> { "execute": "ringbuf−write", "arguments": { "device": "foo", "data": "abcdefgh", "format": "utf8" } } <− { "return": {} }
Read from a ring buffer character device.
device: string
the ring buffer character device name
size: int
how many bytes to read at most
format: DataFormat (optional)
data encoding (default 'utf8').
• |
base64: the data read is returned in base64 encoding. | ||
• |
utf8: the data read is interpreted as UTF−8. Bug: can screw up when the buffer contains invalid UTF−8 sequences, NUL characters, after the ring buffer lost data, and when reading stops because the size limit is reached. | ||
• |
The return value is always Unicode regardless of format, like any other string. |
data read from the device
1.4
−> { "execute": "ringbuf−read", "arguments": { "device": "foo", "size": 1000, "format": "utf8" } } <− { "return": "abcdefgh" }
Configuration shared across all chardev backends
logfile: string (optional)
The name of a logfile to save output
logappend: boolean (optional)
true to append instead of truncate (default to false to truncate)
2.6
Configuration info for file chardevs.
in: string (optional)
The name of the input file
out: string
The name of the output file
append: boolean (optional)
Open the file in append mode (default false to truncate) (Since 2.6)
The members of ChardevCommon
1.4
Configuration info for device and pipe chardevs.
device: string
The name of the special file for the device, i.e. /dev/ttyS0 on Unix or COM1: on Windows
The members of ChardevCommon
1.4
Configuration info for (stream) socket chardevs.
addr: SocketAddressLegacy
socket address to listen on (server=true) or connect to (server=false)
tls−creds: string (optional)
the ID of the TLS credentials object (since 2.6)
tls−authz: string (optional)
the ID of the QAuthZ authorization object against which the client's x509 distinguished name will be validated. This object is only resolved at time of use, so can be deleted and recreated on the fly while the chardev server is active. If missing, it will default to denying access (since 4.0)
server: boolean (optional)
create server socket (default: true)
wait: boolean (optional)
wait for incoming connection on server sockets (default: false). Silently ignored with server: false. This use is deprecated.
nodelay: boolean (optional)
set TCP_NODELAY socket option (default: false)
telnet: boolean (optional)
enable telnet protocol on server sockets (default: false)
tn3270: boolean (optional)
enable tn3270 protocol on server sockets (default: false) (Since: 2.10)
websocket: boolean (optional)
enable websocket protocol on server sockets (default: false) (Since: 3.1)
reconnect: int (optional)
For a client socket, if a socket is disconnected, then attempt a reconnect after the given number of seconds. Setting this to zero disables this function. (default: 0) (Since: 2.2)
The members of ChardevCommon
1.4
Configuration info for datagram socket chardevs.
remote: SocketAddressLegacy
remote address
local: SocketAddressLegacy (optional)
local address
The members of ChardevCommon
1.5
Configuration info for mux chardevs.
chardev: string
name of the base chardev.
The members of ChardevCommon
1.5
Configuration info for stdio chardevs.
signal: boolean (optional)
Allow signals (such as SIGINT triggered by ˆC) be delivered to qemu. Default: true.
The members of ChardevCommon
1.5
Configuration info for spice vm channel chardevs.
type: string
kind of channel (for example vdagent).
The members of ChardevCommon
1.5
CONFIG_SPICE
Configuration info for spice port chardevs.
fqdn: string
name of the channel (see docs/spice−port−fqdn.txt)
The members of ChardevCommon
1.5
CONFIG_SPICE
Configuration info for DBus chardevs.
name: string
name of the channel (following docs/spice−port−fqdn.txt)
The members of ChardevCommon
7.0
CONFIG_DBUS_DISPLAY
Configuration info for virtual console chardevs.
width: int (optional)
console width, in pixels
height: int (optional)
console height, in pixels
cols: int (optional)
console width, in chars
rows: int (optional)
console height, in chars
The members of ChardevCommon
1.5
Configuration info for ring buffer chardevs.
size: int (optional)
ring buffer size, must be power of two, default is 65536
The members of ChardevCommon
1.5
Configuration info for qemu vdagent implementation.
mouse: boolean (optional)
enable/disable mouse, default is enabled.
clipboard: boolean (optional)
enable/disable clipboard, default is disabled.
The members of ChardevCommon
6.1
CONFIG_SPICE_PROTOCOL
pipe |
Since 1.5 |
|||
udp |
Since 1.5 |
|||
mux |
Since 1.5 |
msmouse
Since 1.5
wctablet
Since 2.9
braille
Since 1.5
testdev
Since 2.2
stdio |
Since 1.5 |
console
Since 1.5
spicevmc (If: CONFIG_SPICE)
Since 1.5
spiceport (If: CONFIG_SPICE)
Since 1.5
qemu−vdagent (If: CONFIG_SPICE_PROTOCOL)
Since 6.1
dbus (If: CONFIG_DBUS_DISPLAY)
Since 7.0
vc |
v1.5 |
ringbuf
Since 1.6
memory |
Since 1.5 |
|||
file |
Not documented |
|||
serial |
Not documented |
parallel
Not documented
socket |
Not documented |
|||
pty |
Not documented |
|||
null |
Not documented |
1.4
data: ChardevFile
Not documented
1.4
data: ChardevHostdev
Not documented
1.4
data: ChardevSocket
Not documented
1.4
data: ChardevUdp
Not documented
1.5
data: ChardevCommon
Not documented
2.6
data: ChardevMux
Not documented
1.5
data: ChardevStdio
Not documented
1.5
data: ChardevSpiceChannel
Not documented
1.5
CONFIG_SPICE
data: ChardevSpicePort
Not documented
1.5
CONFIG_SPICE
data: ChardevQemuVDAgent
Not documented
6.1
CONFIG_SPICE_PROTOCOL
data: ChardevDBus
Not documented
7.0
CONFIG_DBUS_DISPLAY
data: ChardevVC
Not documented
1.5
data: ChardevRingbuf
Not documented
1.5
Configuration info for the new chardev backend.
type: ChardevBackendKind
Not documented
The members of
ChardevFileWrapper when type is "file"
The members of ChardevHostdevWrapper when type is
"serial"
The members of ChardevHostdevWrapper when type is
"parallel"
The members of ChardevHostdevWrapper when type is
"pipe"
The members of ChardevSocketWrapper when type is
"socket"
The members of ChardevUdpWrapper when type is
"udp"
The members of ChardevCommonWrapper when type is
"pty"
The members of ChardevCommonWrapper when type is
"null"
The members of ChardevMuxWrapper when type is
"mux"
The members of ChardevCommonWrapper when type is
"msmouse"
The members of ChardevCommonWrapper when type is
"wctablet"
The members of ChardevCommonWrapper when type is
"braille"
The members of ChardevCommonWrapper when type is
"testdev"
The members of ChardevStdioWrapper when type is
"stdio"
The members of ChardevCommonWrapper when type is
"console"
The members of ChardevSpiceChannelWrapper when
type is "spicevmc" (If:
CONFIG_SPICE)
The members of ChardevSpicePortWrapper when
type is "spiceport" (If:
CONFIG_SPICE)
The members of ChardevQemuVDAgentWrapper when
type is "qemu−vdagent"
(If: CONFIG_SPICE_PROTOCOL)
The members of ChardevDBusWrapper when type is
"dbus" (If:
CONFIG_DBUS_DISPLAY)
The members of ChardevVCWrapper when type is "vc"
The members of ChardevRingbufWrapper when type is
"ringbuf"
The members of ChardevRingbufWrapper when type is
"memory"
1.4
Return info about the chardev backend just created.
pty: string (optional)
name of the slave pseudoterminal device, present if and only if a chardev of type 'pty' was created
1.4
Add a character device backend
id: string
the chardev's ID, must be unique
backend: ChardevBackend
backend type and parameters
ChardevReturn.
1.4
−> { "execute" : "chardev−add", "arguments" : { "id" : "foo", "backend" : { "type" : "null", "data" : {} } } } <− { "return": {} } −> { "execute" : "chardev−add", "arguments" : { "id" : "bar", "backend" : { "type" : "file", "data" : { "out" : "/tmp/bar.log" } } } } <− { "return": {} } −> { "execute" : "chardev−add", "arguments" : { "id" : "baz", "backend" : { "type" : "pty", "data" : {} } } } <− { "return": { "pty" : "/dev/pty/42" } }
Change a character device backend
id: string
the chardev's ID, must exist
backend: ChardevBackend
new backend type and parameters
ChardevReturn.
2.10
−> { "execute" : "chardev−change", "arguments" : { "id" : "baz", "backend" : { "type" : "pty", "data" : {} } } } <− { "return": { "pty" : "/dev/pty/42" } } −> {"execute" : "chardev−change", "arguments" : { "id" : "charchannel2", "backend" : { "type" : "socket", "data" : { "addr" : { "type" : "unix" , "data" : { "path" : "/tmp/charchannel2.socket" } }, "server" : true, "wait" : false }}}} <− {"return": {}}
Remove a character device backend
id: string
the chardev's ID, must exist and not be in use
Nothing on success
1.4
−> { "execute": "chardev−remove", "arguments": { "id" : "foo" } } <− { "return": {} }
Send a break to a character device
id: string
the chardev's ID, must exist
Nothing on success
2.10
−> { "execute": "chardev−send−break", "arguments": { "id" : "foo" } } <− { "return": {} }
Emitted when the guest opens or closes a virtio−serial port.
id: string
device identifier of the virtio−serial port
open: boolean
true if the guest has opened the virtio−serial port
This event is rate−limited.
2.1
<− { "event": "VSERPORT_CHANGE", "data": { "id": "channel0", "open": true }, "timestamp": { "seconds": 1401385907, "microseconds": 422329 } }
An enumeration of guest−memory−dump's format.
elf |
elf format |
kdump−zlib
kdump−compressed format with zlib−compressed
kdump−lzo
kdump−compressed format with lzo−compressed
kdump−snappy
kdump−compressed format with snappy−compressed
win−dmp
Windows full crashdump format, can be used instead of ELF converting (since 2.13)
2.0
Dump guest's memory to vmcore. It is a synchronous operation that can take very long depending on the amount of guest memory.
paging: boolean
if true, do paging to get guest's memory mapping. This allows using gdb to process the core file.
IMPORTANT: this option can make QEMU allocate several gigabytes of RAM. This can happen for a large guest, or a malicious guest pretending to be large.
Also, paging=true has the following limitations:
1. |
The guest may be in a catastrophic state or can have corrupted memory, which cannot be trusted | ||
2. |
The guest can be in real−mode even if paging is enabled. For example, the guest uses ACPI to sleep, and ACPI sleep state goes in real−mode | ||
3. |
Currently only supported on i386 and x86_64. |
protocol: string
the filename or file descriptor of the vmcore. The supported protocols are:
1. |
file: the protocol starts with "file:", and the following string is the file's path. | ||
2. |
fd: the protocol starts with "fd:", and the following string is the fd's name. |
detach: boolean (optional)
if true, QMP will return immediately rather than waiting for the dump to finish. The user can track progress using "query−dump". (since 2.6).
begin: int (optional)
if specified, the starting physical address.
length: int (optional)
if specified, the memory size, in bytes. If you don't want to dump all guest's memory, please specify the start begin and length
format: DumpGuestMemoryFormat (optional)
if specified, the format of guest memory dump. But non−elf format is conflict with paging and filter, ie. paging, begin and length is not allowed to be specified with non−elf format at the same time (since 2.0)
All boolean arguments default to false
nothing on success
1.2
−> { "execute": "dump−guest−memory", "arguments": { "paging": false, "protocol": "fd:dump" } } <− { "return": {} }
Describe the status of a long−running background guest memory dump.
none |
no dump−guest−memory has started yet. |
|||
active |
there is one dump running in background. |
completed
the last dump has finished successfully.
failed |
the last dump has failed. |
2.6
The result format for 'query−dump'.
status: DumpStatus
enum of DumpStatus, which shows current dump status
completed: int
bytes written in latest dump (uncompressed)
total: int
total bytes to be written in latest dump (uncompressed)
2.6
Query latest dump status.
A DumpStatus object showing the dump status.
2.6
−> { "execute": "query−dump" } <− { "return": { "status": "active", "completed": 1024000, "total": 2048000 } }
Emitted when background dump has completed
result: DumpQueryResult
final dump status
error: string (optional)
human−readable error string that provides hint on why dump failed. Only presents on failure. The user should not try to interpret the error string.
2.6
<− { "event": "DUMP_COMPLETED", "data": { "result": { "total": 1090650112, "status": "completed", "completed": 1090650112 } }, "timestamp": { "seconds": 1648244171, "microseconds": 950316 } }
A list of the available formats for dump−guest−memory
formats: array of DumpGuestMemoryFormat
Not documented
2.0
Returns the available formats for dump−guest−memory
A DumpGuestMemoryCapability object listing available formats for dump−guest−memory
2.0
−> { "execute": "query−dump−guest−memory−capability" } <− { "return": { "formats": ["elf", "kdump−zlib", "kdump−lzo", "kdump−snappy"] } }
Sets the link status of a virtual network adapter.
name: string
the device name of the virtual network adapter
up: boolean
true to set the link status to be up
Nothing on success If name is not a valid network device, DeviceNotFound
0.14
Not all network adapters support setting link status. This command will succeed even if the network adapter does not support link status notification.
−> { "execute": "set_link", "arguments": { "name": "e1000.0", "up": false } } <− { "return": {} }
Add a network backend.
Additional arguments depend on the type.
The members of Netdev
0.14
Nothing on success If type is not a valid network backend, DeviceNotFound
−> { "execute": "netdev_add", "arguments": { "type": "user", "id": "netdev1", "dnssearch": [ { "str": "example.org" } ] } } <− { "return": {} }
Remove a network backend.
id: string
the name of the network backend to remove
Nothing on success If id is not a valid network backend, DeviceNotFound
0.14
−> { "execute": "netdev_del", "arguments": { "id": "netdev1" } } <− { "return": {} }
Create a new Network Interface Card.
netdev: string (optional)
id of −netdev to connect to
macaddr: string (optional)
MAC address
model: string (optional)
device model (e1000, rtl8139, virtio etc.)
addr: string (optional)
PCI device address
vectors: int (optional)
number of MSI−x vectors, 0 to disable MSI−X
1.2
Use the user mode network stack which requires no administrator privilege to run.
hostname: string (optional)
client hostname reported by the builtin DHCP server
restrict: boolean (optional)
isolate the guest from the host
ipv4: boolean (optional)
whether to support IPv4, default true for enabled (since 2.6)
ipv6: boolean (optional)
whether to support IPv6, default true for enabled (since 2.6)
ip: string (optional)
legacy parameter, use net= instead
net: string (optional)
IP network address that the guest will see, in the form addr[/netmask] The netmask is optional, and can be either in the form a.b.c.d or as a number of valid top−most bits. Default is 10.0.2.0/24.
host: string (optional)
guest−visible address of the host
tftp: string (optional)
root directory of the built−in TFTP server
bootfile: string (optional)
BOOTP filename, for use with tftp=
dhcpstart: string (optional)
the first of the 16 IPs the built−in DHCP server can assign
dns: string (optional)
guest−visible address of the virtual nameserver
dnssearch: array of String (optional)
list of DNS suffixes to search, passed as DHCP option to the guest
domainname: string (optional)
guest−visible domain name of the virtual nameserver (since 3.0)
ipv6−prefix: string (optional)
IPv6 network prefix (default is fec0::) (since 2.6). The network prefix is given in the usual hexadecimal IPv6 address notation.
ipv6−prefixlen: int (optional)
IPv6 network prefix length (default is 64) (since 2.6)
ipv6−host: string (optional)
guest−visible IPv6 address of the host (since 2.6)
ipv6−dns: string (optional)
guest−visible IPv6 address of the virtual nameserver (since 2.6)
smb: string (optional)
root directory of the built−in SMB server
smbserver: string (optional)
IP address of the built−in SMB server
hostfwd: array of String (optional)
redirect incoming TCP or UDP host connections to guest endpoints
guestfwd: array of String (optional)
forward guest TCP connections
tftp−server−name: string (optional)
RFC2132 "TFTP server name" string (Since 3.1)
1.2
Used to configure a host TAP network interface backend.
ifname: string (optional)
interface name
fd: string (optional)
file descriptor of an already opened tap
fds: string (optional)
multiple file descriptors of already opened multiqueue capable tap
script: string (optional)
script to initialize the interface
downscript: string (optional)
script to shut down the interface
br: string (optional)
bridge name (since 2.8)
helper: string (optional)
command to execute to configure bridge
sndbuf: int (optional)
send buffer limit. Understands [TGMKkb] suffixes.
vnet_hdr: boolean (optional)
enable the IFF_VNET_HDR flag on the tap interface
vhost: boolean (optional)
enable vhost−net network accelerator
vhostfd: string (optional)
file descriptor of an already opened vhost net device
vhostfds: string (optional)
file descriptors of multiple already opened vhost net devices
vhostforce: boolean (optional)
vhost on for non−MSIX virtio guests
queues: int (optional)
number of queues to be created for multiqueue capable tap
poll−us: int (optional)
maximum number of microseconds that could be spent on busy polling for tap (since 2.7)
1.2
Socket netdevs are used to establish a network connection to another QEMU virtual machine via a TCP socket.
fd: string (optional)
file descriptor of an already opened socket
listen: string (optional)
port number, and optional hostname, to listen on
connect: string (optional)
port number, and optional hostname, to connect to
mcast: string (optional)
UDP multicast address and port number
localaddr: string (optional)
source address and port for multicast and udp packets
udp: string (optional)
UDP unicast address and port number
1.2
Configure an Ethernet over L2TPv3 tunnel.
src: string
source address
dst: string
destination address
srcport: string (optional)
source port − mandatory for udp, optional for ip
dstport: string (optional)
destination port − mandatory for udp, optional for ip
ipv6: boolean (optional)
force the use of ipv6
udp: boolean (optional)
use the udp version of l2tpv3 encapsulation
cookie64: boolean (optional)
use 64 bit cookies
counter: boolean (optional)
have sequence counter
pincounter: boolean (optional)
pin sequence counter to zero − workaround for buggy implementations or networks with packet reorder
txcookie: int (optional)
32 or 64 bit transmit cookie
rxcookie: int (optional)
32 or 64 bit receive cookie
txsession: int
32 bit transmit session
rxsession: int (optional)
32 bit receive session − if not specified set to the same value as transmit
offset: int (optional)
additional offset − allows the insertion of additional application−specific data before the packet payload
2.1
Connect to a vde switch running on the host.
sock: string (optional)
socket path
port: int (optional)
port number
group: string (optional)
group owner of socket
mode: int (optional)
permissions for socket
1.2
Connect a host TAP network interface to a host bridge device.
br: string (optional)
bridge name
helper: string (optional)
command to execute to configure bridge
1.2
Connect two or more net clients through a software hub.
hubid: int
hub identifier number
netdev: string (optional)
used to connect hub to a netdev instead of a device (since 2.12)
1.2
Connect a client to a netmap−enabled NIC or to a VALE switch port
ifname: string
Either the name of an existing network interface supported by netmap, or the name of a VALE port (created on the fly). A VALE port name is in the form 'valeXXX:YYY', where XXX and YYY are non−negative integers. XXX identifies a switch and YYY identifies a port of the switch. VALE ports having the same XXX are therefore connected to the same switch.
devname: string (optional)
path of the netmap device (default: '/dev/netmap').
2.0
Vhost−user network backend
chardev: string
name of a unix socket chardev
vhostforce: boolean (optional)
vhost on for non−MSIX virtio guests (default: false).
queues: int (optional)
number of queues to be created for multiqueue vhost−user (default: 1) (Since 2.5)
2.1
Vhost−vdpa network backend
vDPA device is a device that uses a datapath which complies with the virtio specifications with a vendor specific control path.
vhostdev: string (optional)
path of vhost−vdpa device (default:'/dev/vhost−vdpa−0')
vhostfd: string (optional)
file descriptor of an already opened vhost vdpa device
queues: int (optional)
number of queues to be created for multiqueue vhost−vdpa (default: 1)
x−svq: boolean (optional)
Start device with (experimental) shadow virtqueue. (Since 7.1) (default: false)
unstable
Member x−svq is experimental.
5.1
vmnet (host mode) network backend.
Allows the vmnet interface to communicate with other vmnet interfaces that are in host mode and also with the host.
start−address: string (optional)
The starting IPv4 address to use for the interface. Must be in the private IP range (RFC 1918). Must be specified along with end−address and subnet−mask. This address is used as the gateway address. The subsequent address up to and including end−address are placed in the DHCP pool.
end−address: string (optional)
The DHCP IPv4 range end address to use for the interface. Must be in the private IP range (RFC 1918). Must be specified along with start−address and subnet−mask.
subnet−mask: string (optional)
The IPv4 subnet mask to use on the interface. Must be specified along with start−address and subnet−mask.
isolated: boolean (optional)
Enable isolation for this interface. Interface isolation ensures that vmnet interface is not able to communicate with any other vmnet interfaces. Only communication with host is allowed. Requires at least macOS Big Sur 11.0.
net−uuid: string (optional)
The identifier (UUID) to uniquely identify the isolated network vmnet interface should be added to. If set, no DHCP service is provided for this interface and network communication is allowed only with other interfaces added to this network identified by the UUID. Requires at least macOS Big Sur 11.0.
7.1
CONFIG_VMNET
vmnet (shared mode) network backend.
Allows traffic originating from the vmnet interface to reach the Internet through a network address translator (NAT). The vmnet interface can communicate with the host and with other shared mode interfaces on the same subnet. If no DHCP settings, subnet mask and IPv6 prefix specified, the interface can communicate with any of other interfaces in shared mode.
start−address: string (optional)
The starting IPv4 address to use for the interface. Must be in the private IP range (RFC 1918). Must be specified along with end−address and subnet−mask. This address is used as the gateway address. The subsequent address up to and including end−address are placed in the DHCP pool.
end−address: string (optional)
The DHCP IPv4 range end address to use for the interface. Must be in the private IP range (RFC 1918). Must be specified along with start−address and subnet−mask.
subnet−mask: string (optional)
The IPv4 subnet mask to use on the interface. Must be specified along with start−address and subnet−mask.
isolated: boolean (optional)
Enable isolation for this interface. Interface isolation ensures that vmnet interface is not able to communicate with any other vmnet interfaces. Only communication with host is allowed. Requires at least macOS Big Sur 11.0.
nat66−prefix: string (optional)
The IPv6 prefix to use into guest network. Must be a unique local address i.e. start with fd00::/8 and have length of 64.
7.1
CONFIG_VMNET
vmnet (bridged mode) network backend.
Bridges the vmnet interface with a physical network interface.
ifname: string
The name of the physical interface to be bridged.
isolated: boolean (optional)
Enable isolation for this interface. Interface isolation ensures that vmnet interface is not able to communicate with any other vmnet interfaces. Only communication with host is allowed. Requires at least macOS Big Sur 11.0.
7.1
CONFIG_VMNET
Configuration info for stream socket netdev
addr: SocketAddress
socket address to listen on (server=true) or connect to (server=false)
server: boolean (optional)
create server socket (default: false)
reconnect: int (optional)
For a client socket, if a socket is disconnected, then attempt a reconnect after the given number of seconds. Setting this to zero disables this function. (default: 0) (since 8.0)
Only SocketAddress types 'unix', 'inet' and 'fd' are supported.
7.2
Configuration info for datagram socket netdev.
remote: SocketAddress (optional)
remote address
local: SocketAddress (optional)
local address
Only SocketAddress types 'unix', 'inet' and 'fd' are supported.
If remote address is present and it's a multicast address, local address is optional. Otherwise local address is required and remote address is optional.
7.2
Available netdev drivers.
l2tpv3 |
since 2.1 |
vhost−vdpa
since 5.1
vmnet−host (If: CONFIG_VMNET)
since 7.1
vmnet−shared (If: CONFIG_VMNET)
since 7.1
vmnet−bridged (If: CONFIG_VMNET)
since 7.1
stream |
since 7.2 |
|||
dgram |
since 7.2 |
|||
none |
Not documented |
|||
nic |
Not documented |
|||
user |
Not documented |
|||
tap |
Not documented |
|||
socket |
Not documented |
|||
vde |
Not documented |
|||
bridge |
Not documented |
hubport
Not documented
netmap |
Not documented |
vhost−user
Not documented
2.7
Captures the configuration of a network device.
id: string
identifier for monitor commands.
type: NetClientDriver
Specify the driver used for interpreting remaining arguments.
The members of
NetLegacyNicOptions when type is "nic"
The members of NetdevUserOptions when type is
"user"
The members of NetdevTapOptions when type is "tap"
The members of NetdevL2TPv3Options when type is
"l2tpv3"
The members of NetdevSocketOptions when type is
"socket"
The members of NetdevStreamOptions when type is
"stream"
The members of NetdevDgramOptions when type is
"dgram"
The members of NetdevVdeOptions when type is "vde"
The members of NetdevBridgeOptions when type is
"bridge"
The members of NetdevHubPortOptions when type is
"hubport"
The members of NetdevNetmapOptions when type is
"netmap"
The members of NetdevVhostUserOptions when type is
"vhost−user"
The members of NetdevVhostVDPAOptions when type is
"vhost−vdpa"
The members of NetdevVmnetHostOptions when
type is "vmnet−host" (If:
CONFIG_VMNET)
The members of NetdevVmnetSharedOptions when
type is "vmnet−shared"
(If: CONFIG_VMNET)
The members of NetdevVmnetBridgedOptions when
type is "vmnet−bridged"
(If: CONFIG_VMNET)
1.2
Packets receiving state
normal |
filter assigned packets according to the mac−table |
|||
none |
don't receive any assigned packet |
|||
all |
receive all assigned packets |
1.6
Rx−filter information for a NIC.
name: string
net client name
promiscuous: boolean
whether promiscuous mode is enabled
multicast: RxState
multicast receive state
unicast: RxState
unicast receive state
vlan: RxState
vlan receive state (Since 2.0)
broadcast−allowed: boolean
whether to receive broadcast
multicast−overflow: boolean
multicast table is overflowed or not
unicast−overflow: boolean
unicast table is overflowed or not
main−mac: string
the main macaddr string
vlan−table: array of int
a list of active vlan id
unicast−table: array of string
a list of unicast macaddr string
multicast−table: array of string
a list of multicast macaddr string
1.6
Return rx−filter information for all NICs (or for the given NIC).
name: string (optional)
net client name
list of RxFilterInfo for all NICs (or for the given NIC). Returns an error if the given name doesn't exist, or given NIC doesn't support rx−filter querying, or given net client isn't a NIC.
1.6
−> { "execute": "query−rx−filter", "arguments": { "name": "vnet0" } } <− { "return": [ { "promiscuous": true, "name": "vnet0", "main−mac": "52:54:00:12:34:56", "unicast": "normal", "vlan": "normal", "vlan−table": [ 4, 0 ], "unicast−table": [ ], "multicast": "normal", "multicast−overflow": false, "unicast−overflow": false, "multicast−table": [ "01:00:5e:00:00:01", "33:33:00:00:00:01", "33:33:ff:12:34:56" ], "broadcast−allowed": false } ] }
Emitted once until the 'query−rx−filter' command is executed, the first event will always be emitted
name: string (optional)
net client name
path: string
device path
1.6
<− { "event": "NIC_RX_FILTER_CHANGED", "data": { "name": "vnet0", "path": "/machine/peripheral/vnet0/virtio−backend" }, "timestamp": { "seconds": 1368697518, "microseconds": 326866 } }
Parameters for self−announce timers
initial: int
Initial delay (in ms) before sending the first GARP/RARP announcement
max: int
Maximum delay (in ms) between GARP/RARP announcement packets
rounds: int
Number of self−announcement attempts
step: int
Delay increase (in ms) after each self−announcement attempt
interfaces: array of string (optional)
An optional list of interface names, which restricts the announcement to the listed interfaces. (Since 4.1)
id: string (optional)
A name to be used to identify an instance of announce−timers and to allow it to modified later. Not for use as part of the migration parameters. (Since 4.1)
4.0
Trigger generation of broadcast RARP frames to update network switches. This can be useful when network bonds fail−over the active slave.
The members of AnnounceParameters
−> { "execute": "announce−self", "arguments": { "initial": 50, "max": 550, "rounds": 10, "step": 50, "interfaces": ["vn2", "vn3"], "id": "bob" } } <− { "return": {} }
4.0
Emitted when VIRTIO_NET_F_STANDBY was enabled during feature negotiation. Failover primary devices which were hidden (not hotplugged when requested) before will now be hotplugged by the virtio−net standby device.
device−id: string
QEMU device id of the unplugged device
4.2
<− { "event": "FAILOVER_NEGOTIATED", "data": { "device−id": "net1" }, "timestamp": { "seconds": 1368697518, "microseconds": 326866 } }
Emitted when the netdev stream backend is connected
netdev−id: string
QEMU netdev id that is connected
addr: SocketAddress
The destination address
7.2
<− { "event": "NETDEV_STREAM_CONNECTED", "data": { "netdev−id": "netdev0", "addr": { "port": "47666", "ipv6": true, "host": "::1", "type": "inet" } }, "timestamp": { "seconds": 1666269863, "microseconds": 311222 } } <− { "event": "NETDEV_STREAM_CONNECTED", "data": { "netdev−id": "netdev0", "addr": { "path": "/tmp/qemu0", "type": "unix" } }, "timestamp": { "seconds": 1666269706, "microseconds": 413651 } }
Emitted when the netdev stream backend is disconnected
netdev−id: string
QEMU netdev id that is disconnected
7.2
<− { 'event': 'NETDEV_STREAM_DISCONNECTED', 'data': {'netdev−id': 'netdev0'}, 'timestamp': {'seconds': 1663330937, 'microseconds': 526695} }
Emitted when guest driver adds/deletes GID to/from device
netdev: string
RoCE Network Device name
gid−status: boolean
Add or delete indication
subnet−prefix: int
Subnet Prefix
interface−id: int
Interface ID
4.0
<− {"timestamp": {"seconds": 1541579657, "microseconds": 986760}, "event": "RDMA_GID_STATUS_CHANGED", "data": {"netdev": "bridge0", "interface−id": 15880512517475447892, "gid−status": true, "subnet−prefix": 33022}}
Rocker switch information.
name: string
switch name
id: int
switch ID
ports: int
number of front−panel ports
2.4
Return rocker switch information.
name: string
Not documented
Rocker information
2.4
−> { "execute": "query−rocker", "arguments": { "name": "sw1" } } <− { "return": {"name": "sw1", "ports": 2, "id": 1327446905938}}
An eumeration of port duplex states.
half |
half duplex |
|||
full |
full duplex |
2.4
An eumeration of port autoneg states.
off |
autoneg is off |
|||
on |
autoneg is on |
2.4
Rocker switch port information.
name: string
port name
enabled: boolean
port is enabled for I/O
link−up: boolean
physical link is UP on port
speed: int
port link speed in Mbps
duplex: RockerPortDuplex
port link duplex
autoneg: RockerPortAutoneg
port link autoneg
2.4
Return rocker switch port information.
name: string
Not documented
a list of RockerPort information
2.4
−> { "execute": "query−rocker−ports", "arguments": { "name": "sw1" } } <− { "return": [ {"duplex": "full", "enabled": true, "name": "sw1.1", "autoneg": "off", "link−up": true, "speed": 10000}, {"duplex": "full", "enabled": true, "name": "sw1.2", "autoneg": "off", "link−up": true, "speed": 10000} ]}
Rocker switch OF−DPA flow key
priority: int
key priority, 0 being lowest priority
tbl−id: int
flow table ID
in−pport: int (optional)
physical input port
tunnel−id: int (optional)
tunnel ID
vlan−id: int (optional)
VLAN ID
eth−type: int (optional)
Ethernet header type
eth−src: string (optional)
Ethernet header source MAC address
eth−dst: string (optional)
Ethernet header destination MAC address
ip−proto: int (optional)
IP Header protocol field
ip−tos: int (optional)
IP header TOS field
ip−dst: string (optional)
IP header destination address
optional members may or may not appear in the flow key depending if they're relevant to the flow key.
2.4
Rocker switch OF−DPA flow mask
in−pport: int (optional)
physical input port
tunnel−id: int (optional)
tunnel ID
vlan−id: int (optional)
VLAN ID
eth−src: string (optional)
Ethernet header source MAC address
eth−dst: string (optional)
Ethernet header destination MAC address
ip−proto: int (optional)
IP Header protocol field
ip−tos: int (optional)
IP header TOS field
optional members may or may not appear in the flow mask depending if they're relevant to the flow mask.
2.4
Rocker switch OF−DPA flow action
goto−tbl: int (optional)
next table ID
group−id: int (optional)
group ID
tunnel−lport: int (optional)
tunnel logical port ID
vlan−id: int (optional)
VLAN ID
new−vlan−id: int (optional)
new VLAN ID
out−pport: int (optional)
physical output port
optional members may or may not appear in the flow action depending if they're relevant to the flow action.
2.4
Rocker switch OF−DPA flow
cookie: int
flow unique cookie ID
hits: int
count of matches (hits) on flow
key: RockerOfDpaFlowKey
flow key
mask: RockerOfDpaFlowMask
flow mask
action: RockerOfDpaFlowAction
flow action
2.4
Return rocker OF−DPA flow information.
name: string
switch name
tbl−id: int (optional)
flow table ID. If tbl−id is not specified, returns flow information for all tables.
rocker OF−DPA flow information
2.4
−> { "execute": "query−rocker−of−dpa−flows", "arguments": { "name": "sw1" } } <− { "return": [ {"key": {"in−pport": 0, "priority": 1, "tbl−id": 0}, "hits": 138, "cookie": 0, "action": {"goto−tbl": 10}, "mask": {"in−pport": 4294901760} }, {...more...}, ]}
Rocker switch OF−DPA group
id: int
group unique ID
type: int
group type
vlan−id: int (optional)
VLAN ID
pport: int (optional)
physical port number
index: int (optional)
group index, unique with group type
out−pport: int (optional)
output physical port number
group−id: int (optional)
next group ID
set−vlan−id: int (optional)
VLAN ID to set
pop−vlan: int (optional)
pop VLAN headr from packet
group−ids: array of int (optional)
list of next group IDs
set−eth−src: string (optional)
set source MAC address in Ethernet header
set−eth−dst: string (optional)
set destination MAC address in Ethernet header
ttl−check: int (optional)
perform TTL check
optional members may or may not appear in the group depending if they're relevant to the group type.
2.4
Return rocker OF−DPA group information.
name: string
switch name
type: int (optional)
group type. If type is not specified, returns group information for all group types.
rocker OF−DPA group information
2.4
−> { "execute": "query−rocker−of−dpa−groups", "arguments": { "name": "sw1" } } <− { "return": [ {"type": 0, "out−pport": 2, "pport": 2, "vlan−id": 3841, "pop−vlan": 1, "id": 251723778}, {"type": 0, "out−pport": 0, "pport": 0, "vlan−id": 3841, "pop−vlan": 1, "id": 251723776}, {"type": 0, "out−pport": 1, "pport": 1, "vlan−id": 3840, "pop−vlan": 1, "id": 251658241}, {"type": 0, "out−pport": 0, "pport": 0, "vlan−id": 3840, "pop−vlan": 1, "id": 251658240} ]}
An enumeration of TPM models
tpm−tis
TPM TIS model
tpm−crb
TPM CRB model (since 2.12)
tpm−spapr
TPM SPAPR model (since 5.0)
1.5
CONFIG_TPM
Return a list of supported TPM models
a list of TpmModel
1.5
−> { "execute": "query−tpm−models" } <− { "return": [ "tpm−tis", "tpm−crb", "tpm−spapr" ] }
CONFIG_TPM
An enumeration of TPM types
passthrough
TPM passthrough type
emulator
Software Emulator TPM type (since 2.11)
1.5
CONFIG_TPM
Return a list of supported TPM types
a list of TpmType
1.5
−> { "execute": "query−tpm−types" } <− { "return": [ "passthrough", "emulator" ] }
CONFIG_TPM
Information about the TPM passthrough type
path: string (optional)
string describing the path used for accessing the TPM device
cancel−path: string (optional)
string showing the TPM's sysfs cancel file for cancellation of TPM commands while they are executing
1.5
CONFIG_TPM
Information about the TPM emulator type
chardev: string
Name of a unix socket chardev
2.11
CONFIG_TPM
data: TPMPassthroughOptions
Not documented
1.5
CONFIG_TPM
data: TPMEmulatorOptions
Not documented
2.11
CONFIG_TPM
A union referencing different TPM backend types' configuration options
type: TpmType
• |
'passthrough' The configuration options for the TPM passthrough type | ||
• |
'emulator' The configuration options for TPM emulator backend type |
The members of
TPMPassthroughOptionsWrapper when type is
"passthrough"
The members of TPMEmulatorOptionsWrapper when type is
"emulator"
1.5
CONFIG_TPM
Information about the TPM
id: string
The Id of the TPM
model: TpmModel
The TPM frontend model
options: TpmTypeOptions
The TPM (backend) type configuration options
1.5
CONFIG_TPM
Return information about the TPM device
TPMInfo on success
1.5
−> { "execute": "query−tpm" } <− { "return": [ { "model": "tpm−tis", "options": { "type": "passthrough", "data": { "cancel−path": "/sys/class/misc/tpm0/device/cancel", "path": "/dev/tpm0" } }, "id": "tpm0" } ] }
CONFIG_TPM
Display protocols which support changing password options.
vnc |
Not documented |
|||
spice |
Not documented |
7.0
An action to take on changing a password on a connection with active clients.
keep |
maintain existing clients |
|||
fail |
fail the command if clients are connected |
disconnect
disconnect existing clients
7.0
Options for set_password.
protocol: DisplayProtocol
• |
'vnc' to modify the VNC server password |
|||
• |
'spice' to modify the Spice server password |
password: string
the new password
connected: SetPasswordAction (optional)
How to handle existing clients when changing the password. If nothing is specified, defaults to 'keep'. For VNC, only 'keep' is currently implemented.
The members of SetPasswordOptionsVnc when protocol is "vnc"
7.0
Options for set_password specific to the VNC procotol.
display: string (optional)
The id of the display where the password should be changed. Defaults to the first.
7.0
Set the password of a remote display server.
The members of SetPasswordOptions
• |
Nothing on success |
|||
• |
If Spice is not enabled, DeviceNotFound |
0.14
−> { "execute": "set_password", "arguments": { "protocol": "vnc", "password": "secret" } } <− { "return": {} }
General options for expire_password.
protocol: DisplayProtocol
• |
'vnc' to modify the VNC server expiration |
|||
• |
'spice' to modify the Spice server expiration |
time: string
when to expire the password.
• |
'now' to expire the password immediately |
|||
• |
'never' to cancel password expiration |
|||
• |
'+INT' where INT is the number of seconds from now (integer) |
|||
• |
'INT' where INT is the absolute time in seconds |
The members of ExpirePasswordOptionsVnc when protocol is "vnc"
Time is relative to the server and currently there is no way to coordinate server time with client time. It is not recommended to use the absolute time version of the time parameter unless you're sure you are on the same machine as the QEMU instance.
7.0
Options for expire_password specific to the VNC procotol.
display: string (optional)
The id of the display where the expiration should be changed. Defaults to the first.
7.0
Expire the password of a remote display server.
The members of ExpirePasswordOptions
• |
Nothing on success |
|||
• |
If protocol is 'spice' and Spice is not active, DeviceNotFound |
0.14
−> { "execute": "expire_password", "arguments": { "protocol": "vnc", "time": "+60" } } <− { "return": {} }
Supported image format types.
png |
PNG format |
|||
ppm |
PPM format |
7.1
Capture the contents of a screen and write it to a file.
filename: string
the path of a new file to store the image
device: string (optional)
ID of the display device that should be dumped. If this parameter is missing, the primary display will be used. (Since 2.12)
head: int (optional)
head to use in case the device supports multiple heads. If this parameter is missing, head #0 will be used. Also note that the head can only be specified in conjunction with the device ID. (Since 2.12)
format: ImageFormat (optional)
image format for screendump. (default: ppm) (Since 7.1)
Nothing on success
0.14
−> { "execute": "screendump", "arguments": { "filename": "/tmp/image" } } <− { "return": {} }
The basic information for SPICE network connection
host: string
IP address
port: string
port number
family: NetworkAddressFamily
address family
2.1
CONFIG_SPICE
Information about a SPICE server
auth: string (optional)
authentication method
The members of SpiceBasicInfo
2.1
CONFIG_SPICE
Information about a SPICE client channel.
connection−id: int
SPICE connection id number. All channels with the same id belong to the same SPICE session.
channel−type: int
SPICE channel type number. "1" is the main control channel, filter for this one if you want to track spice sessions only
channel−id: int
SPICE channel ID number. Usually "0", might be different when multiple channels of the same type exist, such as multiple display channels in a multihead setup
tls: boolean
true if the channel is encrypted, false otherwise.
The members of SpiceBasicInfo
0.14
CONFIG_SPICE
An enumeration of Spice mouse states.
client |
Mouse cursor position is determined by the client. |
|||
server |
Mouse cursor position is determined by the server. |
unknown
No information is available about mouse mode used by the spice server.
spice/enums.h has a SpiceMouseMode already, hence the name.
1.1
CONFIG_SPICE
Information about the SPICE session.
enabled: boolean
true if the SPICE server is enabled, false otherwise
migrated: boolean
true if the last guest migration completed and spice migration had completed as well. false otherwise. (since 1.4)
host: string (optional)
The hostname the SPICE server is bound to. This depends on the name resolution on the host and may be an IP address.
port: int (optional)
The SPICE server's port number.
compiled−version: string (optional)
SPICE server version.
tls−port: int (optional)
The SPICE server's TLS port number.
auth: string (optional)
the current authentication type used by the server
• |
'none' if no authentication is being used | ||
• |
'spice' uses SASL or direct TLS authentication, depending on command line options |
mouse−mode: SpiceQueryMouseMode
The mode in which the mouse cursor is displayed currently. Can be determined by the client or the server, or unknown if spice server doesn't provide this information. (since: 1.1)
channels: array of SpiceChannel (optional)
a list of SpiceChannel for each active spice channel
0.14
CONFIG_SPICE
Returns information about the current SPICE server
SpiceInfo
0.14
−> { "execute": "query−spice" } <− { "return": { "enabled": true, "auth": "spice", "port": 5920, "migrated":false, "tls−port": 5921, "host": "0.0.0.0", "mouse−mode":"client", "channels": [ { "port": "54924", "family": "ipv4", "channel−type": 1, "connection−id": 1804289383, "host": "127.0.0.1", "channel−id": 0, "tls": true }, { "port": "36710", "family": "ipv4", "channel−type": 4, "connection−id": 1804289383, "host": "127.0.0.1", "channel−id": 0, "tls": false }, [ ... more channels follow ... ] ] } }
CONFIG_SPICE
Emitted when a SPICE client establishes a connection
server: SpiceBasicInfo
server information
client: SpiceBasicInfo
client information
0.14
<− { "timestamp": {"seconds": 1290688046, "microseconds": 388707}, "event": "SPICE_CONNECTED", "data": { "server": { "port": "5920", "family": "ipv4", "host": "127.0.0.1"}, "client": {"port": "52873", "family": "ipv4", "host": "127.0.0.1"} }}
CONFIG_SPICE
Emitted after initial handshake and authentication takes place (if any) and the SPICE channel is up and running
server: SpiceServerInfo
server information
client: SpiceChannel
client information
0.14
<− { "timestamp": {"seconds": 1290688046, "microseconds": 417172}, "event": "SPICE_INITIALIZED", "data": {"server": {"auth": "spice", "port": "5921", "family": "ipv4", "host": "127.0.0.1"}, "client": {"port": "49004", "family": "ipv4", "channel−type": 3, "connection−id": 1804289383, "host": "127.0.0.1", "channel−id": 0, "tls": true} }}
CONFIG_SPICE
Emitted when the SPICE connection is closed
server: SpiceBasicInfo
server information
client: SpiceBasicInfo
client information
0.14
<− { "timestamp": {"seconds": 1290688046, "microseconds": 388707}, "event": "SPICE_DISCONNECTED", "data": { "server": { "port": "5920", "family": "ipv4", "host": "127.0.0.1"}, "client": {"port": "52873", "family": "ipv4", "host": "127.0.0.1"} }}
CONFIG_SPICE
Emitted when SPICE migration has completed
1.3
<− { "timestamp": {"seconds": 1290688046, "microseconds": 417172}, "event": "SPICE_MIGRATE_COMPLETED" }
CONFIG_SPICE
The basic information for vnc network connection
host: string
IP address
service: string
The service name of the vnc port. This may depend on the host system's service database so symbolic names should not be relied on.
family: NetworkAddressFamily
address family
websocket: boolean
true in case the socket is a websocket (since 2.3).
2.1
CONFIG_VNC
The network connection information for server
auth: string (optional)
authentication method used for the plain (non−websocket) VNC server
The members of VncBasicInfo
2.1
CONFIG_VNC
Information about a connected VNC client.
x509_dname: string (optional)
If x509 authentication is in use, the Distinguished Name of the client.
sasl_username: string (optional)
If SASL authentication is in use, the SASL username used for authentication.
The members of VncBasicInfo
0.14
CONFIG_VNC
Information about the VNC session.
enabled: boolean
true if the VNC server is enabled, false otherwise
host: string (optional)
The hostname the VNC server is bound to. This depends on the name resolution on the host and may be an IP address.
family: NetworkAddressFamily (optional)
• |
'ipv6' if the host is listening for IPv6 connections |
|||
• |
'ipv4' if the host is listening for IPv4 connections |
|||
• |
'unix' if the host is listening on a unix domain socket |
|||
• |
'unknown' otherwise |
service: string (optional)
The service name of the server's port. This may depends on the host system's service database so symbolic names should not be relied on.
auth: string (optional)
the current authentication type used by the server
• |
'none' if no authentication is being used | ||
• |
'vnc' if VNC authentication is being used | ||
• |
'vencrypt+plain' if VEncrypt is used with plain text authentication | ||
• |
'vencrypt+tls+none' if VEncrypt is used with TLS and no authentication | ||
• |
'vencrypt+tls+vnc' if VEncrypt is used with TLS and VNC authentication | ||
• |
'vencrypt+tls+plain' if VEncrypt is used with TLS and plain text auth | ||
• |
'vencrypt+x509+none' if VEncrypt is used with x509 and no auth | ||
• |
'vencrypt+x509+vnc' if VEncrypt is used with x509 and VNC auth | ||
• |
'vencrypt+x509+plain' if VEncrypt is used with x509 and plain text auth | ||
• |
'vencrypt+tls+sasl' if VEncrypt is used with TLS and SASL auth | ||
• |
'vencrypt+x509+sasl' if VEncrypt is used with x509 and SASL auth |
clients: array of VncClientInfo (optional)
a list of VncClientInfo of all currently connected clients
0.14
CONFIG_VNC
vnc primary authentication method.
none |
Not documented |
|||
vnc |
Not documented |
|||
ra2 |
Not documented |
|||
ra2ne |
Not documented |
|||
tight |
Not documented |
|||
ultra |
Not documented |
|||
tls |
Not documented |
vencrypt
Not documented
sasl |
Not documented |
2.3
CONFIG_VNC
vnc sub authentication method with vencrypt.
plain |
Not documented |
tls−none
Not documented
x509−none
Not documented
tls−vnc
Not documented
x509−vnc
Not documented
tls−plain
Not documented
x509−plain
Not documented
tls−sasl
Not documented
x509−sasl
Not documented
2.3
CONFIG_VNC
The network connection information for server
auth: VncPrimaryAuth
The current authentication type used by the servers
vencrypt: VncVencryptSubAuth (optional)
The vencrypt sub authentication type used by the servers, only specified in case auth == vencrypt.
The members of VncBasicInfo
2.9
CONFIG_VNC
Information about a vnc server
id: string
vnc server name.
server: array of VncServerInfo2
A list of VncBasincInfo describing all listening sockets. The list can be empty (in case the vnc server is disabled). It also may have multiple entries: normal + websocket, possibly also ipv4 + ipv6 in the future.
clients: array of VncClientInfo
A list of VncClientInfo of all currently connected clients. The list can be empty, for obvious reasons.
auth: VncPrimaryAuth
The current authentication type used by the non−websockets servers
vencrypt: VncVencryptSubAuth (optional)
The vencrypt authentication type used by the servers, only specified in case auth == vencrypt.
display: string (optional)
The display device the vnc server is linked to.
2.3
CONFIG_VNC
Returns information about the current VNC server
VncInfo
0.14
−> { "execute": "query−vnc" } <− { "return": { "enabled":true, "host":"0.0.0.0", "service":"50402", "auth":"vnc", "family":"ipv4", "clients":[ { "host":"127.0.0.1", "service":"50401", "family":"ipv4", "websocket":false } ] } }
CONFIG_VNC
Returns a list of vnc servers. The list can be empty.
a list of VncInfo2
2.3
CONFIG_VNC
Change the VNC server password.
password: string
the new password to use with VNC authentication
1.1
An empty password in this command will set the password to the empty string. Existing clients are unaffected by executing this command.
CONFIG_VNC
Emitted when a VNC client establishes a connection
server: VncServerInfo
server information
client: VncBasicInfo
client information
This event is emitted before any authentication takes place, thus the authentication ID is not provided
0.13
<− { "event": "VNC_CONNECTED", "data": { "server": { "auth": "sasl", "family": "ipv4", "websocket": false, "service": "5901", "host": "0.0.0.0" }, "client": { "family": "ipv4", "service": "58425", "host": "127.0.0.1", "websocket": false } }, "timestamp": { "seconds": 1262976601, "microseconds": 975795 } }
CONFIG_VNC
Emitted after authentication takes place (if any) and the VNC session is made active
server: VncServerInfo
server information
client: VncClientInfo
client information
0.13
<− { "event": "VNC_INITIALIZED", "data": { "server": { "auth": "sasl", "family": "ipv4", "websocket": false, "service": "5901", "host": "0.0.0.0"}, "client": { "family": "ipv4", "service": "46089", "websocket": false, "host": "127.0.0.1", "sasl_username": "luiz" } }, "timestamp": { "seconds": 1263475302, "microseconds": 150772 } }
CONFIG_VNC
Emitted when the connection is closed
server: VncServerInfo
server information
client: VncClientInfo
client information
0.13
<− { "event": "VNC_DISCONNECTED", "data": { "server": { "auth": "sasl", "family": "ipv4", "websocket": false, "service": "5901", "host": "0.0.0.0" }, "client": { "family": "ipv4", "service": "58425", "websocket": false, "host": "127.0.0.1", "sasl_username": "luiz" } }, "timestamp": { "seconds": 1262976601, "microseconds": 975795 } }
CONFIG_VNC
Information about a mouse device.
name: string
the name of the mouse device
index: int
the index of the mouse device
current: boolean
true if this device is currently receiving mouse events
absolute: boolean
true if this device supports absolute coordinates as input
0.14
Returns information about each active mouse device
a list of MouseInfo for each device
0.14
−> { "execute": "query−mice" } <− { "return": [ { "name":"QEMU Microsoft Mouse", "index":0, "current":false, "absolute":false }, { "name":"QEMU PS/2 Mouse", "index":1, "current":true, "absolute":true } ] }
An enumeration of key name.
This is used by the send−key command.
unmapped
since 2.0
pause |
since 2.0 |
|||
ro |
since 2.4 |
kp_comma
since 2.4
kp_equals
since 2.6
power |
since 2.6 |
hiragana
since 2.9
henkan |
since 2.9 |
|||
yen |
since 2.9 |
|||
sleep |
since 2.10 |
|||
wake |
since 2.10 |
audionext
since 2.10
audioprev
since 2.10
audiostop
since 2.10
audioplay
since 2.10
audiomute
since 2.10
volumeup
since 2.10
volumedown
since 2.10
mediaselect
since 2.10
|
since 2.10 |
calculator
since 2.10
computer
since 2.10
ac_home
since 2.10
ac_back
since 2.10
ac_forward
since 2.10
ac_refresh
since 2.10
ac_bookmarks
since 2.10
muhenkan
since 2.12
katakanahiragana
since 2.12
lang1 |
since 6.1 |
|||
lang2 |
since 6.1 |
|||
f13 |
since 8.0 |
|||
f14 |
since 8.0 |
|||
f15 |
since 8.0 |
|||
f16 |
since 8.0 |
|||
f17 |
since 8.0 |
|||
f18 |
since 8.0 |
|||
f19 |
since 8.0 |
|||
f20 |
since 8.0 |
|||
f21 |
since 8.0 |
|||
f22 |
since 8.0 |
|||
f23 |
since 8.0 |
|||
f24 |
since 8.0 |
|||
shift |
Not documented |
shift_r
Not documented
alt |
Not documented |
|||
alt_r |
Not documented |
|||
ctrl |
Not documented |
|||
ctrl_r |
Not documented |
|||
menu |
Not documented |
|||
esc |
Not documented |
|||
1 |
Not documented |
|||
2 |
Not documented |
|||
3 |
Not documented |
|||
4 |
Not documented |
|||
5 |
Not documented |
|||
6 |
Not documented |
|||
7 |
Not documented |
|||
8 |
Not documented |
|||
9 |
Not documented |
|||
0 |
Not documented |
|||
minus |
Not documented |
|||
equal |
Not documented |
backspace
Not documented
tab |
Not documented |
|||
q |
Not documented |
|||
w |
Not documented |
|||
e |
Not documented |
|||
r |
Not documented |
|||
t |
Not documented |
|||
y |
Not documented |
|||
u |
Not documented |
|||
i |
Not documented |
|||
o |
Not documented |
|||
p |
Not documented |
bracket_left
Not documented
bracket_right
Not documented
ret |
Not documented |
|||
a |
Not documented |
|||
s |
Not documented |
|||
d |
Not documented |
|||
f |
Not documented |
|||
g |
Not documented |
|||
h |
Not documented |
|||
j |
Not documented |
|||
k |
Not documented |
|||
l |
Not documented |
semicolon
Not documented
apostrophe
Not documented
grave_accent
Not documented
backslash
Not documented
z |
Not documented |
|||
x |
Not documented |
|||
c |
Not documented |
|||
v |
Not documented |
|||
b |
Not documented |
|||
n |
Not documented |
|||
m |
Not documented |
|||
comma |
Not documented |
|||
dot |
Not documented |
|||
slash |
Not documented |
asterisk
Not documented
spc |
Not documented |
caps_lock
Not documented
f1 |
Not documented |
|||
f2 |
Not documented |
|||
f3 |
Not documented |
|||
f4 |
Not documented |
|||
f5 |
Not documented |
|||
f6 |
Not documented |
|||
f7 |
Not documented |
|||
f8 |
Not documented |
|||
f9 |
Not documented |
|||
f10 |
Not documented |
num_lock
Not documented
scroll_lock
Not documented
kp_divide
Not documented
kp_multiply
Not documented
kp_subtract
Not documented
kp_add |
Not documented |
kp_enter
Not documented
kp_decimal
Not documented
sysrq |
Not documented |
|||
kp_0 |
Not documented |
|||
kp_1 |
Not documented |
|||
kp_2 |
Not documented |
|||
kp_3 |
Not documented |
|||
kp_4 |
Not documented |
|||
kp_5 |
Not documented |
|||
kp_6 |
Not documented |
|||
kp_7 |
Not documented |
|||
kp_8 |
Not documented |
|||
kp_9 |
Not documented |
|||
less |
Not documented |
|||
f11 |
Not documented |
|||
f12 |
Not documented |
|||
|
Not documented |
|||
home |
Not documented |
|||
pgup |
Not documented |
|||
pgdn |
Not documented |
|||
end |
Not documented |
|||
left |
Not documented |
|||
up |
Not documented |
|||
down |
Not documented |
|||
right |
Not documented |
|||
insert |
Not documented |
|||
delete |
Not documented |
|||
stop |
Not documented |
|||
again |
Not documented |
|||
props |
Not documented |
|||
undo |
Not documented |
|||
front |
Not documented |
|||
copy |
Not documented |
|||
open |
Not documented |
|||
paste |
Not documented |
|||
find |
Not documented |
|||
cut |
Not documented |
|||
lf |
Not documented |
|||
help |
Not documented |
|||
meta_l |
Not documented |
|||
meta_r |
Not documented |
compose
Not documented
'sysrq' was mistakenly added to hack around the fact that the ps2 driver was not generating correct scancodes sequences when 'alt+print' was pressed. This flaw is now fixed and the 'sysrq' key serves no further purpose. Any further use of 'sysrq' will be transparently changed to 'print', so they are effectively synonyms.
1.3
number |
Not documented |
|||
qcode |
Not documented |
1.3
data: int
Not documented
1.3
data: QKeyCode
Not documented
1.3
Represents a keyboard key.
type: KeyValueKind
Not documented
The members of IntWrapper
when type is "number"
The members of QKeyCodeWrapper when type is
"qcode"
1.3
Send keys to guest.
keys: array of KeyValue
An array of KeyValue elements. All KeyValues in this array are simultaneously sent to the guest. A KeyValue.number value is sent directly to the guest, while KeyValue.qcode must be a valid QKeyCode value
hold−time: int (optional)
time to delay key up events, milliseconds. Defaults to 100
• |
Nothing on success |
|||
• |
If key is unknown or redundant, GenericError |
1.3
−> { "execute": "send−key", "arguments": { "keys": [ { "type": "qcode", "data": "ctrl" }, { "type": "qcode", "data": "alt" }, { "type": "qcode", "data": "delete" } ] } } <− { "return": {} }
Button of a pointer input device (mouse, tablet).
side |
front side button of a 5−button mouse (since 2.9) |
|||
extra |
rear side button of a 5−button mouse (since 2.9) |
|||
touch |
screen contact on a multi−touch device (since 8.1) |
|||
left |
Not documented |
|||
middle |
Not documented |
|||
right |
Not documented |
wheel−up
Not documented
wheel−down
Not documented
wheel−left
Not documented
wheel−right
Not documented
2.0
Position axis of a pointer input device (mouse, tablet).
x |
Not documented |
|||
y |
Not documented |
2.0
Type of a multi−touch event.
begin |
Not documented |
|||
update |
Not documented |
|||
end |
Not documented |
|||
cancel |
Not documented |
|||
data |
Not documented |
8.1
Keyboard input event.
key: KeyValue
Which key this event is for.
down: boolean
True for key−down and false for key−up events.
2.0
Pointer button input event.
button: InputButton
Which button this event is for.
down: boolean
True for key−down and false for key−up events.
2.0
Pointer motion input event.
axis: InputAxis
Which axis is referenced by value.
value: int
Pointer position. For absolute coordinates the valid range is 0 −> 0x7ffff
2.0
MultiTouch input event.
slot: int
Which slot has generated the event.
tracking−id: int
ID to correlate this event with previously generated events.
axis: InputAxis
Which axis is referenced by value.
value: int
Contact position.
type: InputMultiTouchType
Not documented
8.1
key |
a keyboard input event |
|||
btn |
a pointer button input event |
|||
rel |
a relative pointer motion input event |
|||
abs |
an absolute pointer motion input event |
|||
mtt |
a multi−touch input event |
2.0
data: InputKeyEvent
Not documented
2.0
data: InputBtnEvent
Not documented
2.0
data: InputMoveEvent
Not documented
2.0
data: InputMultiTouchEvent
Not documented
8.1
Input event union.
type: InputEventKind
the type of input event
The members of
InputKeyEventWrapper when type is "key"
The members of InputBtnEventWrapper when type is
"btn"
The members of InputMoveEventWrapper when type is
"rel"
The members of InputMoveEventWrapper when type is
"abs"
The members of InputMultiTouchEventWrapper when type is
"mtt"
2.0
Send input event(s) to guest.
The device and head parameters can be used to send the input event to specific input devices in case (a) multiple input devices of the same kind are added to the virtual machine and (b) you have configured input routing (see docs/multiseat.txt) for those input devices. The parameters work exactly like the device and head properties of input devices. If device is missing, only devices that have no input routing config are admissible. If device is specified, both input devices with and without input routing config are admissible, but devices with input routing config take precedence.
device: string (optional)
display device to send event(s) to.
head: int (optional)
head to send event(s) to, in case the display device supports multiple scanouts.
events: array of InputEvent
List of InputEvent union.
Nothing on success.
2.6
The consoles are visible in the qom tree, under /backend/console[$index]. They have a device link and head property, so it is possible to map which console belongs to which device and display.
1. Press left mouse button. −> { "execute": "input−send−event", "arguments": { "device": "video0", "events": [ { "type": "btn", "data" : { "down": true, "button": "left" } } ] } } <− { "return": {} } −> { "execute": "input−send−event", "arguments": { "device": "video0", "events": [ { "type": "btn", "data" : { "down": false, "button": "left" } } ] } } <− { "return": {} } 2. Press ctrl−alt−del. −> { "execute": "input−send−event", "arguments": { "events": [ { "type": "key", "data" : { "down": true, "key": {"type": "qcode", "data": "ctrl" } } }, { "type": "key", "data" : { "down": true, "key": {"type": "qcode", "data": "alt" } } }, { "type": "key", "data" : { "down": true, "key": {"type": "qcode", "data": "delete" } } } ] } } <− { "return": {} } 3. Move mouse pointer to absolute coordinates (20000, 400). −> { "execute": "input−send−event" , "arguments": { "events": [ { "type": "abs", "data" : { "axis": "x", "value" : 20000 } }, { "type": "abs", "data" : { "axis": "y", "value" : 400 } } ] } } <− { "return": {} }
GTK display options.
grab−on−hover: boolean (optional)
Grab keyboard input on mouse hover.
zoom−to−fit: boolean (optional)
Zoom guest display to fit into the host window. When turned off the host window will be resized instead. In case the display device can notify the guest on window resizes (virtio−gpu) this will default to "on", assuming the guest will resize the display to match the window size then. Otherwise it defaults to "off". (Since 3.1)
show−tabs: boolean (optional)
Display the tab bar for switching between the various graphical interfaces (e.g. VGA and virtual console character devices) by default. (Since 7.1)
show−menubar: boolean (optional)
Display the main window menubar. Defaults to "on". (Since 8.0)
2.12
EGL headless display options.
rendernode: string (optional)
Which DRM render node should be used. Default is the first available node on the host.
3.1
DBus display options.
addr: string (optional)
The D−Bus bus address (default to the session bus).
rendernode: string (optional)
Which DRM render node should be used. Default is the first available node on the host.
p2p: boolean (optional)
Whether to use peer−to−peer connections (accepted through add_client).
audiodev: string (optional)
Use the specified DBus audiodev to export audio.
7.0
Display OpenGL mode.
off |
Disable OpenGL (default). | ||
on |
Use OpenGL, pick context type automatically. Would better be named 'auto' but is called 'on' for backward compatibility with bool type. | ||
core |
Use OpenGL with Core (desktop) Context. | ||
es |
Use OpenGL with ES (embedded systems) Context. |
3.0
Curses display options.
charset: string (optional)
Font charset used by guest (default: CP437).
4.0
Cocoa display options.
left−command−key: boolean (optional)
Enable/disable forwarding of left command key to guest. Allows command−tab window switching on the host without sending this key to the guest when "off". Defaults to "on"
full−grab: boolean (optional)
Capture all key presses, including system combos. This requires accessibility permissions, since it performs a global grab on key events. (default: off) See https://support.apple.com/en−in/guide/mac−help/mh32356/mac
swap−opt−cmd: boolean (optional)
Swap the Option and Command keys so that their key codes match their position on non−Mac keyboards and you can use Meta/Super and Alt where you expect them. (default: off)
7.0
Set of modifier keys that need to be held for shortcut key actions.
lctrl−lalt
Not documented
lshift−lctrl−lalt
Not documented
rctrl |
Not documented |
7.1
SDL2 display options.
grab−mod: HotKeyMod (optional)
Modifier keys that should be pressed together with the "G" key to release the mouse grab.
7.1
Display (user interface) type.
default
The default user interface, selecting from the first available of gtk, sdl, cocoa, and vnc.
none |
No user interface or video output display. The guest will still see an emulated graphics card, but its output will not be displayed to the QEMU user. |
gtk (If: CONFIG_GTK)
The GTK user interface.
sdl (If: CONFIG_SDL)
The SDL user interface.
egl−headless (If: CONFIG_OPENGL)
No user interface, offload GL operations to a local DRI device. Graphical display need to be paired with VNC or Spice. (Since 3.1)
curses (If: CONFIG_CURSES)
Display video output via curses. For graphics device models which support a text mode, QEMU can display this output using a curses/ncurses interface. Nothing is displayed when the graphics device is in graphical mode or if the graphics device does not support a text mode. Generally only the VGA device models support text mode.
cocoa (If: CONFIG_COCOA)
The Cocoa user interface.
spice−app (If: CONFIG_SPICE)
Set up a Spice server and run the default associated application to connect to it. The server will redirect the serial console and QEMU monitors. (Since 4.0)
dbus (If: CONFIG_DBUS_DISPLAY)
Start a D−Bus service for the display. (Since 7.0)
2.12
Display (user interface) options.
type: DisplayType
Which DisplayType qemu should use.
full−screen: boolean (optional)
Start user interface in fullscreen mode (default: off).
window−close: boolean (optional)
Allow to quit qemu with window close button (default: on).
show−cursor: boolean (optional)
Force showing the mouse cursor (default: off). (since: 5.0)
gl: DisplayGLMode (optional)
Enable OpenGL support (default: off).
The members of DisplayGTK
when type is "gtk" (If:
CONFIG_GTK)
The members of DisplayCocoa when type is
"cocoa" (If: CONFIG_COCOA)
The members of DisplayCurses when type is
"curses" (If: CONFIG_CURSES)
The members of DisplayEGLHeadless when type is
"egl−headless" (If:
CONFIG_OPENGL)
The members of DisplayDBus when type is
"dbus" (If:
CONFIG_DBUS_DISPLAY)
The members of DisplaySDL when type is
"sdl" (If: CONFIG_SDL)
2.12
Returns information about display configuration
DisplayOptions
3.1
Available DisplayReload types.
vnc |
VNC display |
6.0
Specify the VNC reload options.
tls−certs: boolean (optional)
reload tls certs or not.
6.0
Options of the display configuration reload.
type: DisplayReloadType
Specify the display type.
The members of DisplayReloadOptionsVNC when type is "vnc"
6.0
Reload display configuration.
The members of DisplayReloadOptions
Nothing on success.
6.0
−> { "execute": "display−reload", "arguments": { "type": "vnc", "tls−certs": true } } <− { "return": {} }
Available DisplayUpdate types.
vnc |
VNC display |
7.1
Specify the VNC reload options.
addresses: array of SocketAddress (optional)
If specified, change set of addresses to listen for connections. Addresses configured for websockets are not touched.
7.1
Options of the display configuration reload.
type: DisplayUpdateType
Specify the display type.
The members of DisplayUpdateOptionsVNC when type is "vnc"
7.1
Update display configuration.
The members of DisplayUpdateOptions
Nothing on success.
7.1
−> { "execute": "display−update", "arguments": { "type": "vnc", "addresses": [ { "type": "inet", "host": "0.0.0.0", "port": "5901" } ] } } <− { "return": {} }
Set migration information for remote display. This makes the server ask the client to automatically reconnect using the new parameters once migration finished successfully. Only implemented for SPICE.
protocol: string
must be "spice"
hostname: string
migration target hostname
port: int (optional)
spice tcp port for plaintext channels
tls−port: int (optional)
spice tcp port for tls−secured channels
cert−subject: string (optional)
server certificate subject
0.14
−> { "execute": "client_migrate_info", "arguments": { "protocol": "spice", "hostname": "virt42.lab.kraxel.org", "port": 1234 } } <− { "return": {} }
The authorization policy result
deny |
deny access |
|||
allow |
allow access |
4.0
The authorization policy match format
exact |
an exact string match |
|||
glob |
string with ? and * shell wildcard support |
4.0
A single authorization rule.
match: string
a string or glob to match against a user identity
policy: QAuthZListPolicy
the result to return if match evaluates to true
format: QAuthZListFormat (optional)
the format of the match rule (default 'exact')
4.0
Properties for authz−list objects.
policy: QAuthZListPolicy (optional)
Default policy to apply when no rule matches (default: deny)
rules: array of QAuthZListRule (optional)
Authorization rules based on matching user
4.0
Properties for authz−listfile objects.
filename: string
File name to load the configuration from. The file must contain valid JSON for AuthZListProperties.
refresh: boolean (optional)
If true, inotify is used to monitor the file, automatically reloading changes. If an error occurs during reloading, all authorizations will fail until the file is next successfully loaded. (default: true if the binary was built with CONFIG_INOTIFY1, false otherwise)
4.0
Properties for authz−pam objects.
service: string
PAM service name to use for authorization
4.0
Properties for authz−simple objects.
identity: string
Identifies the allowed user. Its format depends on the network service that authorization object is associated with. For authorizing based on TLS x509 certificates, the identity must be the x509 distinguished name.
4.0
Detailed migration status.
transferred: int
amount of bytes already transferred to the target VM
remaining: int
amount of bytes remaining to be transferred to the target VM
total: int
total amount of bytes involved in the migration process
duplicate: int
number of duplicate (zero) pages (since 1.2)
skipped: int
number of skipped zero pages. Always zero, only provided for compatibility (since 1.5)
normal: int
number of normal pages (since 1.2)
normal−bytes: int
number of normal bytes sent (since 1.2)
dirty−pages−rate: int
number of pages dirtied by second by the guest (since 1.3)
mbps: number
throughput in megabits/sec. (since 1.6)
dirty−sync−count: int
number of times that dirty ram was synchronized (since 2.1)
postcopy−requests: int
The number of page requests received from the destination (since 2.7)
page−size: int
The number of bytes per page for the various page−based statistics (since 2.10)
multifd−bytes: int
The number of bytes sent through multifd (since 3.0)
pages−per−second: int
the number of memory pages transferred per second (Since 4.0)
precopy−bytes: int
The number of bytes sent in the pre−copy phase (since 7.0).
downtime−bytes: int
The number of bytes sent while the guest is paused (since 7.0).
postcopy−bytes: int
The number of bytes sent during the post−copy phase (since 7.0).
dirty−sync−missed−zero−copy: int
Number of times dirty RAM synchronization could not avoid copying dirty pages. This is between 0 and dirty−sync−count * multifd−channels. (since 7.1)
deprecated
Member skipped is always zero since 1.5.3
0.14
Detailed XBZRLE migration cache statistics
cache−size: int
XBZRLE cache size
bytes: int
amount of bytes already transferred to the target VM
pages: int
amount of pages transferred to the target VM
cache−miss: int
number of cache miss
cache−miss−rate: number
rate of cache miss (since 2.1)
encoding−rate: number
rate of encoded bytes (since 5.1)
overflow: int
number of overflows
1.2
Detailed migration compression statistics
pages: int
amount of pages compressed and transferred to the target VM
busy: int
count of times that no free thread was available to compress data
busy−rate: number
rate of thread busy
compressed−size: int
amount of bytes after compression
compression−rate: number
rate of compressed size
3.1
An enumeration of migration status.
none |
no migration has ever happened. |
|||
setup |
migration process has been initiated. |
cancelling
in the process of cancelling migration.
cancelled
cancelling migration is finished.
active |
in the process of doing migration. |
postcopy−active
like active, but now in postcopy mode. (since 2.5)
postcopy−paused
during postcopy but paused. (since 3.0)
postcopy−recover
trying to recover from a paused postcopy. (since 3.0)
completed
migration is finished.
failed |
some error occurred during migration process. | ||
colo |
VM is in the process of fault tolerance, VM can not get into this state unless colo capability is enabled for migration. (since 2.8) |
pre−switchover
Paused before device serialisation. (since 2.11)
device |
During device serialisation when pause−before−switchover is enabled (since 2.11) |
wait−unplug
wait for device unplug request by guest OS to be completed. (since 4.2)
2.3
Detailed VFIO devices migration statistics
transferred: int
amount of bytes transferred to the target VM by VFIO devices
5.2
Information about current migration process.
status: MigrationStatus (optional)
MigrationStatus describing the current migration status. If this field is not returned, no migration process has been initiated
ram: MigrationStats (optional)
MigrationStats containing detailed migration status, only returned if status is 'active' or 'completed'(since 1.2)
disk: MigrationStats (optional)
MigrationStats containing detailed disk migration status, only returned if status is 'active' and it is a block migration
xbzrle−cache: XBZRLECacheStats (optional)
XBZRLECacheStats containing detailed XBZRLE migration statistics, only returned if XBZRLE feature is on and status is 'active' or 'completed' (since 1.2)
total−time: int (optional)
total amount of milliseconds since migration started. If migration has ended, it returns the total migration time. (since 1.2)
downtime: int (optional)
only present when migration finishes correctly total downtime in milliseconds for the guest. (since 1.3)
expected−downtime: int (optional)
only present while migration is active expected downtime in milliseconds for the guest in last walk of the dirty bitmap. (since 1.3)
setup−time: int (optional)
amount of setup time in milliseconds before the iterations begin but after the QMP command is issued. This is designed to provide an accounting of any activities (such as RDMA pinning) which may be expensive, but do not actually occur during the iterative migration rounds themselves. (since 1.6)
cpu−throttle−percentage: int (optional)
percentage of time guest cpus are being throttled during auto−converge. This is only present when auto−converge has started throttling guest cpus. (Since 2.7)
error−desc: string (optional)
the human readable error description string, when status is 'failed'. Clients should not attempt to parse the error strings. (Since 2.7)
postcopy−blocktime: int (optional)
total time when all vCPU were blocked during postcopy live migration. This is only present when the postcopy−blocktime migration capability is enabled. (Since 3.0)
postcopy−vcpu−blocktime: array of int (optional)
list of the postcopy blocktime per vCPU. This is only present when the postcopy−blocktime migration capability is enabled. (Since 3.0)
compression: CompressionStats (optional)
migration compression statistics, only returned if compression feature is on and status is 'active' or 'completed' (Since 3.1)
socket−address: array of SocketAddress (optional)
Only used for tcp, to know what the real port is (Since 4.0)
vfio: VfioStats (optional)
VfioStats containing detailed VFIO devices migration statistics, only returned if VFIO device is present, migration is supported by all VFIO devices and status is 'active' or 'completed' (since 5.2)
blocked−reasons: array of string (optional)
A list of reasons an outgoing migration is blocked. Present and non−empty when migration is blocked. (since 6.0)
dirty−limit−throttle−time−per−round: int (optional)
Maximum throttle time (in microseconds) of virtual CPUs each dirty ring full round, which shows how MigrationCapability dirty−limit affects the guest during live migration. (Since 8.1)
dirty−limit−ring−full−time: int (optional)
Estimated average dirty ring full time (in microseconds) for each dirty ring full round. The value equals the dirty ring memory size divided by the average dirty page rate of the virtual CPU, which can be used to observe the average memory load of the virtual CPU indirectly. Note that zero means guest doesn't dirty memory. (Since 8.1)
0.14
Returns information about current migration process. If migration is active there will be another json−object with RAM migration status and if block migration is active another one with block migration status.
MigrationInfo
0.14
1. Before the first migration −> { "execute": "query−migrate" } <− { "return": {} } 2. Migration is done and has succeeded −> { "execute": "query−migrate" } <− { "return": { "status": "completed", "total−time":12345, "setup−time":12345, "downtime":12345, "ram":{ "transferred":123, "remaining":123, "total":246, "duplicate":123, "normal":123, "normal−bytes":123456, "dirty−sync−count":15 } } } 3. Migration is done and has failed −> { "execute": "query−migrate" } <− { "return": { "status": "failed" } } 4. Migration is being performed and is not a block migration: −> { "execute": "query−migrate" } <− { "return":{ "status":"active", "total−time":12345, "setup−time":12345, "expected−downtime":12345, "ram":{ "transferred":123, "remaining":123, "total":246, "duplicate":123, "normal":123, "normal−bytes":123456, "dirty−sync−count":15 } } } 5. Migration is being performed and is a block migration: −> { "execute": "query−migrate" } <− { "return":{ "status":"active", "total−time":12345, "setup−time":12345, "expected−downtime":12345, "ram":{ "total":1057024, "remaining":1053304, "transferred":3720, "duplicate":123, "normal":123, "normal−bytes":123456, "dirty−sync−count":15 }, "disk":{ "total":20971520, "remaining":20880384, "transferred":91136 } } } 6. Migration is being performed and XBZRLE is active: −> { "execute": "query−migrate" } <− { "return":{ "status":"active", "total−time":12345, "setup−time":12345, "expected−downtime":12345, "ram":{ "total":1057024, "remaining":1053304, "transferred":3720, "duplicate":10, "normal":3333, "normal−bytes":3412992, "dirty−sync−count":15 }, "xbzrle−cache":{ "cache−size":67108864, "bytes":20971520, "pages":2444343, "cache−miss":2244, "cache−miss−rate":0.123, "encoding−rate":80.1, "overflow":34434 } } }
Migration capabilities enumeration
xbzrle |
Migration supports xbzrle (Xor Based Zero Run Length Encoding). This feature allows us to minimize migration traffic for certain work loads, by sending compressed difference of the pages |
rdma−pin−all
Controls whether or not the entire VM memory footprint is mlock()'d on demand or all at once. Refer to docs/rdma.txt for usage. Disabled by default. (since 2.0)
zero−blocks
During storage migration encode blocks of zeroes efficiently. This essentially saves 1MB of zeroes per block on the wire. Enabling requires source and target VM to support this feature. To enable it is sufficient to enable the capability on the source VM. The feature is disabled by default. (since 1.6)
compress
Use multiple compression threads to accelerate live migration. This feature can help to reduce the migration traffic, by sending compressed pages. Please note that if compress and xbzrle are both on, compress only takes effect in the ram bulk stage, after that, it will be disabled and only xbzrle takes effect, this can help to minimize migration traffic. The feature is disabled by default. (since 2.4 )
events |
generate events for each migration state change (since 2.4 ) |
auto−converge
If enabled, QEMU will automatically throttle down the guest to speed up convergence of RAM migration. (since 1.6)
postcopy−ram
Start executing on the migration target before all of RAM has been migrated, pulling the remaining pages along as needed. The capacity must have the same setting on both source and target or migration will not even start. NOTE: If the migration fails during postcopy the VM will fail. (since 2.6)
x−colo |
If enabled, migration will never end, and the state of the VM on the primary side will be migrated continuously to the VM on secondary side, this process is called COarse−Grain LOck Stepping (COLO) for Non−stop Service. (since 2.8) |
release−ram
if enabled, qemu will free the migrated ram pages on the source during postcopy−ram migration. (since 2.9)
block |
If enabled, QEMU will also migrate the contents of all block devices. Default is disabled. A possible alternative uses mirror jobs to a builtin NBD server on the destination, which offers more flexibility. (Since 2.10) |
return−path
If enabled, migration will use the return path even for precopy. (since 2.10)
pause−before−switchover
Pause outgoing migration before serialising device state and before disabling block IO (since 2.11)
multifd
Use more than one fd for migration (since 4.0)
dirty−bitmaps
If enabled, QEMU will migrate named dirty bitmaps. (since 2.12)
postcopy−blocktime
Calculate downtime for postcopy live migration (since 3.0)
late−block−activate
If enabled, the destination will not activate block devices (and thus take locks) immediately at the end of migration. (since 3.0)
x−ignore−shared
If enabled, QEMU will not migrate shared memory that is accessible on the destination machine. (since 4.0)
validate−uuid
Send the UUID of the source to allow the destination to ensure it is the same. (since 4.2)
background−snapshot
If enabled, the migration stream will be a snapshot of the VM exactly at the point when the migration procedure starts. The VM RAM is saved with running VM. (since 6.0)
zero−copy−send
Controls behavior on sending memory pages on migration. When true, enables a zero−copy mechanism for sending memory pages, if host supports it. Requires that QEMU be permitted to use locked memory for guest RAM pages. (since 7.1)
postcopy−preempt
If enabled, the migration process will allow postcopy requests to preempt precopy stream, so postcopy requests will be handled faster. This is a performance feature and should not affect the correctness of postcopy migration. (since 7.1)
switchover−ack
If enabled, migration will not stop the source VM and complete the migration until an ACK is received from the destination that it's OK to do so. Exactly when this ACK is sent depends on the migrated devices that use this feature. For example, a device can use it to make sure some of its data is sent and loaded in the destination before doing switchover. This can reduce downtime if devices that support this capability are present. 'return−path' capability must be enabled to use it. (since 8.1)
dirty−limit
If enabled, migration will throttle vCPUs as needed to keep their dirty page rate within vcpu−dirty−limit. This can improve responsiveness of large guests during live migration, and can result in more stable read performance. Requires KVM with accelerator property "dirty−ring−size" set. (Since 8.1)
unstable
Members x−colo and x−ignore−shared are experimental.
1.2
Migration capability information
capability: MigrationCapability
capability enum
state: boolean
capability state bool
1.2
Enable/Disable the following migration capabilities (like xbzrle)
capabilities: array of MigrationCapabilityStatus
json array of capability modifications to make
1.2
−> { "execute": "migrate−set−capabilities" , "arguments": { "capabilities": [ { "capability": "xbzrle", "state": true } ] } } <− { "return": {} }
Returns information about the current migration capabilities status
MigrationCapabilityStatus
1.2
−> { "execute": "query−migrate−capabilities" } <− { "return": [ {"state": false, "capability": "xbzrle"}, {"state": false, "capability": "rdma−pin−all"}, {"state": false, "capability": "auto−converge"}, {"state": false, "capability": "zero−blocks"}, {"state": false, "capability": "compress"}, {"state": true, "capability": "events"}, {"state": false, "capability": "postcopy−ram"}, {"state": false, "capability": "x−colo"} ]}
An enumeration of multifd compression methods.
none |
no compression. |
|||
zlib |
use zlib compression method. |
zstd (If: CONFIG_ZSTD)
use zstd compression method.
5.0
persistent: boolean (optional)
If present, the bitmap will be made persistent or transient depending on this parameter.
6.0
name: string
The name of the bitmap.
alias: string
An alias name for migration (for example the bitmap name on the opposite site).
transform: BitmapMigrationBitmapAliasTransform (optional)
Allows the modification of the migrated bitmap. (since 6.0)
5.2
Maps a block node name and the bitmaps it has to aliases for dirty bitmap migration.
node−name: string
A block node name.
alias: string
An alias block node name for migration (for example the node name on the opposite site).
bitmaps: array of BitmapMigrationBitmapAlias
Mappings for the bitmaps on this node.
5.2
Migration parameters enumeration
announce−initial
Initial delay (in milliseconds) before sending the first announce (Since 4.0)
announce−max
Maximum delay (in milliseconds) between packets in the announcement (Since 4.0)
announce−rounds
Number of self−announce packets sent after migration (Since 4.0)
announce−step
Increase in delay (in milliseconds) between subsequent packets in the announcement (Since 4.0)
compress−level
Set the compression level to be used in live migration, the compression level is an integer between 0 and 9, where 0 means no compression, 1 means the best compression speed, and 9 means best compression ratio which will consume more CPU.
compress−threads
Set compression thread count to be used in live migration, the compression thread count is an integer between 1 and 255.
compress−wait−thread
Controls behavior when all compression threads are currently busy. If true (default), wait for a free compression thread to become available; otherwise, send the page uncompressed. (Since 3.1)
decompress−threads
Set decompression thread count to be used in live migration, the decompression thread count is an integer between 1 and 255. Usually, decompression is at least 4 times as fast as compression, so set the decompress−threads to the number about 1/4 of compress−threads is adequate.
throttle−trigger−threshold
The ratio of bytes_dirty_period and bytes_xfer_period to trigger throttling. It is expressed as percentage. The default value is 50. (Since 5.0)
cpu−throttle−initial
Initial percentage of time guest cpus are throttled when migration auto−converge is activated. The default value is 20. (Since 2.7)
cpu−throttle−increment
throttle percentage increase each time auto−converge detects that migration is not making progress. The default value is 10. (Since 2.7)
cpu−throttle−tailslow
Make CPU throttling slower at tail stage At the tail stage of throttling, the Guest is very sensitive to CPU percentage while the cpu−throttle −increment is excessive usually at tail stage. If this parameter is true, we will compute the ideal CPU percentage used by the Guest, which may exactly make the dirty rate match the dirty rate threshold. Then we will choose a smaller throttle increment between the one specified by cpu−throttle−increment and the one generated by ideal CPU percentage. Therefore, it is compatible to traditional throttling, meanwhile the throttle increment won't be excessive at tail stage. The default value is false. (Since 5.1)
tls−creds
ID of the 'tls−creds' object that provides credentials for establishing a TLS connection over the migration data channel. On the outgoing side of the migration, the credentials must be for a 'client' endpoint, while for the incoming side the credentials must be for a 'server' endpoint. Setting this will enable TLS for all migrations. The default is unset, resulting in unsecured migration at the QEMU level. (Since 2.7)
tls−hostname
hostname of the target host for the migration. This is required when using x509 based TLS credentials and the migration URI does not already include a hostname. For example if using fd: or exec: based migration, the hostname must be provided so that the server's x509 certificate identity can be validated. (Since 2.7)
tls−authz
ID of the 'authz' object subclass that provides access control checking of the TLS x509 certificate distinguished name. This object is only resolved at time of use, so can be deleted and recreated on the fly while the migration server is active. If missing, it will default to denying access (Since 4.0)
max−bandwidth
to set maximum speed for migration. maximum speed in bytes per second. (Since 2.8)
downtime−limit
set maximum tolerated downtime for migration. maximum downtime in milliseconds (Since 2.8)
x−checkpoint−delay
The delay time (in ms) between two COLO checkpoints in periodic mode. (Since 2.8)
block−incremental
Affects how much storage is migrated when the block migration capability is enabled. When false, the entire storage backing chain is migrated into a flattened image at the destination; when true, only the active qcow2 layer is migrated and the destination must already have access to the same backing chain as was used on the source. (since 2.10)
multifd−channels
Number of channels used to migrate data in parallel. This is the same number that the number of sockets used for migration. The default value is 2 (since 4.0)
xbzrle−cache−size
cache size to be used by XBZRLE migration. It needs to be a multiple of the target page size and a power of 2 (Since 2.11)
max−postcopy−bandwidth
Background transfer bandwidth during postcopy. Defaults to 0 (unlimited). In bytes per second. (Since 3.0)
max−cpu−throttle
maximum cpu throttle percentage. Defaults to 99. (Since 3.1)
multifd−compression
Which compression method to use. Defaults to none. (Since 5.0)
multifd−zlib−level
Set the compression level to be used in live migration, the compression level is an integer between 0 and 9, where 0 means no compression, 1 means the best compression speed, and 9 means best compression ratio which will consume more CPU. Defaults to 1. (Since 5.0)
multifd−zstd−level
Set the compression level to be used in live migration, the compression level is an integer between 0 and 20, where 0 means no compression, 1 means the best compression speed, and 20 means best compression ratio which will consume more CPU. Defaults to 1. (Since 5.0)
block−bitmap−mapping
Maps block nodes and bitmaps on them to aliases for the purpose of dirty bitmap migration. Such aliases may for example be the corresponding names on the opposite site. The mapping must be one−to−one, but not necessarily complete: On the source, unmapped bitmaps and all bitmaps on unmapped nodes will be ignored. On the destination, encountering an unmapped alias in the incoming migration stream will result in a report, and all further bitmap migration data will then be discarded. Note that the destination does not know about bitmaps it does not receive, so there is no limitation or requirement regarding the number of bitmaps received, or how they are named, or on which nodes they are placed. By default (when this parameter has never been set), bitmap names are mapped to themselves. Nodes are mapped to their block device name if there is one, and to their node name otherwise. (Since 5.2)
x−vcpu−dirty−limit−period
Periodic time (in milliseconds) of dirty limit during live migration. Should be in the range 1 to 1000ms. Defaults to 1000ms. (Since 8.1)
vcpu−dirty−limit
Dirtyrate limit (MB/s) during live migration. Defaults to 1. (Since 8.1)
unstable
Members x−checkpoint−delay and x−vcpu−dirty−limit−period are experimental.
2.4
announce−initial: int (optional)
Initial delay (in milliseconds) before sending the first announce (Since 4.0)
announce−max: int (optional)
Maximum delay (in milliseconds) between packets in the announcement (Since 4.0)
announce−rounds: int (optional)
Number of self−announce packets sent after migration (Since 4.0)
announce−step: int (optional)
Increase in delay (in milliseconds) between subsequent packets in the announcement (Since 4.0)
compress−level: int (optional)
compression level
compress−threads: int (optional)
compression thread count
compress−wait−thread: boolean (optional)
Controls behavior when all compression threads are currently busy. If true (default), wait for a free compression thread to become available; otherwise, send the page uncompressed. (Since 3.1)
decompress−threads: int (optional)
decompression thread count
throttle−trigger−threshold: int (optional)
The ratio of bytes_dirty_period and bytes_xfer_period to trigger throttling. It is expressed as percentage. The default value is 50. (Since 5.0)
cpu−throttle−initial: int (optional)
Initial percentage of time guest cpus are throttled when migration auto−converge is activated. The default value is 20. (Since 2.7)
cpu−throttle−increment: int (optional)
throttle percentage increase each time auto−converge detects that migration is not making progress. The default value is 10. (Since 2.7)
cpu−throttle−tailslow: boolean (optional)
Make CPU throttling slower at tail stage At the tail stage of throttling, the Guest is very sensitive to CPU percentage while the cpu−throttle −increment is excessive usually at tail stage. If this parameter is true, we will compute the ideal CPU percentage used by the Guest, which may exactly make the dirty rate match the dirty rate threshold. Then we will choose a smaller throttle increment between the one specified by cpu−throttle−increment and the one generated by ideal CPU percentage. Therefore, it is compatible to traditional throttling, meanwhile the throttle increment won't be excessive at tail stage. The default value is false. (Since 5.1)
tls−creds: StrOrNull (optional)
ID of the 'tls−creds' object that provides credentials for establishing a TLS connection over the migration data channel. On the outgoing side of the migration, the credentials must be for a 'client' endpoint, while for the incoming side the credentials must be for a 'server' endpoint. Setting this to a non−empty string enables TLS for all migrations. An empty string means that QEMU will use plain text mode for migration, rather than TLS (Since 2.9) Previously (since 2.7), this was reported by omitting tls−creds instead.
tls−hostname: StrOrNull (optional)
hostname of the target host for the migration. This is required when using x509 based TLS credentials and the migration URI does not already include a hostname. For example if using fd: or exec: based migration, the hostname must be provided so that the server's x509 certificate identity can be validated. (Since 2.7) An empty string means that QEMU will use the hostname associated with the migration URI, if any. (Since 2.9) Previously (since 2.7), this was reported by omitting tls−hostname instead.
max−bandwidth: int (optional)
to set maximum speed for migration. maximum speed in bytes per second. (Since 2.8)
downtime−limit: int (optional)
set maximum tolerated downtime for migration. maximum downtime in milliseconds (Since 2.8)
x−checkpoint−delay: int (optional)
the delay time between two COLO checkpoints. (Since 2.8)
block−incremental: boolean (optional)
Affects how much storage is migrated when the block migration capability is enabled. When false, the entire storage backing chain is migrated into a flattened image at the destination; when true, only the active qcow2 layer is migrated and the destination must already have access to the same backing chain as was used on the source. (since 2.10)
multifd−channels: int (optional)
Number of channels used to migrate data in parallel. This is the same number that the number of sockets used for migration. The default value is 2 (since 4.0)
xbzrle−cache−size: int (optional)
cache size to be used by XBZRLE migration. It needs to be a multiple of the target page size and a power of 2 (Since 2.11)
max−postcopy−bandwidth: int (optional)
Background transfer bandwidth during postcopy. Defaults to 0 (unlimited). In bytes per second. (Since 3.0)
max−cpu−throttle: int (optional)
maximum cpu throttle percentage. The default value is 99. (Since 3.1)
multifd−compression: MultiFDCompression (optional)
Which compression method to use. Defaults to none. (Since 5.0)
multifd−zlib−level: int (optional)
Set the compression level to be used in live migration, the compression level is an integer between 0 and 9, where 0 means no compression, 1 means the best compression speed, and 9 means best compression ratio which will consume more CPU. Defaults to 1. (Since 5.0)
multifd−zstd−level: int (optional)
Set the compression level to be used in live migration, the compression level is an integer between 0 and 20, where 0 means no compression, 1 means the best compression speed, and 20 means best compression ratio which will consume more CPU. Defaults to 1. (Since 5.0)
block−bitmap−mapping: array of BitmapMigrationNodeAlias (optional)
Maps block nodes and bitmaps on them to aliases for the purpose of dirty bitmap migration. Such aliases may for example be the corresponding names on the opposite site. The mapping must be one−to−one, but not necessarily complete: On the source, unmapped bitmaps and all bitmaps on unmapped nodes will be ignored. On the destination, encountering an unmapped alias in the incoming migration stream will result in a report, and all further bitmap migration data will then be discarded. Note that the destination does not know about bitmaps it does not receive, so there is no limitation or requirement regarding the number of bitmaps received, or how they are named, or on which nodes they are placed. By default (when this parameter has never been set), bitmap names are mapped to themselves. Nodes are mapped to their block device name if there is one, and to their node name otherwise. (Since 5.2)
x−vcpu−dirty−limit−period: int (optional)
Periodic time (in milliseconds) of dirty limit during live migration. Should be in the range 1 to 1000ms. Defaults to 1000ms. (Since 8.1)
vcpu−dirty−limit: int (optional)
Dirtyrate limit (MB/s) during live migration. Defaults to 1. (Since 8.1)
tls−authz: StrOrNull (optional)
Not documented
unstable
Members x−checkpoint−delay and x−vcpu−dirty−limit−period are experimental.
2.4
Set various migration parameters.
The members of MigrateSetParameters
2.4
−> { "execute": "migrate−set−parameters" , "arguments": { "compress−level": 1 } } <− { "return": {} }
The optional members aren't actually optional.
announce−initial: int (optional)
Initial delay (in milliseconds) before sending the first announce (Since 4.0)
announce−max: int (optional)
Maximum delay (in milliseconds) between packets in the announcement (Since 4.0)
announce−rounds: int (optional)
Number of self−announce packets sent after migration (Since 4.0)
announce−step: int (optional)
Increase in delay (in milliseconds) between subsequent packets in the announcement (Since 4.0)
compress−level: int (optional)
compression level
compress−threads: int (optional)
compression thread count
compress−wait−thread: boolean (optional)
Controls behavior when all compression threads are currently busy. If true (default), wait for a free compression thread to become available; otherwise, send the page uncompressed. (Since 3.1)
decompress−threads: int (optional)
decompression thread count
throttle−trigger−threshold: int (optional)
The ratio of bytes_dirty_period and bytes_xfer_period to trigger throttling. It is expressed as percentage. The default value is 50. (Since 5.0)
cpu−throttle−initial: int (optional)
Initial percentage of time guest cpus are throttled when migration auto−converge is activated. (Since 2.7)
cpu−throttle−increment: int (optional)
throttle percentage increase each time auto−converge detects that migration is not making progress. (Since 2.7)
cpu−throttle−tailslow: boolean (optional)
Make CPU throttling slower at tail stage At the tail stage of throttling, the Guest is very sensitive to CPU percentage while the cpu−throttle −increment is excessive usually at tail stage. If this parameter is true, we will compute the ideal CPU percentage used by the Guest, which may exactly make the dirty rate match the dirty rate threshold. Then we will choose a smaller throttle increment between the one specified by cpu−throttle−increment and the one generated by ideal CPU percentage. Therefore, it is compatible to traditional throttling, meanwhile the throttle increment won't be excessive at tail stage. The default value is false. (Since 5.1)
tls−creds: string (optional)
ID of the 'tls−creds' object that provides credentials for establishing a TLS connection over the migration data channel. On the outgoing side of the migration, the credentials must be for a 'client' endpoint, while for the incoming side the credentials must be for a 'server' endpoint. An empty string means that QEMU will use plain text mode for migration, rather than TLS (Since 2.7) Note: 2.8 reports this by omitting tls−creds instead.
tls−hostname: string (optional)
hostname of the target host for the migration. This is required when using x509 based TLS credentials and the migration URI does not already include a hostname. For example if using fd: or exec: based migration, the hostname must be provided so that the server's x509 certificate identity can be validated. (Since 2.7) An empty string means that QEMU will use the hostname associated with the migration URI, if any. (Since 2.9) Note: 2.8 reports this by omitting tls−hostname instead.
tls−authz: string (optional)
ID of the 'authz' object subclass that provides access control checking of the TLS x509 certificate distinguished name. (Since 4.0)
max−bandwidth: int (optional)
to set maximum speed for migration. maximum speed in bytes per second. (Since 2.8)
downtime−limit: int (optional)
set maximum tolerated downtime for migration. maximum downtime in milliseconds (Since 2.8)
x−checkpoint−delay: int (optional)
the delay time between two COLO checkpoints. (Since 2.8)
block−incremental: boolean (optional)
Affects how much storage is migrated when the block migration capability is enabled. When false, the entire storage backing chain is migrated into a flattened image at the destination; when true, only the active qcow2 layer is migrated and the destination must already have access to the same backing chain as was used on the source. (since 2.10)
multifd−channels: int (optional)
Number of channels used to migrate data in parallel. This is the same number that the number of sockets used for migration. The default value is 2 (since 4.0)
xbzrle−cache−size: int (optional)
cache size to be used by XBZRLE migration. It needs to be a multiple of the target page size and a power of 2 (Since 2.11)
max−postcopy−bandwidth: int (optional)
Background transfer bandwidth during postcopy. Defaults to 0 (unlimited). In bytes per second. (Since 3.0)
max−cpu−throttle: int (optional)
maximum cpu throttle percentage. Defaults to 99. (Since 3.1)
multifd−compression: MultiFDCompression (optional)
Which compression method to use. Defaults to none. (Since 5.0)
multifd−zlib−level: int (optional)
Set the compression level to be used in live migration, the compression level is an integer between 0 and 9, where 0 means no compression, 1 means the best compression speed, and 9 means best compression ratio which will consume more CPU. Defaults to 1. (Since 5.0)
multifd−zstd−level: int (optional)
Set the compression level to be used in live migration, the compression level is an integer between 0 and 20, where 0 means no compression, 1 means the best compression speed, and 20 means best compression ratio which will consume more CPU. Defaults to 1. (Since 5.0)
block−bitmap−mapping: array of BitmapMigrationNodeAlias (optional)
Maps block nodes and bitmaps on them to aliases for the purpose of dirty bitmap migration. Such aliases may for example be the corresponding names on the opposite site. The mapping must be one−to−one, but not necessarily complete: On the source, unmapped bitmaps and all bitmaps on unmapped nodes will be ignored. On the destination, encountering an unmapped alias in the incoming migration stream will result in a report, and all further bitmap migration data will then be discarded. Note that the destination does not know about bitmaps it does not receive, so there is no limitation or requirement regarding the number of bitmaps received, or how they are named, or on which nodes they are placed. By default (when this parameter has never been set), bitmap names are mapped to themselves. Nodes are mapped to their block device name if there is one, and to their node name otherwise. (Since 5.2)
x−vcpu−dirty−limit−period: int (optional)
Periodic time (in milliseconds) of dirty limit during live migration. Should be in the range 1 to 1000ms. Defaults to 1000ms. (Since 8.1)
vcpu−dirty−limit: int (optional)
Dirtyrate limit (MB/s) during live migration. Defaults to 1. (Since 8.1)
unstable
Members x−checkpoint−delay and x−vcpu−dirty−limit−period are experimental.
2.4
Returns information about the current migration parameters
MigrationParameters
2.4
−> { "execute": "query−migrate−parameters" } <− { "return": { "decompress−threads": 2, "cpu−throttle−increment": 10, "compress−threads": 8, "compress−level": 1, "cpu−throttle−initial": 20, "max−bandwidth": 33554432, "downtime−limit": 300 } }
Followup to a migration command to switch the migration to postcopy mode. The postcopy−ram capability must be set on both source and destination before the original migration command.
2.5
−> { "execute": "migrate−start−postcopy" } <− { "return": {} }
Emitted when a migration event happens
status: MigrationStatus
MigrationStatus describing the current migration status.
2.4
<− {"timestamp": {"seconds": 1432121972, "microseconds": 744001}, "event": "MIGRATION", "data": {"status": "completed"} }
Emitted from the source side of a migration at the start of each pass (when it syncs the dirty bitmap)
pass: int
An incrementing count (starting at 1 on the first pass)
2.6
<− { "timestamp": {"seconds": 1449669631, "microseconds": 239225}, "event": "MIGRATION_PASS", "data": {"pass": 2} }
The message transmission between Primary side and Secondary side.
checkpoint−ready
Secondary VM (SVM) is ready for checkpointing
checkpoint−request
Primary VM (PVM) tells SVM to prepare for checkpointing
checkpoint−reply
SVM gets PVM's checkpoint request
vmstate−send
VM's state will be sent by PVM.
vmstate−size
The total size of VMstate.
vmstate−received
VM's state has been received by SVM.
vmstate−loaded
VM's state has been loaded by SVM.
2.8
The COLO current mode.
none |
COLO is disabled. |
primary
COLO node in primary side.
secondary
COLO node in slave side.
2.8
An enumeration of COLO failover status
none |
no failover has ever happened |
require
got failover requirement but not handled
active |
in the process of doing failover |
completed
finish the process of failover
relaunch
restart the failover process, from 'none' −> 'completed' (Since 2.9)
2.8
Emitted when VM finishes COLO mode due to some errors happening or at the request of users.
mode: COLOMode
report COLO mode when COLO exited.
reason: COLOExitReason
describes the reason for the COLO exit.
3.1
<− { "timestamp": {"seconds": 2032141960, "microseconds": 417172}, "event": "COLO_EXIT", "data": {"mode": "primary", "reason": "request" } }
The reason for a COLO exit.
none |
failover has never happened. This state does not occur in the COLO_EXIT event, and is only visible in the result of query−colo−status. |
request
COLO exit is due to an external request.
error |
COLO exit is due to an internal error. |
processing
COLO is currently handling a failover (since 4.0).
3.1
Tell qemu that heartbeat is lost, request it to do takeover procedures. If this command is sent to the PVM, the Primary side will exit COLO mode. If sent to the Secondary, the Secondary side will run failover work, then takes over server operation to become the service VM.
unstable
This command is experimental.
2.8
−> { "execute": "x−colo−lost−heartbeat" } <− { "return": {} }
CONFIG_REPLICATION
Cancel the current executing migration process.
nothing on success
This command succeeds even if there is no migration process running.
0.14
−> { "execute": "migrate_cancel" } <− { "return": {} }
Continue migration when it's in a paused state.
state: MigrationStatus
The state the migration is currently expected to be in
nothing on success
2.11
−> { "execute": "migrate−continue" , "arguments": { "state": "pre−switchover" } } <− { "return": {} }
Migrates the current running guest to another Virtual Machine.
uri: string
the Uniform Resource Identifier of the destination VM
blk: boolean (optional)
do block migration (full disk copy)
inc: boolean (optional)
incremental disk copy migration
detach: boolean (optional)
this argument exists only for compatibility reasons and is ignored by QEMU
resume: boolean (optional)
resume one paused migration, default "off". (since 3.0)
nothing on success
0.14
1. |
The 'query−migrate' command should be used to check migration's progress and final result (this information is provided by the 'status' member) | ||
2. |
All boolean arguments default to false | ||
3. |
The user Monitor's "detach" argument is invalid in QMP and should not be used |
−> { "execute": "migrate", "arguments": { "uri": "tcp:0:4446" } } <− { "return": {} }
Start an incoming migration, the qemu must have been started with −incoming defer
uri: string
The Uniform Resource Identifier identifying the source or address to listen on
nothing on success
2.3
1. |
It's a bad idea to use a string for the uri, but it needs to stay compatible with −incoming and the format of the uri is already exposed above libvirt. | ||
2. |
QEMU must be started with −incoming defer to allow migrate−incoming to be used. | ||
3. |
The uri format is the same as for −incoming |
−> { "execute": "migrate−incoming", "arguments": { "uri": "tcp::4446" } } <− { "return": {} }
Save the state of all devices to file. The RAM and the block devices of the VM are not saved by this command.
filename: string
the file to save the state of the devices to as binary data. See xen−save−devices−state.txt for a description of the binary format.
live: boolean (optional)
Optional argument to ask QEMU to treat this command as part of a live migration. Default to true. (since 2.11)
Nothing on success
1.1
−> { "execute": "xen−save−devices−state", "arguments": { "filename": "/tmp/save" } } <− { "return": {} }
Enable or disable the global dirty log mode.
enable: boolean
true to enable, false to disable.
nothing
1.3
−> { "execute": "xen−set−global−dirty−log", "arguments": { "enable": true } } <− { "return": {} }
Load the state of all devices from file. The RAM and the block devices of the VM are not loaded by this command.
filename: string
the file to load the state of the devices from as binary data. See xen−save−devices−state.txt for a description of the binary format.
2.7
−> { "execute": "xen−load−devices−state", "arguments": { "filename": "/tmp/resume" } } <− { "return": {} }
Enable or disable replication.
enable: boolean
true to enable, false to disable.
primary: boolean
true for primary or false for secondary.
failover: boolean (optional)
true to do failover, false to stop. but cannot be specified if 'enable' is true. default value is false.
nothing.
−> { "execute": "xen−set−replication", "arguments": {"enable": true, "primary": false} } <− { "return": {} }
2.9
CONFIG_REPLICATION
The result format for 'query−xen−replication−status'.
error: boolean
true if an error happened, false if replication is normal.
desc: string (optional)
the human readable error description string, when error is 'true'.
2.9
CONFIG_REPLICATION
Query replication status while the vm is running.
A ReplicationStatus object showing the status.
−> { "execute": "query−xen−replication−status" } <− { "return": { "error": false } }
2.9
CONFIG_REPLICATION
Xen uses this command to notify replication to trigger a checkpoint.
nothing.
−> { "execute": "xen−colo−do−checkpoint" } <− { "return": {} }
2.9
CONFIG_REPLICATION
The result format for 'query−colo−status'.
mode: COLOMode
COLO running mode. If COLO is running, this field will return 'primary' or 'secondary'.
last−mode: COLOMode
COLO last running mode. If COLO is running, this field will return same like mode field, after failover we can use this field to get last colo mode. (since 4.0)
reason: COLOExitReason
describes the reason for the COLO exit.
3.1
CONFIG_REPLICATION
Query COLO status while the vm is running.
A COLOStatus object showing the status.
−> { "execute": "query−colo−status" } <− { "return": { "mode": "primary", "last−mode": "none", "reason": "request" } }
3.1
CONFIG_REPLICATION
Provide a recovery migration stream URI.
uri: string
the URI to be used for the recovery of migration stream.
nothing.
−> { "execute": "migrate−recover", "arguments": { "uri": "tcp:192.168.1.200:12345" } } <− { "return": {} }
3.0
Pause a migration. Currently it only supports postcopy.
nothing.
−> { "execute": "migrate−pause" } <− { "return": {} }
3.0
Emitted from source side of a migration when migration state is WAIT_UNPLUG. Device was unplugged by guest operating system. Device resources in QEMU are kept on standby to be able to re−plug it in case of migration failure.
device−id: string
QEMU device id of the unplugged device
4.2
<− { "event": "UNPLUG_PRIMARY", "data": { "device−id": "hostdev0" }, "timestamp": { "seconds": 1265044230, "microseconds": 450486 } }
Dirty rate of vcpu.
id: int
vcpu index.
dirty−rate: int
dirty rate.
6.2
Dirty page rate measurement status.
unstarted
measuring thread has not been started yet
measuring
measuring thread is running
measured
dirty page rate is measured and the results are available
5.2
Method used to measure dirty page rate. Differences between available methods are explained in calc−dirty−rate.
page−sampling
use page sampling
dirty−ring
use dirty ring
dirty−bitmap
use dirty bitmap
6.2
Information about measured dirty page rate.
dirty−rate: int (optional)
an estimate of the dirty page rate of the VM in units of MiB/s. Value is present only when status is 'measured'.
status: DirtyRateStatus
current status of dirty page rate measurements
start−time: int
start time in units of second for calculation
calc−time: int
time period for which dirty page rate was measured (in seconds)
sample−pages: int
number of sampled pages per GiB of guest memory. Valid only in page−sampling mode (Since 6.1)
mode: DirtyRateMeasureMode
mode that was used to measure dirty page rate (Since 6.2)
vcpu−dirty−rate: array of DirtyRateVcpu (optional)
dirty rate for each vCPU if dirty−ring mode was specified (Since 6.2)
5.2
Start measuring dirty page rate of the VM. Results can be retrieved with query−dirty−rate after measurements are completed.
Dirty page rate is the number of pages changed in a given time period expressed in MiB/s. The following methods of calculation are available:
1. |
In page sampling mode, a random subset of pages are selected and hashed twice: once at the beginning of measurement time period, and once again at the end. If two hashes for some page are different, the page is counted as changed. Since this method relies on sampling and hashing, calculated dirty page rate is only an estimate of its true value. Increasing sample−pages improves estimation quality at the cost of higher computational overhead. | ||
2. |
Dirty bitmap mode captures writes to memory (for example by temporarily revoking write access to all pages) and counting page faults. Information about modified pages is collected into a bitmap, where each bit corresponds to one guest page. This mode requires that KVM accelerator property "dirty−ring−size" is not set. | ||
3. |
Dirty ring mode is similar to dirty bitmap mode, but the information about modified pages is collected into ring buffer. This mode tracks page modification per each vCPU separately. It requires that KVM accelerator property "dirty−ring−size" is set. |
calc−time: int
time period in units of second for which dirty page rate is calculated. Note that larger calc−time values will typically result in smaller dirty page rates because page dirtying is a one−time event. Once some page is counted as dirty during calc−time period, further writes to this page will not increase dirty page rate anymore.
sample−pages: int (optional)
number of sampled pages per each GiB of guest memory. Default value is 512. For 4KiB guest pages this corresponds to sampling ratio of 0.2%. This argument is used only in page sampling mode. (Since 6.1)
mode: DirtyRateMeasureMode (optional)
mechanism for tracking dirty pages. Default value is 'page−sampling'. Others are 'dirty−bitmap' and 'dirty−ring'. (Since 6.1)
5.2
−> {"execute": "calc−dirty−rate", "arguments": {"calc−time": 1, 'sample−pages': 512} } <− { "return": {} }
Query results of the most recent invocation of calc−dirty−rate.
5.2
1. Measurement is in progress: <− {"status": "measuring", "sample−pages": 512, "mode": "page−sampling", "start−time": 3665220, "calc−time": 10} 2. Measurement has been completed: <− {"status": "measured", "sample−pages": 512, "dirty−rate": 108, "mode": "page−sampling", "start−time": 3665220, "calc−time": 10}
Dirty page rate limit information of a virtual CPU.
cpu−index: int
index of a virtual CPU.
limit−rate: int
upper limit of dirty page rate (MB/s) for a virtual CPU, 0 means unlimited.
current−rate: int
current dirty page rate (MB/s) for a virtual CPU.
7.1
Set the upper limit of dirty page rate for virtual CPUs.
Requires KVM with accelerator property "dirty−ring−size" set. A virtual CPU's dirty page rate is a measure of its memory load. To observe dirty page rates, use calc−dirty−rate.
cpu−index: int (optional)
index of a virtual CPU, default is all.
dirty−rate: int
upper limit of dirty page rate (MB/s) for virtual CPUs.
7.1
−> {"execute": "set−vcpu−dirty−limit"} "arguments": { "dirty−rate": 200, "cpu−index": 1 } } <− { "return": {} }
Cancel the upper limit of dirty page rate for virtual CPUs.
Cancel the dirty page limit for the vCPU which has been set with set−vcpu−dirty−limit command. Note that this command requires support from dirty ring, same as the "set−vcpu−dirty−limit".
cpu−index: int (optional)
index of a virtual CPU, default is all.
7.1
−> {"execute": "cancel−vcpu−dirty−limit"}, "arguments": { "cpu−index": 1 } } <− { "return": {} }
Returns information about virtual CPU dirty page rate limits, if any.
7.1
−> {"execute": "query−vcpu−dirty−limit"} <− {"return": [ { "limit−rate": 60, "current−rate": 3, "cpu−index": 0}, { "limit−rate": 60, "current−rate": 3, "cpu−index": 1}]}
Information about migrationthreads
name: string
the name of migration thread
thread−id: int
ID of the underlying host thread
7.2
Returns information of migration threads
data: migration thread name
information about migration threads
7.2
Save a VM snapshot
job−id: string
identifier for the newly created job
tag: string
name of the snapshot to create
vmstate: string
block device node name to save vmstate to
devices: array of string
list of block device node names to save a snapshot to
Applications should not assume that the snapshot save is complete when this command returns. The job commands / events must be used to determine completion and to fetch details of any errors that arise.
Note that execution of the guest CPUs may be stopped during the time it takes to save the snapshot. A future version of QEMU may ensure CPUs are executing continuously.
It is strongly recommended that devices contain all writable block device nodes if a consistent snapshot is required.
If tag already exists, an error will be reported
nothing
−> { "execute": "snapshot−save", "arguments": { "job−id": "snapsave0", "tag": "my−snap", "vmstate": "disk0", "devices": ["disk0", "disk1"] } } <− { "return": { } } <− {"event": "JOB_STATUS_CHANGE", "timestamp": {"seconds": 1432121972, "microseconds": 744001}, "data": {"status": "created", "id": "snapsave0"}} <− {"event": "JOB_STATUS_CHANGE", "timestamp": {"seconds": 1432122172, "microseconds": 744001}, "data": {"status": "running", "id": "snapsave0"}} <− {"event": "STOP", "timestamp": {"seconds": 1432122372, "microseconds": 744001} } <− {"event": "RESUME", "timestamp": {"seconds": 1432122572, "microseconds": 744001} } <− {"event": "JOB_STATUS_CHANGE", "timestamp": {"seconds": 1432122772, "microseconds": 744001}, "data": {"status": "waiting", "id": "snapsave0"}} <− {"event": "JOB_STATUS_CHANGE", "timestamp": {"seconds": 1432122972, "microseconds": 744001}, "data": {"status": "pending", "id": "snapsave0"}} <− {"event": "JOB_STATUS_CHANGE", "timestamp": {"seconds": 1432123172, "microseconds": 744001}, "data": {"status": "concluded", "id": "snapsave0"}} −> {"execute": "query−jobs"} <− {"return": [{"current−progress": 1, "status": "concluded", "total−progress": 1, "type": "snapshot−save", "id": "snapsave0"}]}
6.0
Load a VM snapshot
job−id: string
identifier for the newly created job
tag: string
name of the snapshot to load.
vmstate: string
block device node name to load vmstate from
devices: array of string
list of block device node names to load a snapshot from
Applications should not assume that the snapshot load is complete when this command returns. The job commands / events must be used to determine completion and to fetch details of any errors that arise.
Note that execution of the guest CPUs will be stopped during the time it takes to load the snapshot.
It is strongly recommended that devices contain all writable block device nodes that can have changed since the original snapshot−save command execution.
nothing
−> { "execute": "snapshot−load", "arguments": { "job−id": "snapload0", "tag": "my−snap", "vmstate": "disk0", "devices": ["disk0", "disk1"] } } <− { "return": { } } <− {"event": "JOB_STATUS_CHANGE", "timestamp": {"seconds": 1472124172, "microseconds": 744001}, "data": {"status": "created", "id": "snapload0"}} <− {"event": "JOB_STATUS_CHANGE", "timestamp": {"seconds": 1472125172, "microseconds": 744001}, "data": {"status": "running", "id": "snapload0"}} <− {"event": "STOP", "timestamp": {"seconds": 1472125472, "microseconds": 744001} } <− {"event": "RESUME", "timestamp": {"seconds": 1472125872, "microseconds": 744001} } <− {"event": "JOB_STATUS_CHANGE", "timestamp": {"seconds": 1472126172, "microseconds": 744001}, "data": {"status": "waiting", "id": "snapload0"}} <− {"event": "JOB_STATUS_CHANGE", "timestamp": {"seconds": 1472127172, "microseconds": 744001}, "data": {"status": "pending", "id": "snapload0"}} <− {"event": "JOB_STATUS_CHANGE", "timestamp": {"seconds": 1472128172, "microseconds": 744001}, "data": {"status": "concluded", "id": "snapload0"}} −> {"execute": "query−jobs"} <− {"return": [{"current−progress": 1, "status": "concluded", "total−progress": 1, "type": "snapshot−load", "id": "snapload0"}]}
6.0
Delete a VM snapshot
job−id: string
identifier for the newly created job
tag: string
name of the snapshot to delete.
devices: array of string
list of block device node names to delete a snapshot from
Applications should not assume that the snapshot delete is complete when this command returns. The job commands / events must be used to determine completion and to fetch details of any errors that arise.
nothing
−> { "execute": "snapshot−delete", "arguments": { "job−id": "snapdelete0", "tag": "my−snap", "devices": ["disk0", "disk1"] } } <− { "return": { } } <− {"event": "JOB_STATUS_CHANGE", "timestamp": {"seconds": 1442124172, "microseconds": 744001}, "data": {"status": "created", "id": "snapdelete0"}} <− {"event": "JOB_STATUS_CHANGE", "timestamp": {"seconds": 1442125172, "microseconds": 744001}, "data": {"status": "running", "id": "snapdelete0"}} <− {"event": "JOB_STATUS_CHANGE", "timestamp": {"seconds": 1442126172, "microseconds": 744001}, "data": {"status": "waiting", "id": "snapdelete0"}} <− {"event": "JOB_STATUS_CHANGE", "timestamp": {"seconds": 1442127172, "microseconds": 744001}, "data": {"status": "pending", "id": "snapdelete0"}} <− {"event": "JOB_STATUS_CHANGE", "timestamp": {"seconds": 1442128172, "microseconds": 744001}, "data": {"status": "concluded", "id": "snapdelete0"}} −> {"execute": "query−jobs"} <− {"return": [{"current−progress": 1, "status": "concluded", "total−progress": 1, "type": "snapshot−delete", "id": "snapdelete0"}]}
6.0
This action can be used to test transaction failure.
1.6
An enumeration of Transactional completion modes.
individual
Do not attempt to cancel any other Actions if any Actions fail after the Transaction request succeeds. All Actions that can complete successfully will do so without waiting on others. This is the default.
grouped
If any Action fails after the Transaction succeeds, cancel all Actions. Actions do not complete until all Actions are ready to complete. May be rejected by Actions that do not support this completion mode.
2.5
abort |
Since 1.6 |
block−dirty−bitmap−add
Since 2.5
block−dirty−bitmap−remove
Since 4.2
block−dirty−bitmap−clear
Since 2.5
block−dirty−bitmap−enable
Since 4.0
block−dirty−bitmap−disable
Since 4.0
block−dirty−bitmap−merge
Since 4.0
blockdev−backup
Since 2.3
blockdev−snapshot
Since 2.5
blockdev−snapshot−internal−sync
Since 1.7
blockdev−snapshot−sync
since 1.1
drive−backup
Since 1.6
deprecated
Member drive−backup is deprecated. Use member blockdev−backup instead.
1.1
data: Abort
Not documented
1.6
data: BlockDirtyBitmapAdd
Not documented
2.5
data: BlockDirtyBitmap
Not documented
2.5
data: BlockDirtyBitmapMerge
Not documented
4.0
data: BlockdevBackup
Not documented
2.3
data: BlockdevSnapshot
Not documented
2.5
data: BlockdevSnapshotInternal
Not documented
1.7
data: BlockdevSnapshotSync
Not documented
1.1
data: DriveBackup
Not documented
1.6
A discriminated record of operations that can be performed with transaction.
type: TransactionActionKind
Not documented
The members of AbortWrapper
when type is "abort"
The members of BlockDirtyBitmapAddWrapper when type is
"block−dirty−bitmap−add"
The members of BlockDirtyBitmapWrapper when type is
"block−dirty−bitmap−remove"
The members of BlockDirtyBitmapWrapper when type is
"block−dirty−bitmap−clear"
The members of BlockDirtyBitmapWrapper when type is
"block−dirty−bitmap−enable"
The members of BlockDirtyBitmapWrapper when type is
"block−dirty−bitmap−disable"
The members of BlockDirtyBitmapMergeWrapper when type is
"block−dirty−bitmap−merge"
The members of BlockdevBackupWrapper when type is
"blockdev−backup"
The members of BlockdevSnapshotWrapper when type is
"blockdev−snapshot"
The members of BlockdevSnapshotInternalWrapper when type is
"blockdev−snapshot−internal−sync"
The members of BlockdevSnapshotSyncWrapper when type is
"blockdev−snapshot−sync"
The members of DriveBackupWrapper when type is
"drive−backup"
1.1
Optional arguments to modify the behavior of a Transaction.
completion−mode: ActionCompletionMode (optional)
Controls how jobs launched asynchronously by Actions will complete or fail as a group. See ActionCompletionMode for details.
2.5
Executes a number of transactionable QMP commands atomically. If any operation fails, then the entire set of actions will be abandoned and the appropriate error returned.
For external snapshots, the dictionary contains the device, the file to use for the new snapshot, and the format. The default format, if not specified, is qcow2.
Each new snapshot defaults to being created by QEMU (wiping any contents if the file already exists), but it is also possible to reuse an externally−created file. In the latter case, you should ensure that the new image file has the same contents as the current one; QEMU cannot perform any meaningful check. Typically this is achieved by using the current image file as the backing file for the new image.
On failure, the original disks pre−snapshot attempt will be used.
For internal snapshots, the dictionary contains the device and the snapshot's name. If an internal snapshot matching name already exists, the request will be rejected. Only some image formats support it, for example, qcow2, and rbd,
On failure, qemu will try delete the newly created internal snapshot in the transaction. When an I/O error occurs during deletion, the user needs to fix it later with qemu−img or other command.
actions: array of TransactionAction
List of TransactionAction; information needed for the respective operations.
properties: TransactionProperties (optional)
structure of additional options to control the execution of the transaction. See TransactionProperties for additional detail.
nothing on success
Errors depend on the operations of the transaction
The transaction aborts on the first failure. Therefore, there will be information on only one failed operation returned in an error condition, and subsequent actions will not have been attempted.
1.1
−> { "execute": "transaction", "arguments": { "actions": [ { "type": "blockdev−snapshot−sync", "data" : { "device": "ide−hd0", "snapshot−file": "/some/place/my−image", "format": "qcow2" } }, { "type": "blockdev−snapshot−sync", "data" : { "node−name": "myfile", "snapshot−file": "/some/place/my−image2", "snapshot−node−name": "node3432", "mode": "existing", "format": "qcow2" } }, { "type": "blockdev−snapshot−sync", "data" : { "device": "ide−hd1", "snapshot−file": "/some/place/my−image2", "mode": "existing", "format": "qcow2" } }, { "type": "blockdev−snapshot−internal−sync", "data" : { "device": "ide−hd2", "name": "snapshot0" } } ] } } <− { "return": {} }
State of a tracing event.
unavailable
The event is statically disabled.
disabled
The event is dynamically disabled.
enabled
The event is dynamically enabled.
2.2
Information of a tracing event.
name: string
Event name.
state: TraceEventState
Tracing state.
vcpu: boolean
Whether this is a per−vCPU event (since 2.7).
deprecated
Member vcpu is deprecated, and always ignored.
2.2
Query the state of events.
name: string
Event name pattern (case−sensitive glob).
vcpu: int (optional)
The vCPU to query (since 2.7).
deprecated
Member vcpu is deprecated, and always ignored.
a list of TraceEventInfo for the matching events
2.2
−> { "execute": "trace−event−get−state", "arguments": { "name": "qemu_memalign" } } <− { "return": [ { "name": "qemu_memalign", "state": "disabled", "vcpu": false } ] }
Set the dynamic tracing state of events.
name: string
Event name pattern (case−sensitive glob).
enable: boolean
Whether to enable tracing.
ignore−unavailable: boolean (optional)
Do not match unavailable events with name.
vcpu: int (optional)
The vCPU to act upon (all by default; since 2.7).
deprecated
Member vcpu is deprecated, and always ignored.
2.2
−> { "execute": "trace−event−set−state", "arguments": { "name": "qemu_memalign", "enable": true } } <− { "return": {} }
Policy for handling "funny" input.
accept |
Accept silently |
|||
reject |
Reject with an error |
|||
crash |
abort() the process |
6.0
Policy for handling "funny" output.
accept |
Pass on unchanged |
|||
hide |
Filter out |
6.0
Policy for handling deprecated management interfaces.
This is intended for testing users of the management interfaces.
Limitation: covers only syntactic aspects of QMP, i.e. stuff tagged with feature 'deprecated'. We may want to extend it to cover semantic aspects and CLI.
Limitation: deprecated−output policy hide is not implemented for enumeration values. They behave the same as with policy accept.
deprecated−input: CompatPolicyInput (optional)
how to handle deprecated input (default 'accept')
deprecated−output: CompatPolicyOutput (optional)
how to handle deprecated output (default 'accept')
unstable−input: CompatPolicyInput (optional)
how to handle unstable input (default 'accept') (since 6.2)
unstable−output: CompatPolicyOutput (optional)
how to handle unstable output (default 'accept') (since 6.2)
6.0
Enable QMP capabilities.
Arguments:
enable: array of QMPCapability (optional)
An optional list of QMPCapability values to enable. The client must not enable any capability that is not mentioned in the QMP greeting message. If the field is not provided, it means no QMP capabilities will be enabled. (since 2.12)
−> { "execute": "qmp_capabilities", "arguments": { "enable": [ "oob" ] } } <− { "return": {} }
This command is valid exactly when first connecting: it must be issued before any other command will be accepted, and will fail once the monitor is accepting other commands. (see qemu docs/interop/qmp−spec.rst)
The QMP client needs to explicitly enable QMP capabilities, otherwise all the QMP capabilities will be turned off by default.
0.13
Enumeration of capabilities to be advertised during initial client connection, used for agreeing on particular QMP extension behaviors.
oob |
QMP ability to support out−of−band requests. (Please refer to qmp−spec.rst for more information on OOB) |
2.12
A three−part version number.
major: int
The major version number.
minor: int
The minor version number.
micro: int
The micro version number.
2.4
A description of QEMU's version.
qemu: VersionTriple
The version of QEMU. By current convention, a micro version of 50 signifies a development branch. A micro version greater than or equal to 90 signifies a release candidate for the next minor version. A micro version of less than 50 signifies a stable release.
package: string
QEMU will always set this field to an empty string. Downstream versions of QEMU should set this to a non−empty string. The exact format depends on the downstream however it highly recommended that a unique name is used.
0.14
Returns the current version of QEMU.
A VersionInfo object describing the current version of QEMU.
0.14
−> { "execute": "query−version" } <− { "return":{ "qemu":{ "major":0, "minor":11, "micro":5 }, "package":"" } }
Information about a QMP command
name: string
The command name
0.14
Return a list of supported QMP commands by this server
A list of CommandInfo for all supported commands
0.14
−> { "execute": "query−commands" } <− { "return":[ { "name":"query−balloon" }, { "name":"system_powerdown" } ] }
This example has been shortened as the real response is too long.
This command will cause the QEMU process to exit gracefully. While every attempt is made to send the QMP response before terminating, this is not guaranteed. When using this interface, a premature EOF would not be unexpected.
0.14
−> { "execute": "quit" } <− { "return": {} }
An enumeration of monitor modes.
readline
HMP monitor (human−oriented command line interface)
control
QMP monitor (JSON−based machine interface)
5.0
Options to be used for adding a new monitor.
id: string (optional)
Name of the monitor
mode: MonitorMode (optional)
Selects the monitor mode (default: readline in the system emulator, control in qemu−storage−daemon)
pretty: boolean (optional)
Enables pretty printing (QMP only)
chardev: string
Name of a character device to expose the monitor on
5.0
Command query−qmp−schema exposes the QMP wire ABI as an array of SchemaInfo. This lets QMP clients figure out what commands and events are available in this QEMU, and their parameters and results.
However, the SchemaInfo can't reflect all the rules and restrictions that apply to QMP. It's interface introspection (figuring out what's there), not interface specification. The specification is in the QAPI schema.
Furthermore, while we strive to keep the QMP wire format backwards−compatible across qemu versions, the introspection output is not guaranteed to have the same stability. For example, one version of qemu may list an object member as an optional non−variant, while another lists the same member only through the object's variants; or the type of a member may change from a generic string into a specific enum or from one specific type into an alternate that includes the original type alongside something else.
array of SchemaInfo, where each element describes an entity in the ABI: command, event, type, ...
The order of the various SchemaInfo is unspecified; however, all names are guaranteed to be unique (no name will be duplicated with different meta−types).
the QAPI schema is also used to help define internal interfaces, by defining QAPI types. These are not part of the QMP wire ABI, and therefore not returned by this command.
2.5
This is a SchemaInfo's meta type, i.e. the kind of entity it describes.
builtin
a predefined type such as 'int' or 'bool'.
enum |
an enumeration type |
|||
array |
an array type |
|||
object |
an object type (struct or union) |
alternate
an alternate type
command
a QMP command
event |
a QMP event |
2.5
name: string
the entity's name, inherited from base. The SchemaInfo is always referenced by this name. Commands and events have the name defined in the QAPI schema. Unlike command and event names, type names are not part of the wire ABI. Consequently, type names are meaningless strings here, although they are still guaranteed unique regardless of meta−type.
meta−type: SchemaMetaType
the entity's meta type, inherited from base.
features: array of string (optional)
names of features associated with the entity, in no particular order. (since 4.1 for object types, 4.2 for commands, 5.0 for the rest)
The members of
SchemaInfoBuiltin when meta−type is
"builtin"
The members of SchemaInfoEnum when meta−type is
"enum"
The members of SchemaInfoArray when meta−type is
"array"
The members of SchemaInfoObject when meta−type is
"object"
The members of SchemaInfoAlternate when meta−type is
"alternate"
The members of SchemaInfoCommand when meta−type is
"command"
The members of SchemaInfoEvent when meta−type is
"event"
Additional members depend on the value of
meta−type.
2.5
Additional SchemaInfo members for meta−type 'builtin'.
json−type: JSONType
the JSON type used for this type on the wire.
2.5
The four primitive and two structured types according to RFC 8259 section 1, plus 'int' (split off 'number'), plus the obvious top type 'value'.
string |
Not documented |
|||
number |
Not documented |
|||
int |
Not documented |
boolean
Not documented
null |
Not documented |
|||
object |
Not documented |
|||
array |
Not documented |
|||
value |
Not documented |
2.5
Additional SchemaInfo members for meta−type 'enum'.
members: array of SchemaInfoEnumMember
the enum type's members, in no particular order (since 6.2).
values: array of string
the enumeration type's member names, in no particular order. Redundant with members. Just for backward compatibility.
deprecated
Member values is deprecated. Use members instead.
Values of this type are JSON string on the wire.
2.5
An object member.
name: string
the member's name, as defined in the QAPI schema.
features: array of string (optional)
names of features associated with the member, in no particular order.
6.2
Additional SchemaInfo members for meta−type 'array'.
element−type: string
the array type's element type.
Values of this type are JSON array on the wire.
2.5
Additional SchemaInfo members for meta−type 'object'.
members: array of SchemaInfoObjectMember
the object type's (non−variant) members, in no particular order.
tag: string (optional)
the name of the member serving as type tag. An element of members with this name must exist.
variants: array of SchemaInfoObjectVariant (optional)
variant members, i.e. additional members that depend on the type tag's value. Present exactly when tag is present. The variants are in no particular order, and may even differ from the order of the values of the enum type of the tag.
Values of this type are JSON object on the wire.
2.5
An object member.
name: string
the member's name, as defined in the QAPI schema.
type: string
the name of the member's type.
default: value (optional)
default when used as command parameter. If absent, the parameter is mandatory. If present, the value must be null. The parameter is optional, and behavior when it's missing is not specified here. Future extension: if present and non−null, the parameter is optional, and defaults to this value.
features: array of string (optional)
names of features associated with the member, in no particular order. (since 5.0)
2.5
The variant members for a value of the type tag.
case: string
a value of the type tag.
type: string
the name of the object type that provides the variant members when the type tag has value case.
2.5
Additional SchemaInfo members for meta−type 'alternate'.
members: array of SchemaInfoAlternateMember
the alternate type's members, in no particular order. The members' wire encoding is distinct, see docs/devel/qapi−code−gen.txt section Alternate types.
On the wire, this can be any of the members.
2.5
An alternate member.
type: string
the name of the member's type.
2.5
Additional SchemaInfo members for meta−type 'command'.
arg−type: string
the name of the object type that provides the command's parameters.
ret−type: string
the name of the command's result type.
allow−oob: boolean (optional)
whether the command allows out−of−band execution, defaults to false (Since: 2.12)
2.5
Additional SchemaInfo members for meta−type 'event'.
arg−type: string
the name of the object type that provides the event's parameters.
2.5
name: string
the name of the property
type: string
the type of the property. This will typically come in one of four forms:
1. |
A primitive type such as 'u8', 'u16', 'bool', 'str', or 'double'. These types are mapped to the appropriate JSON type. | ||
2. |
A child type in the form 'child<subtype>' where subtype is a qdev device type name. Child properties create the composition tree. | ||
3. |
A link type in the form 'link<subtype>' where subtype is a qdev device type name. Link properties form the device model graph. |
description: string (optional)
if specified, the description of the property.
default−value: value (optional)
the default value, if any (since 5.0)
1.2
This command will list any properties of a object given a path in the object model.
path: string
the path within the object model. See qom−get for a description of this parameter.
a list of ObjectPropertyInfo that describe the properties of the object.
1.2
−> { "execute": "qom−list", "arguments": { "path": "/chardevs" } } <− { "return": [ { "name": "type", "type": "string" }, { "name": "parallel0", "type": "child<chardev−vc>" }, { "name": "serial0", "type": "child<chardev−vc>" }, { "name": "mon0", "type": "child<chardev−stdio>" } ] }
This command will get a property from a object model path and return the value.
path: string
The path within the object model. There are two forms of supported paths−−absolute and partial paths.
Absolute paths are derived from the root object and can follow child<> or link<> properties. Since they can follow link<> properties, they can be arbitrarily long. Absolute paths look like absolute filenames and are prefixed with a leading slash.
Partial paths look like relative filenames. They do not begin with a prefix. The matching rules for partial paths are subtle but designed to make specifying objects easy. At each level of the composition tree, the partial path is matched as an absolute path. The first match is not returned. At least two matches are searched for. A successful result is only returned if only one match is found. If more than one match is found, a flag is return to indicate that the match was ambiguous.
property: string
The property name to read
The property value. The type depends on the property type. child<> and link<> properties are returned as #str pathnames. All integer property types (u8, u16, etc) are returned as #int.
1.2
1. Use absolute path −> { "execute": "qom−get", "arguments": { "path": "/machine/unattached/device[0]", "property": "hotplugged" } } <− { "return": false } 2. Use partial path −> { "execute": "qom−get", "arguments": { "path": "unattached/sysbus", "property": "type" } } <− { "return": "System" }
This command will set a property from a object model path.
path: string
see qom−get for a description of this parameter
property: string
the property name to set
value: value
a value who's type is appropriate for the property type. See qom−get for a description of type mapping.
1.2
−> { "execute": "qom−set", "arguments": { "path": "/machine", "property": "graphics", "value": false } } <− { "return": {} }
This structure describes a search result from qom−list−types
name: string
the type name found in the search
abstract: boolean (optional)
the type is abstract and can't be directly instantiated. Omitted if false. (since 2.10)
parent: string (optional)
Name of parent type, if any (since 2.10)
1.1
This command will return a list of types given search parameters
implements: string (optional)
if specified, only return types that implement this type name
abstract: boolean (optional)
if true, include abstract types in the results
a list of ObjectTypeInfo or an empty list if no results are found
1.1
List properties associated with a QOM object.
typename: string
the type name of an object
objects can create properties at runtime, for example to describe links between different devices and/or objects. These properties are not included in the output of this command.
a list of ObjectPropertyInfo describing object properties
2.12
Properties for can−host−socketcan objects.
if: string
interface name of the host system CAN bus to connect to
canbus: string
object ID of the can−bus object to connect to the host interface
2.12
Properties for colo−compare objects.
primary_in: string
name of the character device backend to use for the primary input (incoming packets are redirected to outdev)
secondary_in: string
name of the character device backend to use for secondary input (incoming packets are only compared to the input on primary_in and then dropped)
outdev: string
name of the character device backend to use for output
iothread: string
name of the iothread to run in
notify_dev: string (optional)
name of the character device backend to be used to communicate with the remote colo−frame (only for Xen COLO)
compare_timeout: int (optional)
the maximum time to hold a packet from primary_in for comparison with an incoming packet on secondary_in in milliseconds (default: 3000)
expired_scan_cycle: int (optional)
the interval at which colo−compare checks whether packets from primary have timed out, in milliseconds (default: 3000)
max_queue_size: int (optional)
the maximum number of packets to keep in the queue for comparing with incoming packets from secondary_in. If the queue is full and additional packets are received, the additional packets are dropped. (default: 1024)
vnet_hdr_support: boolean (optional)
if true, vnet header support is enabled (default: false)
2.8
Properties for cryptodev−backend and cryptodev−backend−builtin objects.
queues: int (optional)
the number of queues for the cryptodev backend. Ignored for cryptodev−backend and must be 1 for cryptodev−backend−builtin. (default: 1)
throttle−bps: int (optional)
limit total bytes per second (Since 8.0)
throttle−ops: int (optional)
limit total operations per second (Since 8.0)
2.8
Properties for cryptodev−vhost−user objects.
chardev: string
the name of a Unix domain socket character device that connects to the vhost−user server
The members of CryptodevBackendProperties
2.12
Properties for dbus−vmstate objects.
addr: string
the name of the DBus bus to connect to
id−list: string (optional)
a comma separated list of DBus IDs of helpers whose data should be included in the VM state on migration
5.0
Indicates where to insert a netfilter relative to a given other filter.
before |
insert before the specified filter |
|||
behind |
insert behind the specified filter |
5.0
Properties for objects of classes derived from netfilter.
netdev: string
id of the network device backend to filter
queue: NetFilterDirection (optional)
indicates which queue(s) to filter (default: all)
status: string (optional)
indicates whether the filter is enabled ("on") or disabled ("off") (default: "on")
position: string (optional)
specifies where the filter should be inserted in the filter list. "head" means the filter is inserted at the head of the filter list, before any existing filters. "tail" means the filter is inserted at the tail of the filter list, behind any existing filters (default). "id=<id>" means the filter is inserted before or behind the filter specified by <id>, depending on the insert property. (default: "tail")
insert: NetfilterInsert (optional)
where to insert the filter relative to the filter given in position. Ignored if position is "head" or "tail". (default: behind)
2.5
Properties for filter−buffer objects.
interval: int
a non−zero interval in microseconds. All packets arriving in the given interval are delayed until the end of the interval.
The members of NetfilterProperties
2.5
Properties for filter−dump objects.
file: string
the filename where the dumped packets should be stored
maxlen: int (optional)
maximum number of bytes in a packet that are stored (default: 65536)
The members of NetfilterProperties
2.5
Properties for filter−mirror objects.
outdev: string
the name of a character device backend to which all incoming packets are mirrored
vnet_hdr_support: boolean (optional)
if true, vnet header support is enabled (default: false)
The members of NetfilterProperties
2.6
Properties for filter−redirector objects.
At least one of indev or outdev must be present. If both are present, they must not refer to the same character device backend.
indev: string (optional)
the name of a character device backend from which packets are received and redirected to the filtered network device
outdev: string (optional)
the name of a character device backend to which all incoming packets are redirected
vnet_hdr_support: boolean (optional)
if true, vnet header support is enabled (default: false)
The members of NetfilterProperties
2.6
Properties for filter−rewriter objects.
vnet_hdr_support: boolean (optional)
if true, vnet header support is enabled (default: false)
The members of NetfilterProperties
2.8
Properties for input−barrier objects.
name: string
the screen name as declared in the screens section of barrier.conf
server: string (optional)
hostname of the Barrier server (default: "localhost")
port: string (optional)
TCP port of the Barrier server (default: "24800")
x−origin: string (optional)
x coordinate of the leftmost pixel on the guest screen (default: "0")
y−origin: string (optional)
y coordinate of the topmost pixel on the guest screen (default: "0")
width: string (optional)
the width of secondary screen in pixels (default: "1920")
height: string (optional)
the height of secondary screen in pixels (default: "1080")
4.2
Properties for input−linux objects.
evdev: string
the path of the host evdev device to use
grab_all: boolean (optional)
if true, grab is toggled for all devices (e.g. both keyboard and mouse) instead of just one device (default: false)
repeat: boolean (optional)
enables auto−repeat events (default: false)
grab−toggle: GrabToggleKeys (optional)
the key or key combination that toggles device grab (default: ctrl−ctrl)
2.6
Common properties for event loops
aio−max−batch: int (optional)
maximum number of requests in a batch for the AIO engine, 0 means that the engine will use its default. (default: 0)
thread−pool−min: int (optional)
minimum number of threads reserved in the thread pool (default:0)
thread−pool−max: int (optional)
maximum number of threads the thread pool can contain (default:64)
7.1
Properties for iothread objects.
poll−max−ns: int (optional)
the maximum number of nanoseconds to busy wait for events. 0 means polling is disabled (default: 32768 on POSIX hosts, 0 otherwise)
poll−grow: int (optional)
the multiplier used to increase the polling time when the algorithm detects it is missing events due to not polling long enough. 0 selects a default behaviour (default: 0)
poll−shrink: int (optional)
the divisor used to decrease the polling time when the algorithm detects it is spending too long polling without encountering events. 0 selects a default behaviour (default: 0)
The members of
EventLoopBaseProperties
The aio−max−batch option is available
since 6.1.
2.0
Properties for the main−loop object.
The members of EventLoopBaseProperties
7.1
Properties for objects of classes derived from memory−backend.
merge: boolean (optional)
if true, mark the memory as mergeable (default depends on the machine type)
dump: boolean (optional)
if true, include the memory in core dumps (default depends on the machine type)
host−nodes: array of int (optional)
the list of NUMA host nodes to bind the memory to
policy: HostMemPolicy (optional)
the NUMA policy (default: 'default')
prealloc: boolean (optional)
if true, preallocate memory (default: false)
prealloc−threads: int (optional)
number of CPU threads to use for prealloc (default: 1)
prealloc−context: string (optional)
thread context to use for creation of preallocation threads (default: none) (since 7.2)
share: boolean (optional)
if false, the memory is private to QEMU; if true, it is shared (default: false)
reserve: boolean (optional)
if true, reserve swap space (or huge pages) if applicable (default: true) (since 6.1)
size: int
size of the memory region in bytes
x−use−canonical−path−for−ramblock−id: boolean (optional)
if true, the canonical path is used for ramblock−id. Disable this for 4.0 machine types or older to allow migration with newer QEMU versions. (default: false generally, but true for machine types <= 4.0)
prealloc=true and reserve=false cannot be set at the same time. With reserve=true, the behavior depends on the operating system: for example, Linux will not reserve swap space for shared file mappings −− "not applicable". In contrast, reserve=false will bail out if it cannot be configured accordingly.
2.1
Properties for memory−backend−file objects.
align: int (optional)
the base address alignment when QEMU mmap(2)s mem−path. Some backend stores specified by mem−path require an alignment different than the default one used by QEMU, e.g. the device DAX /dev/dax0.0 requires 2M alignment rather than 4K. In such cases, users can specify the required alignment via this option. 0 selects a default alignment (currently the page size). (default: 0)
offset: int (optional)
the offset into the target file that the region starts at. You can use this option to back multiple regions with a single file. Must be a multiple of the page size. (default: 0) (since 8.1)
discard−data: boolean (optional)
if true, the file contents can be destroyed when QEMU exits, to avoid unnecessarily flushing data to the backing file. Note that discard−data is only an optimization, and QEMU might not discard file contents if it aborts unexpectedly or is terminated using SIGKILL. (default: false)
mem−path: string
the path to either a shared memory or huge page filesystem mount
pmem: boolean (optional) (If: CONFIG_LIBPMEM)
specifies whether the backing file specified by mem−path is in host persistent memory that can be accessed using the SNIA NVM programming model (e.g. Intel NVDIMM).
readonly: boolean (optional)
if true, the backing file is opened read−only; if false, it is opened read−write. (default: false)
The members of MemoryBackendProperties
2.1
Properties for memory−backend−memfd objects.
The share boolean option is true by default with memfd.
hugetlb: boolean (optional)
if true, the file to be created resides in the hugetlbfs filesystem (default: false)
hugetlbsize: int (optional)
the hugetlb page size on systems that support multiple hugetlb page sizes (it must be a power of 2 value supported by the system). 0 selects a default page size. This option is ignored if hugetlb is false. (default: 0)
seal: boolean (optional)
if true, create a sealed−file, which will block further resizing of the memory (default: true)
The members of MemoryBackendProperties
2.12
Properties for memory−backend−epc objects.
The share boolean option is true by default with epc
The merge boolean option is false by default with epc
The dump boolean option is false by default with epc
The members of MemoryBackendProperties
6.2
Properties for pr−manager−helper objects.
path: string
the path to a Unix domain socket for connecting to the external helper
2.11
Properties for qtest objects.
chardev: string
the chardev to be used to receive qtest commands on.
log: string (optional)
the path to a log file
6.0
Properties for x−remote−object objects.
fd: string
file descriptor name previously passed via 'getfd' command
devid: string
the id of the device to be associated with the file descriptor
6.0
Properties for x−vfio−user−server objects.
socket: SocketAddress
socket to be used by the libvfio−user library
device: string
the ID of the device to be emulated at the server
7.1
Properties for objects of classes derived from rng.
opened: boolean (optional)
if true, the device is opened immediately when applying this option and will probably fail when processing the next option. Don't use; only provided for compatibility. (default: false)
deprecated
Member opened is deprecated. Setting true doesn't make sense, and false is already the default.
1.3
Properties for rng−egd objects.
chardev: string
the name of a character device backend that provides the connection to the RNG daemon
The members of RngProperties
1.3
Properties for rng−random objects.
filename: string (optional)
the filename of the device on the host to obtain entropy from (default: "/dev/urandom")
The members of RngProperties
1.3
Properties for sev−guest objects.
sev−device: string (optional)
SEV device to use (default: "/dev/sev")
dh−cert−file: string (optional)
guest owners DH certificate (encoded with base64)
session−file: string (optional)
guest owners session parameters (encoded with base64)
policy: int (optional)
SEV policy value (default: 0x1)
handle: int (optional)
SEV firmware handle (default: 0)
cbitpos: int (optional)
C−bit location in page table entry (default: 0)
reduced−phys−bits: int
number of bits in physical addresses that become unavailable when SEV is enabled
kernel−hashes: boolean (optional)
if true, add hashes of kernel/initrd/cmdline to a designated guest firmware page for measured boot with −kernel (default: false) (since 6.2)
2.12
Properties for thread context objects.
cpu−affinity: array of int (optional)
the list of host CPU numbers used as CPU affinity for all threads created in the thread context (default: QEMU main thread CPU affinity)
node−affinity: array of int (optional)
the list of host node numbers that will be resolved to a list of host CPU numbers used as CPU affinity. This is a shortcut for specifying the list of host CPU numbers belonging to the host nodes manually by setting cpu−affinity. (default: QEMU main thread affinity)
7.2
authz−list
Not documented
authz−listfile
Not documented
authz−pam
Not documented
authz−simple
Not documented
can−bus
Not documented
can−host−socketcan (If: CONFIG_LINUX)
Not documented
colo−compare
Not documented
cryptodev−backend
Not documented
cryptodev−backend−builtin
Not documented
cryptodev−backend−lkcf
Not documented
cryptodev−vhost−user (If: CONFIG_VHOST_CRYPTO)
Not documented
dbus−vmstate
Not documented
filter−buffer
Not documented
filter−dump
Not documented
filter−mirror
Not documented
filter−redirector
Not documented
filter−replay
Not documented
filter−rewriter
Not documented
input−barrier
Not documented
input−linux (If: CONFIG_LINUX)
Not documented
iothread
Not documented
main−loop
Not documented
memory−backend−epc (If: CONFIG_LINUX)
Not documented
memory−backend−file
Not documented
memory−backend−memfd (If: CONFIG_LINUX)
Not documented
memory−backend−ram
Not documented
pef−guest
Not documented
pr−manager−helper (If: CONFIG_LINUX)
Not documented
qtest |
Not documented |
rng−builtin
Not documented
rng−egd
Not documented
rng−random (If: CONFIG_POSIX)
Not documented
secret |
Not documented |
secret_keyring (If: CONFIG_SECRET_KEYRING)
Not documented
sev−guest
Not documented
thread−context
Not documented
s390−pv−guest
Not documented
throttle−group
Not documented
tls−creds−anon
Not documented
tls−creds−psk
Not documented
tls−creds−x509
Not documented
tls−cipher−suites
Not documented
x−remote−object
Not documented
x−vfio−user−server
Not documented
unstable
Member x−remote−object is experimental.
6.0
Describes the options of a user creatable QOM object.
qom−type: ObjectType
the class name for the object to be created
id: string
the name of the new object
The members of
AuthZListProperties when qom−type is
"authz−list"
The members of AuthZListFileProperties when qom−type
is
"authz−listfile"
The members of AuthZPAMProperties when qom−type is
"authz−pam"
The members of AuthZSimpleProperties when qom−type is
"authz−simple"
The members of CanHostSocketcanProperties when
qom−type is
"can−host−socketcan" (If:
CONFIG_LINUX)
The members of ColoCompareProperties when qom−type is
"colo−compare"
The members of CryptodevBackendProperties when
qom−type is
"cryptodev−backend"
The members of CryptodevBackendProperties when
qom−type is
"cryptodev−backend−builtin"
The members of CryptodevBackendProperties when
qom−type is
"cryptodev−backend−lkcf"
The members of CryptodevVhostUserProperties when
qom−type is
"cryptodev−vhost−user" (If:
CONFIG_VHOST_CRYPTO)
The members of DBusVMStateProperties when qom−type is
"dbus−vmstate"
The members of FilterBufferProperties when qom−type is
"filter−buffer"
The members of FilterDumpProperties when qom−type is
"filter−dump"
The members of FilterMirrorProperties when qom−type is
"filter−mirror"
The members of FilterRedirectorProperties when
qom−type is
"filter−redirector"
The members of NetfilterProperties when qom−type is
"filter−replay"
The members of FilterRewriterProperties when qom−type
is
"filter−rewriter"
The members of InputBarrierProperties when qom−type is
"input−barrier"
The members of InputLinuxProperties when
qom−type is
"input−linux" (If:
CONFIG_LINUX)
The members of IothreadProperties when qom−type is
"iothread"
The members of MainLoopProperties when qom−type is
"main−loop"
The members of MemoryBackendEpcProperties when
qom−type is
"memory−backend−epc" (If:
CONFIG_LINUX)
The members of MemoryBackendFileProperties when
qom−type is
"memory−backend−file"
The members of MemoryBackendMemfdProperties when
qom−type is
"memory−backend−memfd" (If:
CONFIG_LINUX)
The members of MemoryBackendProperties when qom−type
is
"memory−backend−ram"
The members of PrManagerHelperProperties when
qom−type is
"pr−manager−helper" (If:
CONFIG_LINUX)
The members of QtestProperties when qom−type is
"qtest"
The members of RngProperties when qom−type is
"rng−builtin"
The members of RngEgdProperties when qom−type is
"rng−egd"
The members of RngRandomProperties when
qom−type is "rng−random"
(If:
CONFIG_POSIX)
The members of SecretProperties when qom−type is
"secret"
The members of SecretKeyringProperties when
qom−type is
"secret_keyring" (If:
CONFIG_SECRET_KEYRING)
The members of SevGuestProperties when qom−type is
"sev−guest"
The members of ThreadContextProperties when qom−type
is
"thread−context"
The members of ThrottleGroupProperties when qom−type
is
"throttle−group"
The members of TlsCredsAnonProperties when qom−type is
"tls−creds−anon"
The members of TlsCredsPskProperties when qom−type is
"tls−creds−psk"
The members of TlsCredsX509Properties when qom−type is
"tls−creds−x509"
The members of TlsCredsProperties when qom−type is
"tls−cipher−suites"
The members of RemoteObjectProperties when qom−type is
"x−remote−object"
The members of VfioUserServerProperties when qom−type
is
"x−vfio−user−server"
6.0
Create a QOM object.
The members of ObjectOptions
Nothing on success Error if qom−type is not a valid class name
2.0
−> { "execute": "object−add", "arguments": { "qom−type": "rng−random", "id": "rng1", "filename": "/dev/hwrng" } } <− { "return": {} }
Remove a QOM object.
id: string
the name of the QOM object to remove
Nothing on success Error if id is not a valid id for a QOM object
2.0
−> { "execute": "object−del", "arguments": { "id": "rng1" } } <− { "return": {} }
List properties associated with a device.
typename: string
the type name of a device
a list of ObjectPropertyInfo describing a devices properties
objects can create properties at runtime, for example to describe links between different devices and/or objects. These properties are not included in the output of this command.
1.2
Add a device.
driver: string
the name of the new device's driver
bus: string (optional)
the device's parent bus (device tree path)
id: string (optional)
the device's ID, must be unique
json−cli
If present, the "−device" command line option supports JSON syntax with a structure identical to the arguments of this command.
json−cli−hotplug
If present, the "−device" command line option supports JSON syntax without the reference counting leak that broke hot−unplug
1. |
Additional arguments depend on the type. | ||
2. |
For detailed information about this command, please refer to the 'docs/qdev−device−use.txt' file. | ||
3. |
It's possible to list device properties by running QEMU with the "−device DEVICE,help" command−line argument, where DEVICE is the device's name |
−> { "execute": "device_add", "arguments": { "driver": "e1000", "id": "net1", "bus": "pci.0", "mac": "52:54:00:12:34:56" } } <− { "return": {} }
0.13
Remove a device from a guest
id: string
the device's ID or QOM path
Nothing on success If id is not a valid device, DeviceNotFound
When this command completes, the device may not be removed from the guest. Hot removal is an operation that requires guest cooperation. This command merely requests that the guest begin the hot removal process. Completion of the device removal process is signaled with a DEVICE_DELETED event. Guest reset will automatically complete removal for all devices. If a guest−side error in the hot removal process is detected, the device will not be removed and a DEVICE_UNPLUG_GUEST_ERROR event is sent. Some errors cannot be detected.
0.14
−> { "execute": "device_del", "arguments": { "id": "net1" } } <− { "return": {} } −> { "execute": "device_del", "arguments": { "id": "/machine/peripheral−anon/device[0]" } } <− { "return": {} }
Emitted whenever the device removal completion is acknowledged by the guest. At this point, it's safe to reuse the specified device ID. Device removal can be initiated by the guest or by HMP/QMP commands.
device: string (optional)
the device's ID if it has one
path: string
the device's QOM path
1.5
<− { "event": "DEVICE_DELETED", "data": { "device": "virtio−net−pci−0", "path": "/machine/peripheral/virtio−net−pci−0" }, "timestamp": { "seconds": 1265044230, "microseconds": 450486 } }
Emitted when a device hot unplug fails due to a guest reported error.
device: string (optional)
the device's ID if it has one
path: string
the device's QOM path
6.2
<− { "event": "DEVICE_UNPLUG_GUEST_ERROR", "data": { "device": "core1", "path": "/machine/peripheral/core1" }, "timestamp": { "seconds": 1615570772, "microseconds": 202844 } }
The comprehensive enumeration of QEMU system emulation ("softmmu") targets. Run "./configure −−help" in the project root directory, and look for the *−softmmu targets near the "−−target−list" option. The individual target constants are not documented here, for the time being.
rx |
since 5.0 |
|||
avr |
since 5.1 |
aarch64
Not documented
alpha |
Not documented |
|||
arm |
Not documented |
|||
cris |
Not documented |
|||
hppa |
Not documented |
|||
i386 |
Not documented |
loongarch64
Not documented
m68k |
Not documented |
microblaze
Not documented
microblazeel
Not documented
mips |
Not documented |
|||
mips64 |
Not documented |
mips64el
Not documented
mipsel |
Not documented |
|||
nios2 |
Not documented |
|||
or1k |
Not documented |
|||
ppc |
Not documented |
|||
ppc64 |
Not documented |
riscv32
Not documented
riscv64
Not documented
s390x |
Not documented |
|||
sh4 |
Not documented |
|||
sh4eb |
Not documented |
|||
sparc |
Not documented |
sparc64
Not documented
tricore
Not documented
x86_64 |
Not documented |
|||
xtensa |
Not documented |
xtensaeb
Not documented
The resulting QMP strings can be appended to the "qemu−system−" prefix to produce the corresponding QEMU executable name. This is true even for "qemu−system−x86_64".
3.0
An enumeration of cpu states that can be assumed by a virtual S390 CPU
uninitialized
Not documented
stopped
Not documented
check−stop
Not documented
operating
Not documented
load |
Not documented |
2.12
Additional information about a virtual S390 CPU
cpu−state: CpuS390State
the virtual CPU's state
2.12
Information about a virtual CPU
cpu−index: int
index of the virtual CPU
qom−path: string
path to the CPU object in the QOM tree
thread−id: int
ID of the underlying host thread
props: CpuInstanceProperties (optional)
properties describing to which node/socket/core/thread virtual CPU belongs to, provided if supported by board
target: SysEmuTarget
the QEMU system emulation target, which determines which additional fields will be listed (since 3.0)
The members of CpuInfoS390 when target is "s390x"
2.12
Returns information about all virtual CPUs.
list of CpuInfoFast
2.12
−> { "execute": "query−cpus−fast" } <− { "return": [ { "thread−id": 25627, "props": { "core−id": 0, "thread−id": 0, "socket−id": 0 }, "qom−path": "/machine/unattached/device[0]", "target":"x86_64", "cpu−index": 0 }, { "thread−id": 25628, "props": { "core−id": 0, "thread−id": 0, "socket−id": 1 }, "qom−path": "/machine/unattached/device[2]", "target":"x86_64", "cpu−index": 1 } ] }
Information describing a machine.
name: string
the name of the machine
alias: string (optional)
an alias for the machine name
is−default: boolean (optional)
whether the machine is default
cpu−max: int
maximum number of CPUs supported by the machine type (since 1.5)
hotpluggable−cpus: boolean
cpu hotplug via −device is supported (since 2.7)
numa−mem−supported: boolean
true if '−numa node,mem' option is supported by the machine type and false otherwise (since 4.1)
deprecated: boolean
if true, the machine type is deprecated and may be removed in future versions of QEMU according to the QEMU deprecation policy (since 4.1)
default−cpu−type: string (optional)
default CPU model typename if none is requested via the −cpu argument. (since 4.2)
default−ram−id: string (optional)
the default ID of initial RAM memory backend (since 5.2)
acpi: boolean
machine type supports ACPI (since 8.0)
1.2
Return a list of supported machines
a list of MachineInfo
1.2
Information describing the running machine parameters.
wakeup−suspend−support: boolean
true if the machine supports wake up from suspend
4.0
Return information on the current virtual machine.
CurrentMachineParams
4.0
Information describing the QEMU target.
arch: SysEmuTarget
the target architecture
1.2
Return information about the target for this QEMU
TargetInfo
1.2
Guest UUID information (Universally Unique Identifier).
UUID: string
the UUID of the guest
0.14
If no UUID was specified for the guest, a null UUID is returned.
Query the guest UUID information.
The UuidInfo for the guest
0.14
−> { "execute": "query−uuid" } <− { "return": { "UUID": "550e8400−e29b−41d4−a716−446655440000" } }
GUID information.
guid: string
the globally unique identifier
2.9
Show Virtual Machine Generation ID
2.9
Performs a hard reset of a guest.
0.14
−> { "execute": "system_reset" } <− { "return": {} }
Requests that a guest perform a powerdown operation.
0.14
A guest may or may not respond to this command. This command returning does not indicate that a guest has accepted the request or that it has shut down. Many guests will respond to this command by prompting the user in some way.
−> { "execute": "system_powerdown" } <− { "return": {} }
Wake up guest from suspend. If the guest has wake−up from suspend support enabled (wakeup−suspend−support flag from query−current−machine), wake−up guest from suspend if the guest is in SUSPENDED state. Return an error otherwise.
1.1
nothing.
prior to 4.0, this command does nothing in case the guest isn't suspended.
−> { "execute": "system_wakeup" } <− { "return": {} }
Policy for handling lost ticks in timer devices. Ticks end up getting lost when, for example, the guest is paused.
discard
throw away the missed ticks and continue with future injection normally. The guest OS will see the timer jump ahead by a potentially quite significant amount all at once, as if the intervening chunk of time had simply not existed; needless to say, such a sudden jump can easily confuse a guest OS which is not specifically prepared to deal with it. Assuming the guest OS can deal correctly with the time jump, the time in the guest and in the host should now match.
delay |
continue to deliver ticks at the normal rate. The guest OS will not notice anything is amiss, as from its point of view time will have continued to flow normally. The time in the guest should now be behind the time in the host by exactly the amount of time during which ticks have been missed. | ||
slew |
deliver ticks at a higher rate to catch up with the missed ticks. The guest OS will not notice anything is amiss, as from its point of view time will have continued to flow normally. Once the timer has managed to catch up with all the missing ticks, the time in the guest and in the host should match. |
2.0
Injects a Non−Maskable Interrupt into the default CPU (x86/s390) or all CPUs (ppc64). The command fails when the guest doesn't support injecting.
If successful, nothing
0.14
prior to 2.1, this command was only supported for x86 and s390 VMs
−> { "execute": "inject−nmi" } <− { "return": {} }
Information about support for KVM acceleration
enabled: boolean
true if KVM acceleration is active
present: boolean
true if KVM acceleration is built into this executable
0.14
Returns information about KVM acceleration
KvmInfo
0.14
−> { "execute": "query−kvm" } <− { "return": { "enabled": true, "present": true } }
node |
NUMA nodes configuration |
|||
dist |
NUMA distance configuration (since 2.10) |
|||
cpu |
property based CPU(s) to node mapping (Since: 2.10) |
hmat−lb
memory latency and bandwidth information (Since: 5.0)
hmat−cache
memory side cache information (Since: 5.0)
2.1
A discriminated record of NUMA options. (for OptsVisitor)
type: NumaOptionsType
Not documented
The members of
NumaNodeOptions when type is "node"
The members of NumaDistOptions when type is "dist"
The members of NumaCpuOptions when type is "cpu"
The members of NumaHmatLBOptions when type is
"hmat−lb"
The members of NumaHmatCacheOptions when type is
"hmat−cache"
2.1
Create a guest NUMA node. (for OptsVisitor)
nodeid: int (optional)
NUMA node ID (increase by 1 from 0 if omitted)
cpus: array of int (optional)
VCPUs belonging to this node (assign VCPUS round−robin if omitted)
mem: int (optional)
memory size of this node; mutually exclusive with memdev. Equally divide total memory among nodes if both mem and memdev are omitted.
memdev: string (optional)
memory backend object. If specified for one node, it must be specified for all nodes.
initiator: int (optional)
defined in ACPI 6.3 Chapter 5.2.27.3 Table 5−145, points to the nodeid which has the memory controller responsible for this NUMA node. This field provides additional information as to the initiator node that is closest (as in directly attached) to this node, and therefore has the best performance (since 5.0)
2.1
Set the distance between 2 NUMA nodes.
src: int
source NUMA node.
dst: int
destination NUMA node.
val: int
NUMA distance from source node to destination node. When a node is unreachable from another node, set the distance between them to 255.
2.10
Create a CXL Fixed Memory Window
size: int
Size of the Fixed Memory Window in bytes. Must be a multiple of 256MiB.
interleave−granularity: int (optional)
Number of contiguous bytes for which accesses will go to a given interleave target. Accepted values [256, 512, 1k, 2k, 4k, 8k, 16k]
targets: array of string
Target root bridge IDs from −device ...,id=<ID> for each root bridge.
7.1
List of CXL Fixed Memory Windows.
cxl−fmw: array of CXLFixedMemoryWindowOptions
List of CXLFixedMemoryWindowOptions
7.1
A X86 32−bit register
EAX |
Not documented |
|||
EBX |
Not documented |
|||
ECX |
Not documented |
|||
EDX |
Not documented |
|||
ESP |
Not documented |
|||
EBP |
Not documented |
|||
ESI |
Not documented |
|||
EDI |
Not documented |
1.5
Information about a X86 CPU feature word
cpuid−input−eax: int
Input EAX value for CPUID instruction for that feature word
cpuid−input−ecx: int (optional)
Input ECX value for CPUID instruction for that feature word
cpuid−register: X86CPURegister32
Output register containing the feature bits
features: int
value of output register, containing the feature bits
1.5
Not used by QMP; hack to let us use X86CPUFeatureWordInfoList internally
unused: array of X86CPUFeatureWordInfo
Not documented
2.5
Option "−numa cpu" overrides default cpu to node mapping. It accepts the same set of cpu properties as returned by query−hotpluggable−cpus[].props, where node−id could be used to override default node mapping.
The members of CpuInstanceProperties
2.10
The memory hierarchy in the System Locality Latency and Bandwidth Information Structure of HMAT (Heterogeneous Memory Attribute Table)
For more information about HmatLBMemoryHierarchy, see chapter 5.2.27.4: Table 5−146: Field "Flags" of ACPI 6.3 spec.
memory |
the structure represents the memory performance |
first−level
first level of memory side cache
second−level
second level of memory side cache
third−level
third level of memory side cache
5.0
Data type in the System Locality Latency and Bandwidth Information Structure of HMAT (Heterogeneous Memory Attribute Table)
For more information about HmatLBDataType, see chapter 5.2.27.4: Table 5−146: Field "Data Type" of ACPI 6.3 spec.
access−latency
access latency (nanoseconds)
read−latency
read latency (nanoseconds)
write−latency
write latency (nanoseconds)
access−bandwidth
access bandwidth (Bytes per second)
read−bandwidth
read bandwidth (Bytes per second)
write−bandwidth
write bandwidth (Bytes per second)
5.0
Set the system locality latency and bandwidth information between Initiator and Target proximity Domains.
For more information about NumaHmatLBOptions, see chapter 5.2.27.4: Table 5−146 of ACPI 6.3 spec.
initiator: int
the Initiator Proximity Domain.
target: int
the Target Proximity Domain.
hierarchy: HmatLBMemoryHierarchy
the Memory Hierarchy. Indicates the performance of memory or side cache.
data−type: HmatLBDataType
presents the type of data, access/read/write latency or hit latency.
latency: int (optional)
the value of latency from initiator to target proximity domain, the latency unit is "ns(nanosecond)".
bandwidth: int (optional)
the value of bandwidth between initiator and target proximity domain, the bandwidth unit is "Bytes per second".
5.0
Cache associativity in the Memory Side Cache Information Structure of HMAT
For more information of HmatCacheAssociativity, see chapter 5.2.27.5: Table 5−147 of ACPI 6.3 spec.
none |
None (no memory side cache in this proximity domain, or cache associativity unknown) | ||
direct |
Direct Mapped |
complex
Complex Cache Indexing (implementation specific)
5.0
Cache write policy in the Memory Side Cache Information Structure of HMAT
For more information of HmatCacheWritePolicy, see chapter 5.2.27.5: Table 5−147: Field "Cache Attributes" of ACPI 6.3 spec.
none |
None (no memory side cache in this proximity domain, or cache write policy unknown) |
write−back
Write Back (WB)
write−through
Write Through (WT)
5.0
Set the memory side cache information for a given memory domain.
For more information of NumaHmatCacheOptions, see chapter 5.2.27.5: Table 5−147: Field "Cache Attributes" of ACPI 6.3 spec.
node−id: int
the memory proximity domain to which the memory belongs.
size: int
the size of memory side cache in bytes.
level: int
the cache level described in this structure.
associativity: HmatCacheAssociativity
the cache associativity, none/direct−mapped/complex(complex cache indexing).
policy: HmatCacheWritePolicy
the write policy, none/write−back/write−through.
line: int
the cache Line size in bytes.
5.0
Save a portion of guest memory to a file.
val: int
the virtual address of the guest to start from
size: int
the size of memory region to save
filename: string
the file to save the memory to as binary data
cpu−index: int (optional)
the index of the virtual CPU to use for translating the virtual address (defaults to CPU 0)
Nothing on success
0.14
Errors were not reliably returned until 1.1
−> { "execute": "memsave", "arguments": { "val": 10, "size": 100, "filename": "/tmp/virtual−mem−dump" } } <− { "return": {} }
Save a portion of guest physical memory to a file.
val: int
the physical address of the guest to start from
size: int
the size of memory region to save
filename: string
the file to save the memory to as binary data
Nothing on success
0.14
Errors were not reliably returned until 1.1
−> { "execute": "pmemsave", "arguments": { "val": 10, "size": 100, "filename": "/tmp/physical−mem−dump" } } <− { "return": {} }
Information about memory backend
id: string (optional)
backend's ID if backend has 'id' property (since 2.9)
size: int
memory backend size
merge: boolean
whether memory merge support is enabled
dump: boolean
whether memory backend's memory is included in a core dump
prealloc: boolean
whether memory was preallocated
share: boolean
whether memory is private to QEMU or shared (since 6.1)
reserve: boolean (optional)
whether swap space (or huge pages) was reserved if applicable. This corresponds to the user configuration and not the actual behavior implemented in the OS to perform the reservation. For example, Linux will never reserve swap space for shared file mappings. (since 6.1)
host−nodes: array of int
host nodes for its memory policy
policy: HostMemPolicy
memory policy of memory backend
2.1
Returns information for all memory backends.
a list of Memdev.
2.1
−> { "execute": "query−memdev" } <− { "return": [ { "id": "mem1", "size": 536870912, "merge": false, "dump": true, "prealloc": false, "share": false, "host−nodes": [0, 1], "policy": "bind" }, { "size": 536870912, "merge": false, "dump": true, "prealloc": true, "share": false, "host−nodes": [2, 3], "policy": "preferred" } ] }
List of properties to be used for hotplugging a CPU instance, it should be passed by management with device_add command when a CPU is being hotplugged.
node−id: int (optional)
NUMA node ID the CPU belongs to
socket−id: int (optional)
socket number within node/board the CPU belongs to
die−id: int (optional)
die number within socket the CPU belongs to (since 4.1)
cluster−id: int (optional)
cluster number within die the CPU belongs to (since 7.1)
core−id: int (optional)
core number within cluster the CPU belongs to
thread−id: int (optional)
thread number within core the CPU belongs to
currently there are 6 properties that could be present but management should be prepared to pass through other properties with device_add command to allow for future interface extension. This also requires the filed names to be kept in sync with the properties passed to −device/device_add.
2.7
type: string
CPU object type for usage with device_add command
props: CpuInstanceProperties
list of properties to be used for hotplugging CPU
vcpus−count: int
number of logical VCPU threads HotpluggableCPU provides
qom−path: string (optional)
link to existing CPU object if CPU is present or omitted if CPU is not present.
2.7
a list of HotpluggableCPU objects.
2.7
For pseries machine type started with −smp 2,cores=2,maxcpus=4 −cpu POWER8: −> { "execute": "query−hotpluggable−cpus" } <− {"return": [ { "props": { "core−id": 8 }, "type": "POWER8−spapr−cpu−core", "vcpus−count": 1 }, { "props": { "core−id": 0 }, "type": "POWER8−spapr−cpu−core", "vcpus−count": 1, "qom−path": "/machine/unattached/device[0]"} ]}' For pc machine type started with −smp 1,maxcpus=2: −> { "execute": "query−hotpluggable−cpus" } <− {"return": [ { "type": "qemu64−x86_64−cpu", "vcpus−count": 1, "props": {"core−id": 0, "socket−id": 1, "thread−id": 0} }, { "qom−path": "/machine/unattached/device[0]", "type": "qemu64−x86_64−cpu", "vcpus−count": 1, "props": {"core−id": 0, "socket−id": 0, "thread−id": 0} } ]} For s390x−virtio−ccw machine type started with −smp 1,maxcpus=2 −cpu qemu (Since: 2.11): −> { "execute": "query−hotpluggable−cpus" } <− {"return": [ { "type": "qemu−s390x−cpu", "vcpus−count": 1, "props": { "core−id": 1 } }, { "qom−path": "/machine/unattached/device[0]", "type": "qemu−s390x−cpu", "vcpus−count": 1, "props": { "core−id": 0 } } ]}
Runtime equivalent of '−numa' CLI option, available at preconfigure stage to configure numa mapping before initializing machine.
The members of NumaOptions
3.0
Request the balloon driver to change its balloon size.
value: int
the target logical size of the VM in bytes. We can deduce the size of the balloon using this formula:
logical_vm_size = vm_ram_size − balloon_size
From it we have: balloon_size = vm_ram_size − value
• |
Nothing on success | ||
• |
If the balloon driver is enabled but not functional because the KVM kernel module cannot support it, KVMMissingCap | ||
• |
If no balloon device is present, DeviceNotActive |
This command just issues a request to the guest. When it returns, the balloon size may not have changed. A guest can change the balloon size independent of this command.
0.14
−> { "execute": "balloon", "arguments": { "value": 536870912 } } <− { "return": {} } With a 2.5GiB guest this command inflated the ballon to 3GiB.
Information about the guest balloon device.
actual: int
the logical size of the VM in bytes Formula used: logical_vm_size = vm_ram_size − balloon_size
0.14
Return information about the balloon device.
• |
BalloonInfo on success | ||
• |
If the balloon driver is enabled but not functional because the KVM kernel module cannot support it, KVMMissingCap | ||
• |
If no balloon device is present, DeviceNotActive |
0.14
−> { "execute": "query−balloon" } <− { "return": { "actual": 1073741824 } }
Emitted when the guest changes the actual BALLOON level. This value is equivalent to the actual field return by the 'query−balloon' command
actual: int
the logical size of the VM in bytes Formula used: logical_vm_size = vm_ram_size − balloon_size
this event is rate−limited.
1.2
<− { "event": "BALLOON_CHANGE", "data": { "actual": 944766976 }, "timestamp": { "seconds": 1267020223, "microseconds": 435656 } }
Actual memory information in bytes.
base−memory: int
size of "base" memory specified with command line option −m.
plugged−memory: int (optional)
size of memory that can be hot−unplugged. This field is omitted if target doesn't support memory hotplug (i.e. CONFIG_MEM_DEVICE not defined at build time).
2.11
Return the amount of initially allocated and present hotpluggable (if enabled) memory in bytes.
−> { "execute": "query−memory−size−summary" } <− { "return": { "base−memory": 4294967296, "plugged−memory": 0 } }
2.11
PCDIMMDevice state information
id: string (optional)
device's ID
addr: int
physical address, where device is mapped
size: int
size of memory that the device provides
slot: int
slot number at which device is plugged in
node: int
NUMA node number where device is plugged in
memdev: string
memory backend linked with device
hotplugged: boolean
true if device was hotplugged
hotpluggable: boolean
true if device if could be added/removed while machine is running
2.1
VirtioPMEM state information
id: string (optional)
device's ID
memaddr: int
physical address in memory, where device is mapped
size: int
size of memory that the device provides
memdev: string
memory backend linked with device
4.1
VirtioMEMDevice state information
id: string (optional)
device's ID
memaddr: int
physical address in memory, where device is mapped
requested−size: int
the user requested size of the device
size: int
the (current) size of memory that the device provides
max−size: int
the maximum size of memory that the device can provide
block−size: int
the block size of memory that the device provides
node: int
NUMA node number where device is assigned to
memdev: string
memory backend linked with the region
5.1
Sgx EPC state information
id: string (optional)
device's ID
memaddr: int
physical address in memory, where device is mapped
size: int
size of memory that the device provides
memdev: string
memory backend linked with device
node: int
the numa node (Since: 7.0)
6.2
nvdimm |
since 2.12 |
virtio−pmem
since 4.1
virtio−mem
since 5.1
sgx−epc
since 6.2.
dimm |
Not documented |
2.1
data: PCDIMMDeviceInfo
Not documented
2.1
data: VirtioPMEMDeviceInfo
Not documented
2.1
data: VirtioMEMDeviceInfo
Not documented
2.1
data: SgxEPCDeviceInfo
Not documented
6.2
Union containing information about a memory device
type: MemoryDeviceInfoKind
Not documented
The members of
PCDIMMDeviceInfoWrapper when type is "dimm"
The members of PCDIMMDeviceInfoWrapper when type is
"nvdimm"
The members of VirtioPMEMDeviceInfoWrapper when type is
"virtio−pmem"
The members of VirtioMEMDeviceInfoWrapper when type is
"virtio−mem"
The members of SgxEPCDeviceInfoWrapper when type is
"sgx−epc"
2.1
Sgx EPC cmdline information
memdev: string
memory backend linked with device
node: int
the numa node (Since: 7.0)
6.2
SGX properties of machine types.
sgx−epc: array of SgxEPC
list of ids of memory−backend−epc objects.
6.2
Lists available memory devices and their state
2.1
−> { "execute": "query−memory−devices" } <− { "return": [ { "data": { "addr": 5368709120, "hotpluggable": true, "hotplugged": true, "id": "d1", "memdev": "/objects/memX", "node": 0, "size": 1073741824, "slot": 0}, "type": "dimm" } ] }
Emitted when the size of a memory device changes. Only emitted for memory devices that can actually change the size (e.g., virtio−mem due to guest action).
id: string (optional)
device's ID
size: int
the new size of memory that the device provides
qom−path: string
path to the device object in the QOM tree (since 6.2)
this event is rate−limited.
5.1
<− { "event": "MEMORY_DEVICE_SIZE_CHANGE", "data": { "id": "vm0", "size": 1073741824, "qom−path": "/machine/unattached/device[2]" }, "timestamp": { "seconds": 1588168529, "microseconds": 201316 } }
Emitted when memory hot unplug error occurs.
device: string
device name
msg: string
Informative message
deprecated
This event is deprecated. Use DEVICE_UNPLUG_GUEST_ERROR instead.
2.4
<− { "event": "MEM_UNPLUG_ERROR", "data": { "device": "dimm1", "msg": "acpi: device unplug for unsupported device" }, "timestamp": { "seconds": 1265044230, "microseconds": 450486 } }
Schema for virtual machine boot configuration.
order: string (optional)
Boot order (a=floppy, c=hard disk, d=CD−ROM, n=network)
once: string (optional)
Boot order to apply on first boot
menu: boolean (optional)
Whether to show a boot menu
splash: string (optional)
The name of the file to be passed to the firmware as logo picture, if menu is true.
splash−time: int (optional)
How long to show the logo picture, in milliseconds
reboot−timeout: int (optional)
Timeout before guest reboots after boot fails
strict: boolean (optional)
Whether to attempt booting from devices not included in the boot order
7.1
Schema for CPU topology configuration. A missing value lets QEMU figure out a suitable value based on the ones that are provided.
cpus: int (optional)
number of virtual CPUs in the virtual machine
sockets: int (optional)
number of sockets in the CPU topology
dies: int (optional)
number of dies per socket in the CPU topology
clusters: int (optional)
number of clusters per die in the CPU topology (since 7.0)
cores: int (optional)
number of cores per cluster in the CPU topology
threads: int (optional)
number of threads per core in the CPU topology
maxcpus: int (optional)
maximum number of hotpluggable virtual CPUs in the virtual machine
6.1
Query interrupt statistics
unstable
This command is meant for debugging.
interrupt statistics
6.2
Query TCG compiler statistics
unstable
This command is meant for debugging.
TCG compiler statistics
6.2
CONFIG_TCG
Query NUMA topology information
unstable
This command is meant for debugging.
topology information
6.2
Query TCG opcode counters
unstable
This command is meant for debugging.
TCG opcode counters
6.2
CONFIG_TCG
Query system ramblock information
unstable
This command is meant for debugging.
system ramblock information
6.2
Query RDMA state
unstable
This command is meant for debugging.
RDMA state
6.2
Query information on the registered ROMS
unstable
This command is meant for debugging.
registered ROMs
6.2
Query information on the USB devices
unstable
This command is meant for debugging.
USB device information
6.2
32 |
SMBIOS version 2.1 (32−bit) Entry Point |
|||
64 |
SMBIOS version 3.0 (64−bit) Entry Point |
7.0
Schema for memory size configuration.
size: int (optional)
memory size in bytes
max−size: int (optional)
maximum hotpluggable memory size in bytes
slots: int (optional)
number of available memory slots for hotplug
7.1
Save the FDT in dtb format.
filename: string
name of the dtb file to be created
7.2
−> { "execute": "dumpdtb" } "arguments": { "filename": "fdt.dtb" } } <− { "return": {} }
CONFIG_FDT
Virtual CPU model.
A CPU model consists of the name of a CPU definition, to which delta changes are applied (e.g. features added/removed). Most magic values that an architecture might require should be hidden behind the name. However, if required, architectures can expose relevant properties.
name: string
the name of the CPU definition the model is based on
props: value (optional)
a dictionary of QOM properties to be applied
2.8
An enumeration of CPU model expansion types.
static |
Expand to a static CPU model, a combination of a static base model name and property delta changes. As the static base model will never change, the expanded CPU model will be the same, independent of QEMU version, machine type, machine options, and accelerator options. Therefore, the resulting model can be used by tooling without having to specify a compatibility machine − e.g. when displaying the "host" model. The static CPU models are migration−safe. | ||
full |
Expand all properties. The produced model is not guaranteed to be migration−safe, but allows tooling to get an insight and work with model details. |
When a non−migration−safe CPU model is expanded in static mode, some features enabled by the CPU model may be omitted, because they can't be implemented by a static CPU model definition (e.g. cache info passthrough and PMU passthrough in x86). If you need an accurate representation of the features enabled by a non−migration−safe CPU model, use full. If you need a static representation that will keep ABI compatibility even when changing QEMU version or machine−type, use static (but keep in mind that some features may be omitted).
2.8
An enumeration of CPU model comparison results. The result is usually calculated using e.g. CPU features or CPU generations.
incompatible
If model A is incompatible to model B, model A is not guaranteed to run where model B runs and the other way around.
identical
If model A is identical to model B, model A is guaranteed to run where model B runs and the other way around.
superset
If model A is a superset of model B, model B is guaranteed to run where model A runs. There are no guarantees about the other way.
subset |
If model A is a subset of model B, model A is guaranteed to run where model B runs. There are no guarantees about the other way. |
2.8
The result of a CPU model baseline.
model: CpuModelInfo
the baselined CpuModelInfo.
2.8
TARGET_S390X
The result of a CPU model comparison.
result: CpuModelCompareResult
The result of the compare operation.
responsible−properties: array of string
List of properties that led to the comparison result not being identical.
responsible−properties is a list of QOM property names that led to both CPUs not being detected as identical. For identical models, this list is empty. If a QOM property is read−only, that means there's no known way to make the CPU models identical. If the special property name "type" is included, the models are by definition not identical and cannot be made identical.
2.8
TARGET_S390X
Compares two CPU models, returning how they compare in a specific configuration. The results indicates how both models compare regarding runnability. This result can be used by tooling to make decisions if a certain CPU model will run in a certain configuration or if a compatible CPU model has to be created by baselining.
Usually, a CPU model is compared against the maximum possible CPU model of a certain configuration (e.g. the "host" model for KVM). If that CPU model is identical or a subset, it will run in that configuration.
The result returned by this command may be affected by:
• |
QEMU version: CPU models may look different depending on the QEMU version. (Except for CPU models reported as "static" in query−cpu−definitions.) | ||
• |
machine−type: CPU model may look different depending on the machine−type. (Except for CPU models reported as "static" in query−cpu−definitions.) | ||
• |
machine options (including accelerator): in some architectures, CPU models may look different depending on machine and accelerator options. (Except for CPU models reported as "static" in query−cpu−definitions.) | ||
• |
"−cpu" arguments and global properties: arguments to the −cpu option and global properties may affect expansion of CPU models. Using query−cpu−model−expansion while using these is not advised. |
Some architectures may not support comparing CPU models. s390x supports comparing CPU models.
modela: CpuModelInfo
Not documented
modelb: CpuModelInfo
Not documented
a CpuModelBaselineInfo. Returns an error if comparing CPU models is not supported, if a model cannot be used, if a model contains an unknown cpu definition name, unknown properties or properties with wrong types.
this command isn't specific to s390x, but is only implemented on this architecture currently.
2.8
TARGET_S390X
Baseline two CPU models, creating a compatible third model. The created model will always be a static, migration−safe CPU model (see "static" CPU model expansion for details).
This interface can be used by tooling to create a compatible CPU model out two CPU models. The created CPU model will be identical to or a subset of both CPU models when comparing them. Therefore, the created CPU model is guaranteed to run where the given CPU models run.
The result returned by this command may be affected by:
• |
QEMU version: CPU models may look different depending on the QEMU version. (Except for CPU models reported as "static" in query−cpu−definitions.) | ||
• |
machine−type: CPU model may look different depending on the machine−type. (Except for CPU models reported as "static" in query−cpu−definitions.) | ||
• |
machine options (including accelerator): in some architectures, CPU models may look different depending on machine and accelerator options. (Except for CPU models reported as "static" in query−cpu−definitions.) | ||
• |
"−cpu" arguments and global properties: arguments to the −cpu option and global properties may affect expansion of CPU models. Using query−cpu−model−expansion while using these is not advised. |
Some architectures may not support baselining CPU models. s390x supports baselining CPU models.
modela: CpuModelInfo
Not documented
modelb: CpuModelInfo
Not documented
a CpuModelBaselineInfo. Returns an error if baselining CPU models is not supported, if a model cannot be used, if a model contains an unknown cpu definition name, unknown properties or properties with wrong types.
this command isn't specific to s390x, but is only implemented on this architecture currently.
2.8
TARGET_S390X
The result of a cpu model expansion.
model: CpuModelInfo
the expanded CpuModelInfo.
2.8
TARGET_S390X or TARGET_I386 or TARGET_ARM
Expands a given CPU model (or a combination of CPU model + additional options) to different granularities, allowing tooling to get an understanding what a specific CPU model looks like in QEMU under a certain configuration.
This interface can be used to query the "host" CPU model.
The data returned by this command may be affected by:
• |
QEMU version: CPU models may look different depending on the QEMU version. (Except for CPU models reported as "static" in query−cpu−definitions.) | ||
• |
machine−type: CPU model may look different depending on the machine−type. (Except for CPU models reported as "static" in query−cpu−definitions.) | ||
• |
machine options (including accelerator): in some architectures, CPU models may look different depending on machine and accelerator options. (Except for CPU models reported as "static" in query−cpu−definitions.) | ||
• |
"−cpu" arguments and global properties: arguments to the −cpu option and global properties may affect expansion of CPU models. Using query−cpu−model−expansion while using these is not advised. |
Some architectures may not support all expansion types. s390x supports "full" and "static". Arm only supports "full".
type: CpuModelExpansionType
Not documented
model: CpuModelInfo
Not documented
a CpuModelExpansionInfo. Returns an error if expanding CPU models is not supported, if the model cannot be expanded, if the model contains an unknown CPU definition name, unknown properties or properties with a wrong type. Also returns an error if an expansion type is not supported.
2.8
TARGET_S390X or TARGET_I386 or TARGET_ARM
Virtual CPU definition.
name: string
the name of the CPU definition
migration−safe: boolean (optional)
whether a CPU definition can be safely used for migration in combination with a QEMU compatibility machine when migrating between different QEMU versions and between hosts with different sets of (hardware or software) capabilities. If not provided, information is not available and callers should not assume the CPU definition to be migration−safe. (since 2.8)
static: boolean
whether a CPU definition is static and will not change depending on QEMU version, machine type, machine options and accelerator options. A static model is always migration−safe. (since 2.8)
unavailable−features: array of string (optional)
List of properties that prevent the CPU model from running in the current host. (since 2.8)
typename: string
Type name that can be used as argument to device−list−properties, to introspect properties configurable using −cpu or −global. (since 2.9)
alias−of: string (optional)
Name of CPU model this model is an alias for. The target of the CPU model alias may change depending on the machine type. Management software is supposed to translate CPU model aliases in the VM configuration, because aliases may stop being migration−safe in the future (since 4.1)
deprecated: boolean
If true, this CPU model is deprecated and may be removed in in some future version of QEMU according to the QEMU deprecation policy. (since 5.2)
unavailable−features is a list of QOM property names that represent CPU model attributes that prevent the CPU from running. If the QOM property is read−only, that means there's no known way to make the CPU model run in the current host. Implementations that choose not to provide specific information return the property name "type". If the property is read−write, it means that it MAY be possible to run the CPU model in the current host if that property is changed. Management software can use it as hints to suggest or choose an alternative for the user, or just to generate meaningful error messages explaining why the CPU model can't be used. If unavailable−features is an empty list, the CPU model is runnable using the current host and machine−type. If unavailable−features is not present, runnability information for the CPU is not available.
1.2
TARGET_PPC or TARGET_ARM or TARGET_I386 or TARGET_S390X or TARGET_MIPS or TARGET_LOONGARCH64 or TARGET_RISCV
Return a list of supported virtual CPU definitions
a list of CpuDefinitionInfo
1.2
TARGET_PPC or TARGET_ARM or TARGET_I386 or TARGET_S390X or TARGET_MIPS or TARGET_LOONGARCH64 or TARGET_RISCV
Mode of the replay subsystem.
none |
normal execution mode. Replay or record are not enabled. | ||
record |
record mode. All non−deterministic data is written into the replay log. | ||
play |
replay mode. Non−deterministic data required for system execution is read from the log. |
2.5
Record/replay information.
mode: ReplayMode
current mode.
filename: string (optional)
name of the record/replay log file. It is present only in record or replay modes, when the log is recorded or replayed.
icount: int
current number of executed instructions.
5.2
Retrieve the record/replay information. It includes current instruction count which may be used for replay−break and replay−seek commands.
record/replay information.
5.2
−> { "execute": "query−replay" } <− { "return": { "mode": "play", "filename": "log.rr", "icount": 220414 } }
Set replay breakpoint at instruction count icount. Execution stops when the specified instruction is reached. There can be at most one breakpoint. When breakpoint is set, any prior one is removed. The breakpoint may be set only in replay mode and only "in the future", i.e. at instruction counts greater than the current one. The current instruction count can be observed with query−replay.
icount: int
instruction count to stop at
5.2
−> { "execute": "replay−break", "arguments": { "icount": 220414 } } <− { "return": {} }
Remove replay breakpoint which was set with replay−break. The command is ignored when there are no replay breakpoints.
5.2
−> { "execute": "replay−delete−break" } <− { "return": {} }
Automatically proceed to the instruction count icount, when replaying the execution. The command automatically loads nearest snapshot and replays the execution to find the desired instruction. When there is no preceding snapshot or the execution is not replayed, then the command fails. icount for the reference may be obtained with query−replay command.
icount: int
target instruction count
5.2
−> { "execute": "replay−seek", "arguments": { "icount": 220414 } } <− { "return": {} }
An enumeration of yank instance types. See YankInstance for more information.
block−node
Not documented
chardev
Not documented
migration
Not documented
6.0
Specifies which block graph node to yank. See YankInstance for more information.
node−name: string
the name of the block graph node
6.0
Specifies which character device to yank. See YankInstance for more information.
id: string
the chardev's ID
6.0
A yank instance can be yanked with the yank qmp command to recover from a hanging QEMU.
Currently implemented yank instances:
• |
nbd block device: Yanking it will shut down the connection to the nbd server without attempting to reconnect. | ||
• |
socket chardev: Yanking it will shut down the connected socket. | ||
• |
migration: Yanking it will shut down all migration connections. Unlike migrate_cancel, it will not notify the migration process, so migration will go into failed state, instead of cancelled state. yank should be used to recover from hangs. |
type: YankInstanceType
Not documented
The members of
YankInstanceBlockNode when type is
"block−node"
The members of YankInstanceChardev when type is
"chardev"
6.0
Try to recover from hanging QEMU by yanking the specified instances. See YankInstance for more information.
Takes a list of YankInstance as argument.
instances: array of YankInstance
Not documented
• |
Nothing on success |
|||
• |
DeviceNotFound error, if any of the YankInstances doesn't exist |
−> { "execute": "yank", "arguments": { "instances": [ { "type": "block−node", "node−name": "nbd0" } ] } } <− { "return": {} }
6.0
Query yank instances. See YankInstance for more information.
list of YankInstance
−> { "execute": "query−yank" } <− { "return": [ { "type": "block−node", "node−name": "nbd0" } ] }
6.0
Allow client connections for VNC, Spice and socket based character devices to be passed in to QEMU via SCM_RIGHTS.
If the FD associated with fdname is not a socket, the command will fail and the FD will be closed.
protocol: string
protocol name. Valid names are "vnc", "spice", "dbus−display" or the name of a character device (e.g. from −chardev id=XXXX)
fdname: string
file descriptor name previously passed via 'getfd' command
skipauth: boolean (optional)
whether to skip authentication. Only applies to "vnc" and "spice" protocols
tls: boolean (optional)
whether to perform TLS. Only applies to the "spice" protocol
nothing on success.
0.14
−> { "execute": "add_client", "arguments": { "protocol": "vnc", "fdname": "myclient" } } <− { "return": {} }
Guest name information.
name: string (optional)
The name of the guest
0.14
Return the name information of a guest.
NameInfo of the guest
0.14
−> { "execute": "query−name" } <− { "return": { "name": "qemu−name" } }
Information about an iothread
id: string
the identifier of the iothread
thread−id: int
ID of the underlying host thread
poll−max−ns: int
maximum polling time in ns, 0 means polling is disabled (since 2.9)
poll−grow: int
how many ns will be added to polling time, 0 means that it's not configured (since 2.9)
poll−shrink: int
how many ns will be removed from polling time, 0 means that it's not configured (since 2.9)
aio−max−batch: int
maximum number of requests in a batch for the AIO engine, 0 means that the engine will use its default (since 6.1)
2.0
Returns a list of information about each iothread.
this list excludes the QEMU main loop thread, which is not declared using the −object iothread command−line option. It is always the main thread of the process.
a list of IOThreadInfo for each iothread
2.0
−> { "execute": "query−iothreads" } <− { "return": [ { "id":"iothread0", "thread−id":3134 }, { "id":"iothread1", "thread−id":3135 } ] }
Stop all guest VCPU execution.
0.14
This function will succeed even if the guest is already in the stopped state. In "inmigrate" state, it will ensure that the guest remains paused once migration finishes, as if the −S option was passed on the command line.
−> { "execute": "stop" } <− { "return": {} }
Resume guest VCPU execution.
0.14
If successful, nothing
This command will succeed if the guest is currently running. It will also succeed if the guest is in the "inmigrate" state; in this case, the effect of the command is to make sure the guest starts once migration finishes, removing the effect of the −S command line option if it was passed.
−> { "execute": "cont" } <− { "return": {} }
Exit from "preconfig" state
This command makes QEMU exit the preconfig state and proceed with VM initialization using configuration data provided on the command line and via the QMP monitor during the preconfig state. The command is only available during the preconfig state (i.e. when the −−preconfig command line option was in use).
unstable
This command is experimental.
3.0
nothing
−> { "execute": "x−exit−preconfig" } <− { "return": {} }
Execute a command on the human monitor and return the output.
command−line: string
the command to execute in the human monitor
cpu−index: int (optional)
The CPU to use for commands that require an implicit CPU
savevm−monitor−nodes
If present, HMP command savevm only snapshots monitor−owned nodes if they have no parents. This allows the use of 'savevm' with −blockdev. (since 4.2)
the output of the command as a string
0.14
This command only exists as a stop−gap. Its use is highly discouraged. The semantics of this command are not guaranteed: this means that command names, arguments and responses can change or be removed at ANY time. Applications that rely on long term stability guarantees should NOT use this command.
Known limitations:
• |
This command is stateless, this means that commands that depend on state information (such as getfd) might not work | ||
• |
Commands that prompt the user for data don't currently work |
−> { "execute": "human−monitor−command", "arguments": { "command−line": "info kvm" } } <− { "return": "kvm support: enabled\r\n" }
Receive a file descriptor via SCM rights and assign it a name
fdname: string
file descriptor name
Nothing on success
0.14
If fdname already exists, the file descriptor assigned to it will be closed and replaced by the received file descriptor.
The 'closefd' command can be used to explicitly close the file descriptor when it is no longer needed.
−> { "execute": "getfd", "arguments": { "fdname": "fd1" } } <− { "return": {} }
CONFIG_POSIX
Add a socket that was duplicated to QEMU process with WSADuplicateSocketW() via WSASocket() & WSAPROTOCOL_INFOW structure and assign it a name (the SOCKET is associated with a CRT file descriptor)
info: string
the WSAPROTOCOL_INFOW structure (encoded in base64)
fdname: string
file descriptor name
Nothing on success
8.0
If fdname already exists, the file descriptor assigned to it will be closed and replaced by the received file descriptor.
The 'closefd' command can be used to explicitly close the file descriptor when it is no longer needed.
−> { "execute": "get−win32−socket", "arguments": { "info": "abcd123..", fdname": "skclient" } } <− { "return": {} }
CONFIG_WIN32
Close a file descriptor previously passed via SCM rights
fdname: string
file descriptor name
Nothing on success
0.14
−> { "execute": "closefd", "arguments": { "fdname": "fd1" } } <− { "return": {} }
Information about a file descriptor that was added to an fd set.
fdset−id: int
The ID of the fd set that fd was added to.
fd: int
The file descriptor that was received via SCM rights and added to the fd set.
1.2
Add a file descriptor, that was passed via SCM rights, to an fd set.
fdset−id: int (optional)
The ID of the fd set to add the file descriptor to.
opaque: string (optional)
A free−form string that can be used to describe the fd.
• |
AddfdInfo on success |
|||
• |
If file descriptor was not received, GenericError |
|||
• |
If fdset−id is a negative value, GenericError |
The list of fd sets is shared by all monitor connections.
If fdset−id is not specified, a new fd set will be created.
1.2
−> { "execute": "add−fd", "arguments": { "fdset−id": 1 } } <− { "return": { "fdset−id": 1, "fd": 3 } }
Remove a file descriptor from an fd set.
fdset−id: int
The ID of the fd set that the file descriptor belongs to.
fd: int (optional)
The file descriptor that is to be removed.
• |
Nothing on success |
|||
• |
If fdset−id or fd is not found, GenericError |
1.2
The list of fd sets is shared by all monitor connections.
If fd is not specified, all file descriptors in fdset−id will be removed.
−> { "execute": "remove−fd", "arguments": { "fdset−id": 1, "fd": 3 } } <− { "return": {} }
Information about a file descriptor that belongs to an fd set.
fd: int
The file descriptor value.
opaque: string (optional)
A free−form string that can be used to describe the fd.
1.2
Information about an fd set.
fdset−id: int
The ID of the fd set.
fds: array of FdsetFdInfo
A list of file descriptors that belong to this fd set.
1.2
Return information describing all fd sets.
A list of FdsetInfo
1.2
The list of fd sets is shared by all monitor connections.
−> { "execute": "query−fdsets" } <− { "return": [ { "fds": [ { "fd": 30, "opaque": "rdonly:/path/to/file" }, { "fd": 24, "opaque": "rdwr:/path/to/file" } ], "fdset−id": 1 }, { "fds": [ { "fd": 28 }, { "fd": 29 } ], "fdset−id": 0 } ] }
Possible types for an option parameter.
string |
accepts a character string |
boolean
accepts "on" or "off"
number |
accepts a number | ||
size |
accepts a number followed by an optional suffix (K)ilo, (M)ega, (G)iga, (T)era |
1.5
Details about a single parameter of a command line option.
name: string
parameter name
type: CommandLineParameterType
parameter CommandLineParameterType
help: string (optional)
human readable text string, not suitable for parsing.
default: string (optional)
default value string (since 2.1)
1.5
Details about a command line option, including its list of parameter details
option: string
option name
parameters: array of CommandLineParameterInfo
an array of CommandLineParameterInfo
1.5
Query command line option schema.
option: string (optional)
option name
list of CommandLineOptionInfo for all options (or for the given option). Returns an error if the given option doesn't exist.
1.5
−> { "execute": "query−command−line−options", "arguments": { "option": "option−rom" } } <− { "return": [ { "parameters": [ { "name": "romfile", "type": "string" }, { "name": "bootindex", "type": "number" } ], "option": "option−rom" } ] }
Emitted when the guest changes the RTC time.
offset: int
offset in seconds between base RTC clock (as specified by −rtc base), and new RTC clock value
qom−path: string
path to the RTC object in the QOM tree
This event is rate−limited. It is not guaranteed that the RTC in the system implements this event, or even that the system has an RTC at all.
0.13
<− { "event": "RTC_CHANGE", "data": { "offset": 78 }, "timestamp": { "seconds": 1267020223, "microseconds": 435656 } }
Emitted when the client of a TYPE_VFIO_USER_SERVER closes the communication channel
vfu−id: string
ID of the TYPE_VFIO_USER_SERVER object. It is the last component of vfu−qom−path referenced below
vfu−qom−path: string
path to the TYPE_VFIO_USER_SERVER object in the QOM tree
dev−id: string
ID of attached PCI device
dev−qom−path: string
path to attached PCI device in the QOM tree
7.1
<− { "event": "VFU_CLIENT_HANGUP", "data": { "vfu−id": "vfu1", "vfu−qom−path": "/objects/vfu1", "dev−id": "sas1", "dev−qom−path": "/machine/peripheral/sas1" }, "timestamp": { "seconds": 1265044230, "microseconds": 450486 } }
This command will reset the RTC interrupt reinjection backlog. Can be used if another mechanism to synchronize guest time is in effect, for example QEMU guest agent's guest−set−time command.
2.1
−> { "execute": "rtc−reset−reinjection" } <− { "return": {} }
TARGET_I386
An enumeration of SEV state information used during query−sev.
uninit |
The guest is uninitialized. |
launch−update
The guest is currently being launched; plaintext data and register state is being imported.
launch−secret
The guest is currently being launched; ciphertext data is being imported.
running
The guest is fully launched or migrated in.
send−update
The guest is currently being migrated out to another machine.
receive−update
The guest is currently being migrated from another machine.
2.12
TARGET_I386
Information about Secure Encrypted Virtualization (SEV) support
enabled: boolean
true if SEV is active
api−major: int
SEV API major version
api−minor: int
SEV API minor version
build−id: int
SEV FW build id
policy: int
SEV policy value
state: SevState
SEV guest state
handle: int
SEV firmware handle
2.12
TARGET_I386
Returns information about SEV
SevInfo
2.12
−> { "execute": "query−sev" } <− { "return": { "enabled": true, "api−major" : 0, "api−minor" : 0, "build−id" : 0, "policy" : 0, "state" : "running", "handle" : 1 } }
TARGET_I386
SEV Guest Launch measurement information
data: string
the measurement value encoded in base64
2.12
TARGET_I386
Query the SEV guest launch information.
The SevLaunchMeasureInfo for the guest
2.12
−> { "execute": "query−sev−launch−measure" } <− { "return": { "data": "4l8LXeNlSPUDlXPJG5966/8%YZ" } }
TARGET_I386
The struct describes capability for a Secure Encrypted Virtualization feature.
pdh: string
Platform Diffie−Hellman key (base64 encoded)
cert−chain: string
PDH certificate chain (base64 encoded)
cpu0−id: string
Unique ID of CPU0 (base64 encoded) (since 7.1)
cbitpos: int
C−bit location in page table entry
reduced−phys−bits: int
Number of physical Address bit reduction when SEV is enabled
2.12
TARGET_I386
This command is used to get the SEV capabilities, and is supported on AMD X86 platforms only.
SevCapability objects.
2.12
−> { "execute": "query−sev−capabilities" } <− { "return": { "pdh": "8CCDD8DDD", "cert−chain": "888CCCDDDEE", "cpu0−id": "2lvmGwo+...61iEinw==", "cbitpos": 47, "reduced−phys−bits": 1}}
TARGET_I386
This command injects a secret blob into memory of SEV guest.
packet−header: string
the launch secret packet header encoded in base64
secret: string
the launch secret data to be injected encoded in base64
gpa: int (optional)
the guest physical address where secret will be injected.
6.0
TARGET_I386
The struct describes attestation report for a Secure Encrypted Virtualization feature.
data: string
guest attestation report (base64 encoded)
6.1
TARGET_I386
This command is used to get the SEV attestation report, and is supported on AMD X86 platforms only.
mnonce: string
a random 16 bytes value encoded in base64 (it will be included in report)
SevAttestationReport objects.
6.1
−> { "execute" : "query−sev−attestation−report", "arguments": { "mnonce": "aaaaaaa" } } <− { "return" : { "data": "aaaaaaaabbbddddd"} }
TARGET_I386
Dump guest's storage keys
filename: string
the path to the file to dump to
This command is only supported on s390 architecture.
2.5
−> { "execute": "dump−skeys", "arguments": { "filename": "/tmp/skeys" } } <− { "return": {} }
TARGET_S390X
The struct describes capability for a specific GIC (Generic Interrupt Controller) version. These bits are not only decided by QEMU/KVM software version, but also decided by the hardware that the program is running upon.
version: int
version of GIC to be described. Currently, only 2 and 3 are supported.
emulated: boolean
whether current QEMU/hardware supports emulated GIC device in user space.
kernel: boolean
whether current QEMU/hardware supports hardware accelerated GIC device in kernel.
2.6
TARGET_ARM
This command is ARM−only. It will return a list of GICCapability objects that describe its capability bits.
a list of GICCapability objects.
2.6
−> { "execute": "query−gic−capabilities" } <− { "return": [{ "version": 2, "emulated": true, "kernel": false }, { "version": 3, "emulated": false, "kernel": true } ] }
TARGET_ARM
Information about intel SGX EPC section info
node: int
the numa node
size: int
the size of EPC section
7.0
Information about intel Safe Guard eXtension (SGX) support
sgx: boolean
true if SGX is supported
sgx1: boolean
true if SGX1 is supported
sgx2: boolean
true if SGX2 is supported
flc: boolean
true if FLC is supported
sections: array of SGXEPCSection
The EPC sections info for guest (Since: 7.0)
6.2
TARGET_I386
Returns information about SGX
SGXInfo
6.2
−> { "execute": "query−sgx" } <− { "return": { "sgx": true, "sgx1" : true, "sgx2" : true, "flc": true, "sections": [{"node": 0, "size": 67108864}, {"node": 1, "size": 29360128}]} }
TARGET_I386
Returns information from host SGX capabilities
SGXInfo
6.2
−> { "execute": "query−sgx−capabilities" } <− { "return": { "sgx": true, "sgx1" : true, "sgx2" : true, "flc": true, "section" : [{"node": 0, "size": 67108864}, {"node": 1, "size": 29360128}]} }
TARGET_I386
An enumeration of Xen event channel port types.
closed |
The port is unused. |
unbound
The port is allocated and ready to be bound.
interdomain
The port is connected as an interdomain interrupt.
pirq |
The port is bound to a physical IRQ (PIRQ). |
|||
virq |
The port is bound to a virtual IRQ (VIRQ). |
|||
ipi |
The post is an inter−processor interrupt (IPI). |
8.0
TARGET_I386
Information about a Xen event channel port
port: int
the port number
vcpu: int
target vCPU for this port
type: EvtchnPortType
the port type
remote−domain: string
remote domain for interdomain ports
target: int
remote port ID, or virq/pirq number
pending: boolean
port is currently active pending delivery
masked: boolean
port is masked
8.0
TARGET_I386
Query the Xen event channels opened by the guest.
list of open event channel ports.
8.0
−> { "execute": "xen−event−list" } <− { "return": [ { "pending": false, "port": 1, "vcpu": 1, "remote−domain": "qemu", "masked": false, "type": "interdomain", "target": 1 }, { "pending": false, "port": 2, "vcpu": 0, "remote−domain": "", "masked": false, "type": "virq", "target": 0 } ] }
TARGET_I386
Inject a Xen event channel port (interrupt) to the guest.
port: int
The port number
• |
Nothing on success. |
8.0
−> { "execute": "xen−event−inject", "arguments": { "port": 1 } } <− { "return": { } }
TARGET_I386
General audio backend options that are used for both playback and recording.
mixing−engine: boolean (optional)
use QEMU's mixing engine to mix all streams inside QEMU and convert audio formats when not supported by the backend. When set to off, fixed−settings must be also off (default on, since 4.2)
fixed−settings: boolean (optional)
use fixed settings for host input/output. When off, frequency, channels and format must not be specified (default true)
frequency: int (optional)
frequency to use when using fixed settings (default 44100)
channels: int (optional)
number of channels when using fixed settings (default 2)
voices: int (optional)
number of voices to use (default 1)
format: AudioFormat (optional)
sample format to use when using fixed settings (default s16)
buffer−length: int (optional)
the buffer length in microseconds
4.0
Generic driver−specific options.
in: AudiodevPerDirectionOptions (optional)
options of the capture stream
out: AudiodevPerDirectionOptions (optional)
options of the playback stream
4.0
Options of the ALSA backend that are used for both playback and recording.
dev: string (optional)
the name of the ALSA device to use (default 'default')
period−length: int (optional)
the period length in microseconds
try−poll: boolean (optional)
attempt to use poll mode, falling back to non−polling access on failure (default true)
The members of AudiodevPerDirectionOptions
4.0
Options of the ALSA audio backend.
in: AudiodevAlsaPerDirectionOptions (optional)
options of the capture stream
out: AudiodevAlsaPerDirectionOptions (optional)
options of the playback stream
threshold: int (optional)
set the threshold (in microseconds) when playback starts
4.0
Options of the sndio audio backend.
in: AudiodevPerDirectionOptions (optional)
options of the capture stream
out: AudiodevPerDirectionOptions (optional)
options of the playback stream
dev: string (optional)
the name of the sndio device to use (default 'default')
latency: int (optional)
play buffer size (in microseconds)
7.2
Options of the Core Audio backend that are used for both playback and recording.
buffer−count: int (optional)
number of buffers
The members of AudiodevPerDirectionOptions
4.0
Options of the coreaudio audio backend.
in: AudiodevCoreaudioPerDirectionOptions (optional)
options of the capture stream
out: AudiodevCoreaudioPerDirectionOptions (optional)
options of the playback stream
4.0
Options of the DirectSound audio backend.
in: AudiodevPerDirectionOptions (optional)
options of the capture stream
out: AudiodevPerDirectionOptions (optional)
options of the playback stream
latency: int (optional)
add extra latency to playback in microseconds (default 10000)
4.0
Options of the JACK backend that are used for both playback and recording.
server−name: string (optional)
select from among several possible concurrent server instances (default: environment variable $JACK_DEFAULT_SERVER if set, else "default")
client−name: string (optional)
the client name to use. The server will modify this name to create a unique variant, if needed unless exact−name is true (default: the guest's name)
connect−ports: string (optional)
if set, a regular expression of JACK client port name(s) to monitor for and automatically connect to
start−server: boolean (optional)
start a jack server process if one is not already present (default: false)
exact−name: boolean (optional)
use the exact name requested otherwise JACK automatically generates a unique one, if needed (default: false)
The members of AudiodevPerDirectionOptions
5.1
Options of the JACK audio backend.
in: AudiodevJackPerDirectionOptions (optional)
options of the capture stream
out: AudiodevJackPerDirectionOptions (optional)
options of the playback stream
5.1
Options of the OSS backend that are used for both playback and recording.
dev: string (optional)
file name of the OSS device (default '/dev/dsp')
buffer−count: int (optional)
number of buffers
try−poll: boolean (optional)
attempt to use poll mode, falling back to non−polling access on failure (default true)
The members of AudiodevPerDirectionOptions
4.0
Options of the OSS audio backend.
in: AudiodevOssPerDirectionOptions (optional)
options of the capture stream
out: AudiodevOssPerDirectionOptions (optional)
options of the playback stream
try−mmap: boolean (optional)
try using memory−mapped access, falling back to non−memory−mapped access on failure (default true)
exclusive: boolean (optional)
open device in exclusive mode (vmix won't work) (default false)
dsp−policy: int (optional)
set the timing policy of the device (between 0 and 10, where smaller number means smaller latency but higher CPU usage) or −1 to use fragment mode (option ignored on some platforms) (default 5)
4.0
Options of the Pulseaudio backend that are used for both playback and recording.
name: string (optional)
name of the sink/source to use
stream−name: string (optional)
name of the PulseAudio stream created by qemu. Can be used to identify the stream in PulseAudio when you create multiple PulseAudio devices or run multiple qemu instances (default: audiodev's id, since 4.2)
latency: int (optional)
latency you want PulseAudio to achieve in microseconds (default 15000)
The members of AudiodevPerDirectionOptions
4.0
Options of the PulseAudio audio backend.
in: AudiodevPaPerDirectionOptions (optional)
options of the capture stream
out: AudiodevPaPerDirectionOptions (optional)
options of the playback stream
server: string (optional)
PulseAudio server address (default: let PulseAudio choose)
4.0
Options of the PipeWire backend that are used for both playback and recording.
name: string (optional)
name of the sink/source to use
stream−name: string (optional)
name of the PipeWire stream created by qemu. Can be used to identify the stream in PipeWire when you create multiple PipeWire devices or run multiple qemu instances (default: audiodev's id)
latency: int (optional)
latency you want PipeWire to achieve in microseconds (default 46000)
The members of AudiodevPerDirectionOptions
8.1
Options of the PipeWire audio backend.
in: AudiodevPipewirePerDirectionOptions (optional)
options of the capture stream
out: AudiodevPipewirePerDirectionOptions (optional)
options of the playback stream
8.1
Options of the SDL audio backend that are used for both playback and recording.
buffer−count: int (optional)
number of buffers (default 4)
The members of AudiodevPerDirectionOptions
6.0
Options of the SDL audio backend.
in: AudiodevSdlPerDirectionOptions (optional)
options of the recording stream
out: AudiodevSdlPerDirectionOptions (optional)
options of the playback stream
6.0
Options of the wav audio backend.
in: AudiodevPerDirectionOptions (optional)
options of the capture stream
out: AudiodevPerDirectionOptions (optional)
options of the playback stream
path: string (optional)
name of the wav file to record (default 'qemu.wav')
4.0
An enumeration of possible audio formats.
u8 |
unsigned 8 bit integer |
|||
s8 |
signed 8 bit integer |
|||
u16 |
unsigned 16 bit integer |
|||
s16 |
signed 16 bit integer |
|||
u32 |
unsigned 32 bit integer |
|||
s32 |
signed 32 bit integer |
|||
f32 |
single precision floating−point (since 5.0) |
4.0
An enumeration of possible audio backend drivers.
jack (If: CONFIG_AUDIO_JACK)
JACK audio backend (since 5.1)
none |
Not documented |
alsa (If: CONFIG_AUDIO_ALSA)
Not documented
coreaudio (If: CONFIG_AUDIO_COREAUDIO)
Not documented
dbus (If: CONFIG_DBUS_DISPLAY)
Not documented
dsound (If: CONFIG_AUDIO_DSOUND)
Not documented
oss (If: CONFIG_AUDIO_OSS)
Not documented
pa (If: CONFIG_AUDIO_PA)
Not documented
pipewire (If: CONFIG_AUDIO_PIPEWIRE)
Not documented
sdl (If: CONFIG_AUDIO_SDL)
Not documented
sndio (If: CONFIG_AUDIO_SNDIO)
Not documented
spice (If: CONFIG_SPICE)
Not documented
wav |
Not documented |
4.0
Options of an audio backend.
id: string
identifier of the backend
driver: AudiodevDriver
the backend driver to use
timer−period: int (optional)
timer period (in microseconds, 0: use lowest possible)
The members of
AudiodevGenericOptions when driver is "none"
The members of AudiodevAlsaOptions when driver
is "alsa" (If:
CONFIG_AUDIO_ALSA)
The members of AudiodevCoreaudioOptions when
driver is "coreaudio" (If:
CONFIG_AUDIO_COREAUDIO)
The members of AudiodevGenericOptions when
driver is "dbus" (If:
CONFIG_DBUS_DISPLAY)
The members of AudiodevDsoundOptions when
driver is "dsound" (If:
CONFIG_AUDIO_DSOUND)
The members of AudiodevJackOptions when driver
is "jack" (If:
CONFIG_AUDIO_JACK)
The members of AudiodevOssOptions when driver
is "oss" (If:
CONFIG_AUDIO_OSS)
The members of AudiodevPaOptions when driver
is "pa" (If:
CONFIG_AUDIO_PA)
The members of AudiodevPipewireOptions when
driver is "pipewire" (If:
CONFIG_AUDIO_PIPEWIRE)
The members of AudiodevSdlOptions when driver
is "sdl" (If:
CONFIG_AUDIO_SDL)
The members of AudiodevSndioOptions when
driver is "sndio" (If:
CONFIG_AUDIO_SNDIO)
The members of AudiodevGenericOptions when
driver is "spice" (If:
CONFIG_SPICE)
The members of AudiodevWavOptions when driver is
"wav"
4.0
Returns information about audiodev configuration
array of Audiodev
8.0
Specify an ACPI table on the command line to load.
At most one of file and data can be specified. The list of files specified by any one of them is loaded and concatenated in order. If both are omitted, data is implied.
Other fields / optargs can be used to override fields of the generic ACPI table header; refer to the ACPI specification 5.0, section 5.2.6 System Description Table Header. If a header field is not overridden, then the corresponding value from the concatenated blob is used (in case of file), or it is filled in with a hard−coded value (in case of data).
String fields are copied into the matching ACPI member from lowest address upwards, and silently truncated / NUL−padded to length.
sig: string (optional)
table signature / identifier (4 bytes)
rev: int (optional)
table revision number (dependent on signature, 1 byte)
oem_id: string (optional)
OEM identifier (6 bytes)
oem_table_id: string (optional)
OEM table identifier (8 bytes)
oem_rev: int (optional)
OEM−supplied revision number (4 bytes)
asl_compiler_id: string (optional)
identifier of the utility that created the table (4 bytes)
asl_compiler_rev: int (optional)
revision number of the utility that created the table (4 bytes)
file: string (optional)
colon (:) separated list of pathnames to load and concatenate as table data. The resultant binary blob is expected to have an ACPI table header. At least one file is required. This field excludes data.
data: string (optional)
colon (:) separated list of pathnames to load and concatenate as table data. The resultant binary blob must not have an ACPI table header. At least one file is required. This field excludes file.
1.5
DIMM |
memory slot |
|||
CPU |
logical CPU slot (since 2.7) |
OSPM Status Indication for a device For description of possible values of source and status fields see "_OST (OSPM Status Indication)" chapter of ACPI5.0 spec.
device: string (optional)
device ID associated with slot
slot: string
slot ID, unique per slot of a given slot−type
slot−type: ACPISlotType
type of the slot
source: int
an integer containing the source event
status: int
an integer containing the status code
2.1
Return a list of ACPIOSTInfo for devices that support status reporting via ACPI _OST method.
2.1
−> { "execute": "query−acpi−ospm−status" } <− { "return": [ { "device": "d1", "slot": "0", "slot−type": "DIMM", "source": 1, "status": 0}, { "slot": "1", "slot−type": "DIMM", "source": 0, "status": 0}, { "slot": "2", "slot−type": "DIMM", "source": 0, "status": 0}, { "slot": "3", "slot−type": "DIMM", "source": 0, "status": 0} ]}
Emitted when guest executes ACPI _OST method.
info: ACPIOSTInfo
OSPM Status Indication
2.1
<− { "event": "ACPI_DEVICE_OST", "data": { "info": { "device": "d1", "slot": "0", "slot−type": "DIMM", "source": 1, "status": 0 } }, "timestamp": { "seconds": 1265044230, "microseconds": 450486 } }
A PCI device memory region
base: int
the starting address (guest physical)
limit: int
the ending address (guest physical)
0.14
Information about a PCI device I/O region.
bar: int
the index of the Base Address Register for this region
type: string
• |
'io' if the region is a PIO region |
|||
• |
'memory' if the region is a MMIO region |
size: int
memory size
prefetch: boolean (optional)
if type is 'memory', true if the memory is prefetchable
mem_type_64: boolean (optional)
if type is 'memory', true if the BAR is 64−bit
address: int
Not documented
0.14
Information about a bus of a PCI Bridge device
number: int
primary bus interface number. This should be the number of the bus the device resides on.
secondary: int
secondary bus interface number. This is the number of the main bus for the bridge
subordinate: int
This is the highest number bus that resides below the bridge.
io_range: PciMemoryRange
The PIO range for all devices on this bridge
memory_range: PciMemoryRange
The MMIO range for all devices on this bridge
prefetchable_range: PciMemoryRange
The range of prefetchable MMIO for all devices on this bridge
2.4
Information about a PCI Bridge device
bus: PciBusInfo
information about the bus the device resides on
devices: array of PciDeviceInfo (optional)
a list of PciDeviceInfo for each device on this bridge
0.14
Information about the Class of a PCI device
desc: string (optional)
a string description of the device's class
class: int
the class code of the device
2.4
Information about the Id of a PCI device
device: int
the PCI device id
vendor: int
the PCI vendor id
subsystem: int (optional)
the PCI subsystem id (since 3.1)
subsystem−vendor: int (optional)
the PCI subsystem vendor id (since 3.1)
2.4
Information about a PCI device
bus: int
the bus number of the device
slot: int
the slot the device is located in
function: int
the function of the slot used by the device
class_info: PciDeviceClass
the class of the device
id: PciDeviceId
the PCI device id
irq: int (optional)
if an IRQ is assigned to the device, the IRQ number
irq_pin: int
the IRQ pin, zero means no IRQ (since 5.1)
qdev_id: string
the device name of the PCI device
pci_bridge: PciBridgeInfo (optional)
if the device is a PCI bridge, the bridge information
regions: array of PciMemoryRegion
a list of the PCI I/O regions associated with the device
the contents of class_info.desc are not stable and should only be treated as informational.
0.14
Information about a PCI bus
bus: int
the bus index
devices: array of PciDeviceInfo
a list of devices on this bus
0.14
Return information about the PCI bus topology of the guest.
a list of PciInfo for each PCI bus. Each bus is represented by a json−object, which has a key with a json−array of all PCI devices attached to it. Each device is represented by a json−object.
0.14
−> { "execute": "query−pci" } <− { "return": [ { "bus": 0, "devices": [ { "bus": 0, "qdev_id": "", "slot": 0, "class_info": { "class": 1536, "desc": "Host bridge" }, "id": { "device": 32902, "vendor": 4663 }, "function": 0, "regions": [ ] }, { "bus": 0, "qdev_id": "", "slot": 1, "class_info": { "class": 1537, "desc": "ISA bridge" }, "id": { "device": 32902, "vendor": 28672 }, "function": 0, "regions": [ ] }, { "bus": 0, "qdev_id": "", "slot": 1, "class_info": { "class": 257, "desc": "IDE controller" }, "id": { "device": 32902, "vendor": 28688 }, "function": 1, "regions": [ { "bar": 4, "size": 16, "address": 49152, "type": "io" } ] }, { "bus": 0, "qdev_id": "", "slot": 2, "class_info": { "class": 768, "desc": "VGA controller" }, "id": { "device": 4115, "vendor": 184 }, "function": 0, "regions": [ { "prefetch": true, "mem_type_64": false, "bar": 0, "size": 33554432, "address": 4026531840, "type": "memory" }, { "prefetch": false, "mem_type_64": false, "bar": 1, "size": 4096, "address": 4060086272, "type": "memory" }, { "prefetch": false, "mem_type_64": false, "bar": 6, "size": 65536, "address": −1, "type": "memory" } ] }, { "bus": 0, "qdev_id": "", "irq": 11, "slot": 4, "class_info": { "class": 1280, "desc": "RAM controller" }, "id": { "device": 6900, "vendor": 4098 }, "function": 0, "regions": [ { "bar": 0, "size": 32, "address": 49280, "type": "io" } ] } ] } ] }
This example has been shortened as the real response is too long.
Enumeration of statistics types
cumulative
stat is cumulative; value can only increase.
instant
stat is instantaneous; value can increase or decrease.
peak |
stat is the peak value; value can only increase. |
linear−histogram
stat is a linear histogram.
log2−histogram
stat is a logarithmic histogram, with one bucket for each power of two.
7.1
Enumeration of unit of measurement for statistics
bytes |
stat reported in bytes. |
seconds
stat reported in seconds.
cycles |
stat reported in clock cycles. |
boolean
stat is a boolean value.
7.1
Enumeration of statistics providers.
kvm |
since 7.1 |
cryptodev
since 8.0
7.1
The kinds of objects on which one can request statistics.
vm |
statistics that apply to the entire virtual machine or the entire QEMU process. | ||
vcpu |
statistics that apply to a single virtual CPU. |
cryptodev
statistics that apply to a crypto device (since 8.0)
7.1
Indicates a set of statistics that should be returned by query−stats.
provider: StatsProvider
provider for which to return statistics.
names: array of string (optional)
statistics to be returned (all if omitted).
7.1
vcpus: array of string (optional)
list of QOM paths for the desired vCPU objects.
7.1
The arguments to the query−stats command; specifies a target for which to request statistics and optionally the required subset of information for that target:
• |
which vCPUs to request statistics for |
|||
• |
which providers to request statistics from |
|||
• |
which named values to return within each provider |
target: StatsTarget
Not documented
providers: array of StatsRequest (optional)
Not documented
The members of StatsVCPUFilter when target is "vcpu"
7.1
scalar: int
single unsigned 64−bit integers.
list: array of int
list of unsigned 64−bit integers (used for histograms).
boolean: boolean
Not documented
7.1
name: string
name of stat.
value: StatsValue
stat value.
7.1
provider: StatsProvider
provider for this set of statistics.
qom−path: string (optional)
Path to the object for which the statistics are returned, if the object is exposed in the QOM tree
stats: array of Stats
list of statistics.
7.1
Return runtime−collected statistics for objects such as the VM or its vCPUs.
The arguments are a StatsFilter and specify the provider and objects to return statistics about.
The members of StatsFilter
a list of StatsResult, one for each provider and object (e.g., for each vCPU).
7.1
Schema for a single statistic.
name: string
name of the statistic; each element of the schema is uniquely identified by a target, a provider (both available in StatsSchema) and the name.
type: StatsType
kind of statistic.
unit: StatsUnit (optional)
basic unit of measure for the statistic; if missing, the statistic is a simple number or counter.
base: int (optional)
base for the multiple of unit in which the statistic is measured. Only present if exponent is non−zero; base and exponent together form a SI prefix (e.g., _nano−_ for base=10 and exponent=−9) or IEC binary prefix (e.g. _kibi−_ for base=2 and exponent=10)
exponent: int
exponent for the multiple of unit in which the statistic is expressed, or 0 for the basic unit
bucket−size: int (optional)
Present when type is "linear−histogram", contains the width of each bucket of the histogram.
7.1
Schema for all available statistics for a provider and target.
provider: StatsProvider
provider for this set of statistics.
target: StatsTarget
the kind of object that can be queried through the provider.
stats: array of StatsSchemaValue
list of statistics.
7.1
Return the schema for all available runtime−collected statistics.
provider: StatsProvider (optional)
Not documented
runtime−collected statistics and their names fall outside QEMU's usual deprecation policies. QEMU will try to keep the set of available data stable, together with their names, but will not guarantee stability at all costs; the same is true of providers that source statistics externally, e.g. from Linux. For example, if the same value is being tracked with different names on different architectures or by different providers, one of them might be renamed. A statistic might go away if an algorithm is changed or some code is removed; changing a default might cause previously useful statistics to always report 0. Such changes, however, are expected to be rare.
7.1
Basic information about a given VirtIODevice
path: string
The VirtIODevice's canonical QOM path
name: string
Name of the VirtIODevice
7.2
Returns a list of all realized VirtIODevices
unstable
This command is meant for debugging.
List of gathered VirtIODevices
7.2
−> { "execute": "x−query−virtio" } <− { "return": [ { "name": "virtio−input", "path": "/machine/peripheral−anon/device[4]/virtio−backend" }, { "name": "virtio−crypto", "path": "/machine/peripheral/crypto0/virtio−backend" }, { "name": "virtio−scsi", "path": "/machine/peripheral−anon/device[2]/virtio−backend" }, { "name": "virtio−net", "path": "/machine/peripheral−anon/device[1]/virtio−backend" }, { "name": "virtio−serial", "path": "/machine/peripheral−anon/device[0]/virtio−backend" } ] }
Information about a vhost device. This information will only be displayed if the vhost device is active.
n−mem−sections: int
vhost_dev n_mem_sections
n−tmp−sections: int
vhost_dev n_tmp_sections
nvqs: int
vhost_dev nvqs (number of virtqueues being used)
vq−index: int
vhost_dev vq_index
features: VirtioDeviceFeatures
vhost_dev features
acked−features: VirtioDeviceFeatures
vhost_dev acked_features
backend−features: VirtioDeviceFeatures
vhost_dev backend_features
protocol−features: VhostDeviceProtocols
vhost_dev protocol_features
max−queues: int
vhost_dev max_queues
backend−cap: int
vhost_dev backend_cap
log−enabled: boolean
vhost_dev log_enabled flag
log−size: int
vhost_dev log_size
7.2
Full status of the virtio device with most VirtIODevice members. Also includes the full status of the corresponding vhost device if the vhost device is active.
name: string
VirtIODevice name
device−id: int
VirtIODevice ID
vhost−started: boolean
VirtIODevice vhost_started flag
guest−features: VirtioDeviceFeatures
VirtIODevice guest_features
host−features: VirtioDeviceFeatures
VirtIODevice host_features
backend−features: VirtioDeviceFeatures
VirtIODevice backend_features
device−endian: string
VirtIODevice device_endian
num−vqs: int
VirtIODevice virtqueue count. This is the number of active virtqueues being used by the VirtIODevice.
status: VirtioDeviceStatus
VirtIODevice configuration status (VirtioDeviceStatus)
isr: int
VirtIODevice ISR
queue−sel: int
VirtIODevice queue_sel
vm−running: boolean
VirtIODevice vm_running flag
broken: boolean
VirtIODevice broken flag
disabled: boolean
VirtIODevice disabled flag
use−started: boolean
VirtIODevice use_started flag
started: boolean
VirtIODevice started flag
start−on−kick: boolean
VirtIODevice start_on_kick flag
disable−legacy−check: boolean
VirtIODevice disabled_legacy_check flag
bus−name: string
VirtIODevice bus_name
use−guest−notifier−mask: boolean
VirtIODevice use_guest_notifier_mask flag
vhost−dev: VhostStatus (optional)
Corresponding vhost device info for a given VirtIODevice. Present if the given VirtIODevice has an active vhost device.
7.2
Poll for a comprehensive status of a given virtio device
path: string
Canonical QOM path of the VirtIODevice
unstable
This command is meant for debugging.
VirtioStatus of the virtio device
7.2
1. Poll for the status of virtio−crypto (no vhost−crypto active) −> { "execute": "x−query−virtio−status", "arguments": { "path": "/machine/peripheral/crypto0/virtio−backend" } } <− { "return": { "device−endian": "little", "bus−name": "", "disable−legacy−check": false, "name": "virtio−crypto", "started": true, "device−id": 20, "backend−features": { "transports": [], "dev−features": [] }, "start−on−kick": false, "isr": 1, "broken": false, "status": { "statuses": [ "VIRTIO_CONFIG_S_ACKNOWLEDGE: Valid virtio device found", "VIRTIO_CONFIG_S_DRIVER: Guest OS compatible with device", "VIRTIO_CONFIG_S_FEATURES_OK: Feature negotiation complete", "VIRTIO_CONFIG_S_DRIVER_OK: Driver setup and ready" ] }, "num−vqs": 2, "guest−features": { "dev−features": [], "transports": [ "VIRTIO_RING_F_EVENT_IDX: Used & avail. event fields enabled", "VIRTIO_RING_F_INDIRECT_DESC: Indirect descriptors supported", "VIRTIO_F_VERSION_1: Device compliant for v1 spec (legacy)" ] }, "host−features": { "unknown−dev−features": 1073741824, "dev−features": [], "transports": [ "VIRTIO_RING_F_EVENT_IDX: Used & avail. event fields enabled", "VIRTIO_RING_F_INDIRECT_DESC: Indirect descriptors supported", "VIRTIO_F_VERSION_1: Device compliant for v1 spec (legacy)", "VIRTIO_F_ANY_LAYOUT: Device accepts arbitrary desc. layouts", "VIRTIO_F_NOTIFY_ON_EMPTY: Notify when device runs out of avail. descs. on VQ" ] }, "use−guest−notifier−mask": true, "vm−running": true, "queue−sel": 1, "disabled": false, "vhost−started": false, "use−started": true } } 2. Poll for the status of virtio−net (vhost−net is active) −> { "execute": "x−query−virtio−status", "arguments": { "path": "/machine/peripheral−anon/device[1]/virtio−backend" } } <− { "return": { "device−endian": "little", "bus−name": "", "disabled−legacy−check": false, "name": "virtio−net", "started": true, "device−id": 1, "vhost−dev": { "n−tmp−sections": 4, "n−mem−sections": 4, "max−queues": 1, "backend−cap": 2, "log−size": 0, "backend−features": { "dev−features": [], "transports": [] }, "nvqs": 2, "protocol−features": { "protocols": [] }, "vq−index": 0, "log−enabled": false, "acked−features": { "dev−features": [ "VIRTIO_NET_F_MRG_RXBUF: Driver can merge receive buffers" ], "transports": [ "VIRTIO_RING_F_EVENT_IDX: Used & avail. event fields enabled", "VIRTIO_RING_F_INDIRECT_DESC: Indirect descriptors supported", "VIRTIO_F_VERSION_1: Device compliant for v1 spec (legacy)" ] }, "features": { "dev−features": [ "VHOST_F_LOG_ALL: Logging write descriptors supported", "VIRTIO_NET_F_MRG_RXBUF: Driver can merge receive buffers" ], "transports": [ "VIRTIO_RING_F_EVENT_IDX: Used & avail. event fields enabled", "VIRTIO_RING_F_INDIRECT_DESC: Indirect descriptors supported", "VIRTIO_F_IOMMU_PLATFORM: Device can be used on IOMMU platform", "VIRTIO_F_VERSION_1: Device compliant for v1 spec (legacy)", "VIRTIO_F_ANY_LAYOUT: Device accepts arbitrary desc. layouts", "VIRTIO_F_NOTIFY_ON_EMPTY: Notify when device runs out of avail. descs. on VQ" ] } }, "backend−features": { "dev−features": [ "VHOST_USER_F_PROTOCOL_FEATURES: Vhost−user protocol features negotiation supported", "VIRTIO_NET_F_GSO: Handling GSO−type packets supported", "VIRTIO_NET_F_CTRL_MAC_ADDR: MAC address set through control channel", "VIRTIO_NET_F_GUEST_ANNOUNCE: Driver sending gratuitous packets supported", "VIRTIO_NET_F_CTRL_RX_EXTRA: Extra RX mode control supported", "VIRTIO_NET_F_CTRL_VLAN: Control channel VLAN filtering supported", "VIRTIO_NET_F_CTRL_RX: Control channel RX mode supported", "VIRTIO_NET_F_CTRL_VQ: Control channel available", "VIRTIO_NET_F_STATUS: Configuration status field available", "VIRTIO_NET_F_MRG_RXBUF: Driver can merge receive buffers", "VIRTIO_NET_F_HOST_UFO: Device can receive UFO", "VIRTIO_NET_F_HOST_ECN: Device can receive TSO with ECN", "VIRTIO_NET_F_HOST_TSO6: Device can receive TSOv6", "VIRTIO_NET_F_HOST_TSO4: Device can receive TSOv4", "VIRTIO_NET_F_GUEST_UFO: Driver can receive UFO", "VIRTIO_NET_F_GUEST_ECN: Driver can receive TSO with ECN", "VIRTIO_NET_F_GUEST_TSO6: Driver can receive TSOv6", "VIRTIO_NET_F_GUEST_TSO4: Driver can receive TSOv4", "VIRTIO_NET_F_MAC: Device has given MAC address", "VIRTIO_NET_F_CTRL_GUEST_OFFLOADS: Control channel offloading reconfig. supported", "VIRTIO_NET_F_GUEST_CSUM: Driver handling packets with partial checksum supported", "VIRTIO_NET_F_CSUM: Device handling packets with partial checksum supported" ], "transports": [ "VIRTIO_RING_F_EVENT_IDX: Used & avail. event fields enabled", "VIRTIO_RING_F_INDIRECT_DESC: Indirect descriptors supported", "VIRTIO_F_VERSION_1: Device compliant for v1 spec (legacy)", "VIRTIO_F_ANY_LAYOUT: Device accepts arbitrary desc. layouts", "VIRTIO_F_NOTIFY_ON_EMPTY: Notify when device runs out of avail. descs. on VQ" ] }, "start−on−kick": false, "isr": 1, "broken": false, "status": { "statuses": [ "VIRTIO_CONFIG_S_ACKNOWLEDGE: Valid virtio device found", "VIRTIO_CONFIG_S_DRIVER: Guest OS compatible with device", "VIRTIO_CONFIG_S_FEATURES_OK: Feature negotiation complete", "VIRTIO_CONFIG_S_DRIVER_OK: Driver setup and ready" ] }, "num−vqs": 3, "guest−features": { "dev−features": [ "VIRTIO_NET_F_CTRL_MAC_ADDR: MAC address set through control channel", "VIRTIO_NET_F_GUEST_ANNOUNCE: Driver sending gratuitous packets supported", "VIRTIO_NET_F_CTRL_VLAN: Control channel VLAN filtering supported", "VIRTIO_NET_F_CTRL_RX: Control channel RX mode supported", "VIRTIO_NET_F_CTRL_VQ: Control channel available", "VIRTIO_NET_F_STATUS: Configuration status field available", "VIRTIO_NET_F_MRG_RXBUF: Driver can merge receive buffers", "VIRTIO_NET_F_HOST_UFO: Device can receive UFO", "VIRTIO_NET_F_HOST_ECN: Device can receive TSO with ECN", "VIRTIO_NET_F_HOST_TSO6: Device can receive TSOv6", "VIRTIO_NET_F_HOST_TSO4: Device can receive TSOv4", "VIRTIO_NET_F_GUEST_UFO: Driver can receive UFO", "VIRTIO_NET_F_GUEST_ECN: Driver can receive TSO with ECN", "VIRTIO_NET_F_GUEST_TSO6: Driver can receive TSOv6", "VIRTIO_NET_F_GUEST_TSO4: Driver can receive TSOv4", "VIRTIO_NET_F_MAC: Device has given MAC address", "VIRTIO_NET_F_CTRL_GUEST_OFFLOADS: Control channel offloading reconfig. supported", "VIRTIO_NET_F_GUEST_CSUM: Driver handling packets with partial checksum supported", "VIRTIO_NET_F_CSUM: Device handling packets with partial checksum supported" ], "transports": [ "VIRTIO_RING_F_EVENT_IDX: Used & avail. event fields enabled", "VIRTIO_RING_F_INDIRECT_DESC: Indirect descriptors supported", "VIRTIO_F_VERSION_1: Device compliant for v1 spec (legacy)" ] }, "host−features": { "dev−features": [ "VHOST_USER_F_PROTOCOL_FEATURES: Vhost−user protocol features negotiation supported", "VIRTIO_NET_F_GSO: Handling GSO−type packets supported", "VIRTIO_NET_F_CTRL_MAC_ADDR: MAC address set through control channel", "VIRTIO_NET_F_GUEST_ANNOUNCE: Driver sending gratuitous packets supported", "VIRTIO_NET_F_CTRL_RX_EXTRA: Extra RX mode control supported", "VIRTIO_NET_F_CTRL_VLAN: Control channel VLAN filtering supported", "VIRTIO_NET_F_CTRL_RX: Control channel RX mode supported", "VIRTIO_NET_F_CTRL_VQ: Control channel available", "VIRTIO_NET_F_STATUS: Configuration status field available", "VIRTIO_NET_F_MRG_RXBUF: Driver can merge receive buffers", "VIRTIO_NET_F_HOST_UFO: Device can receive UFO", "VIRTIO_NET_F_HOST_ECN: Device can receive TSO with ECN", "VIRTIO_NET_F_HOST_TSO6: Device can receive TSOv6", "VIRTIO_NET_F_HOST_TSO4: Device can receive TSOv4", "VIRTIO_NET_F_GUEST_UFO: Driver can receive UFO", "VIRTIO_NET_F_GUEST_ECN: Driver can receive TSO with ECN", "VIRTIO_NET_F_GUEST_TSO6: Driver can receive TSOv6", "VIRTIO_NET_F_GUEST_TSO4: Driver can receive TSOv4", "VIRTIO_NET_F_MAC: Device has given MAC address", "VIRTIO_NET_F_CTRL_GUEST_OFFLOADS: Control channel offloading reconfig. supported", "VIRTIO_NET_F_GUEST_CSUM: Driver handling packets with partial checksum supported", "VIRTIO_NET_F_CSUM: Device handling packets with partial checksum supported" ], "transports": [ "VIRTIO_RING_F_EVENT_IDX: Used & avail. event fields enabled", "VIRTIO_RING_F_INDIRECT_DESC: Indirect descriptors supported", "VIRTIO_F_VERSION_1: Device compliant for v1 spec (legacy)", "VIRTIO_F_ANY_LAYOUT: Device accepts arbitrary desc. layouts", "VIRTIO_F_NOTIFY_ON_EMPTY: Notify when device runs out of avail. descs. on VQ" ] }, "use−guest−notifier−mask": true, "vm−running": true, "queue−sel": 2, "disabled": false, "vhost−started": true, "use−started": true } }
A structure defined to list the configuration statuses of a virtio device
statuses: array of string
List of decoded configuration statuses of the virtio device
unknown−statuses: int (optional)
Virtio device statuses bitmap that have not been decoded
7.2
A structure defined to list the vhost user protocol features of a Vhost User device
protocols: array of string
List of decoded vhost user protocol features of a vhost user device
unknown−protocols: int (optional)
Vhost user device protocol features bitmap that have not been decoded
7.2
The common fields that apply to most Virtio devices. Some devices may not have their own device−specific features (e.g. virtio−rng).
transports: array of string
List of transport features of the virtio device
dev−features: array of string (optional)
List of device−specific features (if the device has unique features)
unknown−dev−features: int (optional)
Virtio device features bitmap that have not been decoded
7.2
Information of a VirtIODevice VirtQueue, including most members of the VirtQueue data structure.
name: string
Name of the VirtIODevice that uses this VirtQueue
queue−index: int
VirtQueue queue_index
inuse: int
VirtQueue inuse
vring−num: int
VirtQueue vring.num
vring−num−default: int
VirtQueue vring.num_default
vring−align: int
VirtQueue vring.align
vring−desc: int
VirtQueue vring.desc (descriptor area)
vring−avail: int
VirtQueue vring.avail (driver area)
vring−used: int
VirtQueue vring.used (device area)
last−avail−idx: int (optional)
VirtQueue last_avail_idx or return of vhost_dev vhost_get_vring_base (if vhost active)
shadow−avail−idx: int (optional)
VirtQueue shadow_avail_idx
used−idx: int
VirtQueue used_idx
signalled−used: int
VirtQueue signalled_used
signalled−used−valid: boolean
VirtQueue signalled_used_valid flag
7.2
Return the status of a given VirtIODevice's VirtQueue
path: string
VirtIODevice canonical QOM path
queue: int
VirtQueue index to examine
unstable
This command is meant for debugging.
VirtQueueStatus of the VirtQueue
last_avail_idx will not be displayed in the case where the selected VirtIODevice has a running vhost device and the VirtIODevice VirtQueue index (queue) does not exist for the corresponding vhost device vhost_virtqueue. Also, shadow_avail_idx will not be displayed in the case where the selected VirtIODevice has a running vhost device.
7.2
1. Get VirtQueueStatus for virtio−vsock (vhost−vsock running) −> { "execute": "x−query−virtio−queue−status", "arguments": { "path": "/machine/peripheral/vsock0/virtio−backend", "queue": 1 } } <− { "return": { "signalled−used": 0, "inuse": 0, "name": "vhost−vsock", "vring−align": 4096, "vring−desc": 5217370112, "signalled−used−valid": false, "vring−num−default": 128, "vring−avail": 5217372160, "queue−index": 1, "last−avail−idx": 0, "vring−used": 5217372480, "used−idx": 0, "vring−num": 128 } } 2. Get VirtQueueStatus for virtio−serial (no vhost) −> { "execute": "x−query−virtio−queue−status", "arguments": { "path": "/machine/peripheral−anon/device[0]/virtio−backend", "queue": 20 } } <− { "return": { "signalled−used": 0, "inuse": 0, "name": "virtio−serial", "vring−align": 4096, "vring−desc": 5182074880, "signalled−used−valid": false, "vring−num−default": 128, "vring−avail": 5182076928, "queue−index": 20, "last−avail−idx": 0, "vring−used": 5182077248, "used−idx": 0, "shadow−avail−idx": 0, "vring−num": 128 } }
Information of a vhost device's vhost_virtqueue, including most members of the vhost_dev vhost_virtqueue data structure.
name: string
Name of the VirtIODevice that uses this vhost_virtqueue
kick: int
vhost_virtqueue kick
call: int
vhost_virtqueue call
desc: int
vhost_virtqueue desc
avail: int
vhost_virtqueue avail
used: int
vhost_virtqueue used
num: int
vhost_virtqueue num
desc−phys: int
vhost_virtqueue desc_phys (descriptor area phys. addr.)
desc−size: int
vhost_virtqueue desc_size
avail−phys: int
vhost_virtqueue avail_phys (driver area phys. addr.)
avail−size: int
vhost_virtqueue avail_size
used−phys: int
vhost_virtqueue used_phys (device area phys. addr.)
used−size: int
vhost_virtqueue used_size
7.2
Return information of a given vhost device's vhost_virtqueue
path: string
VirtIODevice canonical QOM path
queue: int
vhost_virtqueue index to examine
unstable
This command is meant for debugging.
VirtVhostQueueStatus of the vhost_virtqueue
7.2
1. Get vhost_virtqueue status for vhost−crypto −> { "execute": "x−query−virtio−vhost−queue−status", "arguments": { "path": "/machine/peripheral/crypto0/virtio−backend", "queue": 0 } } <− { "return": { "avail−phys": 5216124928, "name": "virtio−crypto", "used−phys": 5216127040, "avail−size": 2054, "desc−size": 16384, "used−size": 8198, "desc": 140141447430144, "num": 1024, "call": 0, "avail": 140141447446528, "desc−phys": 5216108544, "used": 140141447448640, "kick": 0 } } 2. Get vhost_virtqueue status for vhost−vsock −> { "execute": "x−query−virtio−vhost−queue−status", "arguments": { "path": "/machine/peripheral/vsock0/virtio−backend", "queue": 0 } } <− { "return": { "avail−phys": 5182261248, "name": "vhost−vsock", "used−phys": 5182261568, "avail−size": 262, "desc−size": 2048, "used−size": 1030, "desc": 140141413580800, "num": 128, "call": 0, "avail": 140141413582848, "desc−phys": 5182259200, "used": 140141413583168, "kick": 0 } }
Information regarding the vring descriptor area
addr: int
Guest physical address of the descriptor area
len: int
Length of the descriptor area
flags: array of string
List of descriptor flags
7.2
Information regarding the avail vring (a.k.a. driver area)
flags: int
VRingAvail flags
idx: int
VRingAvail index
ring: int
VRingAvail ring[] entry at provided index
7.2
Information regarding the used vring (a.k.a. device area)
flags: int
VRingUsed flags
idx: int
VRingUsed index
7.2
Information regarding a VirtQueue's VirtQueueElement including descriptor, driver, and device areas
name: string
Name of the VirtIODevice that uses this VirtQueue
index: int
Index of the element in the queue
descs: array of VirtioRingDesc
List of descriptors (VirtioRingDesc)
avail: VirtioRingAvail
VRingAvail info
used: VirtioRingUsed
VRingUsed info
7.2
Return the information about a VirtQueue's VirtQueueElement
path: string
VirtIODevice canonical QOM path
queue: int
VirtQueue index to examine
index: int (optional)
Index of the element in the queue (default: head of the queue)
unstable
This command is meant for debugging.
VirtioQueueElement information
7.2
1. Introspect on virtio−net's VirtQueue 0 at index 5 −> { "execute": "x−query−virtio−queue−element", "arguments": { "path": "/machine/peripheral−anon/device[1]/virtio−backend", "queue": 0, "index": 5 } } <− { "return": { "index": 5, "name": "virtio−net", "descs": [ { "flags": ["write"], "len": 1536, "addr": 5257305600 } ], "avail": { "idx": 256, "flags": 0, "ring": 5 }, "used": { "idx": 13, "flags": 0 } } } 2. Introspect on virtio−crypto's VirtQueue 1 at head −> { "execute": "x−query−virtio−queue−element", "arguments": { "path": "/machine/peripheral/crypto0/virtio−backend", "queue": 1 } } <− { "return": { "index": 0, "name": "virtio−crypto", "descs": [ { "flags": [], "len": 0, "addr": 8080268923184214134 } ], "avail": { "idx": 280, "flags": 0, "ring": 0 }, "used": { "idx": 280, "flags": 0 } } } 3. Introspect on virtio−scsi's VirtQueue 2 at head −> { "execute": "x−query−virtio−queue−element", "arguments": { "path": "/machine/peripheral−anon/device[2]/virtio−backend", "queue": 2 } } <− { "return": { "index": 19, "name": "virtio−scsi", "descs": [ { "flags": ["used", "indirect", "write"], "len": 4099327944, "addr": 12055409292258155293 } ], "avail": { "idx": 1147, "flags": 0, "ring": 19 }, "used": { "idx": 280, "flags": 0 } } }
The supported algorithm types of a crypto device.
sym |
symmetric encryption |
|||
asym |
asymmetric Encryption |
8.0
The supported service types of a crypto device.
cipher |
Not documented |
|||
hash |
Not documented |
|||
mac |
Not documented |
|||
aead |
Not documented |
akcipher
Not documented
8.0
The crypto device backend type
builtin
the QEMU builtin support
vhost−user
vhost−user
lkcf |
Linux kernel cryptographic framework |
8.0
Information about a queue of crypto device.
queue: int
the queue index of the crypto device
type: QCryptodevBackendType
the type of the crypto device
8.0
Information about a crypto device.
id: string
the id of the crypto device
service: array of QCryptodevBackendServiceType
supported service types of a crypto device
client: array of QCryptodevBackendClient
the additional information of the crypto device
8.0
Returns information about current crypto devices.
a list of QCryptodevInfo
8.0
CXL has a number of separate event logs for different types of events. Each such event log is handled and signaled independently.
informational
Information Event Log
warning
Warning Event Log
failure
Failure Event Log
fatal |
Fatal Event Log |
8.1
Inject an event record for a General Media Event (CXL r3.0 8.2.9.2.1.1). This event type is reported via one of the event logs specified via the log parameter.
path: string
CXL type 3 device canonical QOM path
log: CxlEventLog
event log to add the event to
flags: int
Event Record Flags. See CXL r3.0 Table 8−42 Common Event Record Format, Event Record Flags for subfield definitions.
dpa: int
Device Physical Address (relative to path device). Note lower bits include some flags. See CXL r3.0 Table 8−43 General Media Event Record, Physical Address.
descriptor: int
Memory Event Descriptor with additional memory event information. See CXL r3.0 Table 8−43 General Media Event Record, Memory Event Descriptor for bit definitions.
type: int
Type of memory event that occurred. See CXL r3.0 Table 8−43 General Media Event Record, Memory Event Type for possible values.
transaction−type: int
Type of first transaction that caused the event to occur. See CXL r3.0 Table 8−43 General Media Event Record, Transaction Type for possible values.
channel: int (optional)
The channel of the memory event location. A channel is an interface that can be independently accessed for a transaction.
rank: int (optional)
The rank of the memory event location. A rank is a set of memory devices on a channel that together execute a transaction.
device: int (optional)
Bitmask that represents all devices in the rank associated with the memory event location.
component−id: string (optional)
Device specific component identifier for the event. May describe a field replaceable sub−component of the device.
8.1
Inject an event record for a DRAM Event (CXL r3.0 8.2.9.2.1.2). This event type is reported via one of the event logs specified via the log parameter.
path: string
CXL type 3 device canonical QOM path
log: CxlEventLog
Event log to add the event to
flags: int
Event Record Flags. See CXL r3.0 Table 8−42 Common Event Record Format, Event Record Flags for subfield definitions.
dpa: int
Device Physical Address (relative to path device). Note lower bits include some flags. See CXL r3.0 Table 8−44 DRAM Event Record, Physical Address.
descriptor: int
Memory Event Descriptor with additional memory event information. See CXL r3.0 Table 8−44 DRAM Event Record, Memory Event Descriptor for bit definitions.
type: int
Type of memory event that occurred. See CXL r3.0 Table 8−44 DRAM Event Record, Memory Event Type for possible values.
transaction−type: int
Type of first transaction that caused the event to occur. See CXL r3.0 Table 8−44 DRAM Event Record, Transaction Type for possible values.
channel: int (optional)
The channel of the memory event location. A channel is an interface that can be independently accessed for a transaction.
rank: int (optional)
The rank of the memory event location. A rank is a set of memory devices on a channel that together execute a transaction.
nibble−mask: int (optional)
Identifies one or more nibbles that the error affects
bank−group: int (optional)
Bank group of the memory event location, incorporating a number of Banks.
bank: int (optional)
Bank of the memory event location. A single bank is accessed per read or write of the memory.
row: int (optional)
Row address within the DRAM.
column: int (optional)
Column address within the DRAM.
correction−mask: array of int (optional)
Bits within each nibble. Used in order of bits set in the nibble−mask. Up to 4 nibbles may be covered.
8.1
Inject an event record for a Memory Module Event (CXL r3.0 8.2.9.2.1.3). This event includes a copy of the Device Health info at the time of the event.
path: string
CXL type 3 device canonical QOM path
log: CxlEventLog
Event Log to add the event to
flags: int
Event Record Flags. See CXL r3.0 Table 8−42 Common Event Record Format, Event Record Flags for subfield definitions.
type: int
Device Event Type. See CXL r3.0 Table 8−45 Memory Module Event Record for bit definitions for bit definiions.
health−status: int
Overall health summary bitmap. See CXL r3.0 Table 8−100 Get Health Info Output Payload, Health Status for bit definitions.
media−status: int
Overall media health summary. See CXL r3.0 Table 8−100 Get Health Info Output Payload, Media Status for bit definitions.
additional−status: int
See CXL r3.0 Table 8−100 Get Health Info Output Payload, Additional Status for subfield definitions.
life−used: int
Percentage (0−100) of factory expected life span.
temperature: int
Device temperature in degrees Celsius.
dirty−shutdown−count: int
Number of times the device has been unable to determine whether data loss may have occurred.
corrected−volatile−error−count: int
Total number of correctable errors in volatile memory.
corrected−persistent−error−count: int
Total number of correctable errors in persistent memory
8.1
Poison records indicate that a CXL memory device knows that a particular memory region may be corrupted. This may be because of locally detected errors (e.g. ECC failure) or poisoned writes received from other components in the system. This injection mechanism enables testing of the OS handling of poison records which may be queried via the CXL mailbox.
path: string
CXL type 3 device canonical QOM path
start: int
Start address; must be 64 byte aligned.
length: int
Length of poison to inject; must be a multiple of 64 bytes.
8.1
Type of uncorrectable CXL error to inject. These errors are reported via an AER uncorrectable internal error with additional information logged at the CXL device.
cache−data−parity
Data error such as data parity or data ECC error CXL.cache
cache−address−parity
Address parity or other errors associated with the address field on CXL.cache
cache−be−parity
Byte enable parity or other byte enable errors on CXL.cache
cache−data−ecc
ECC error on CXL.cache
mem−data−parity
Data error such as data parity or data ECC error on CXL.mem
mem−address−parity
Address parity or other errors associated with the address field on CXL.mem
mem−be−parity
Byte enable parity or other byte enable errors on CXL.mem.
mem−data−ecc
Data ECC error on CXL.mem.
reinit−threshold
REINIT threshold hit.
rsvd−encoding
Received unrecognized encoding.
poison−received
Received poison from the peer.
receiver−overflow
Buffer overflows (first 3 bits of header log indicate which)
internal
Component specific error
cxl−ide−tx
Integrity and data encryption tx error.
cxl−ide−rx
Integrity and data encryption rx error.
8.0
Record of a single error including header log.
type: CxlUncorErrorType
Type of error
header: array of int
16 DWORD of header.
8.0
Command to allow injection of multiple errors in one go. This allows testing of multiple header log handling in the OS.
path: string
CXL Type 3 device canonical QOM path
errors: array of CXLUncorErrorRecord
Errors to inject
8.0
Type of CXL correctable error to inject
cache−data−ecc
Data ECC error on CXL.cache
mem−data−ecc
Data ECC error on CXL.mem
crc−threshold
Component specific and applicable to 68 byte Flit mode only.
cache−poison−received
Received poison from a peer on CXL.cache.
mem−poison−received
Received poison from a peer on CXL.mem
physical
Received error indication from the physical layer.
retry−threshold
Not documented
8.0
Command to inject a single correctable error. Multiple error injection of this error type is not interesting as there is no associated header log. These errors are reported via AER as a correctable internal error, with additional detail available from the CXL device.
path: string
CXL Type 3 device canonical QOM path
type: CxlCorErrorType
Type of error.
8.0
2024, The QEMU Project Developers